LCOV - code coverage report
Current view: top level - src/backend/access/heap - heapam.c (source / functions) Coverage Total Hit
Test: PostgreSQL 19devel Lines: 91.7 % 2701 2477
Test Date: 2026-05-04 16:16:34 Functions: 100.0 % 80 80
Legend: Lines:     hit not hit

            Line data    Source code
       1              : /*-------------------------------------------------------------------------
       2              :  *
       3              :  * heapam.c
       4              :  *    heap access method code
       5              :  *
       6              :  * Portions Copyright (c) 1996-2026, PostgreSQL Global Development Group
       7              :  * Portions Copyright (c) 1994, Regents of the University of California
       8              :  *
       9              :  *
      10              :  * IDENTIFICATION
      11              :  *    src/backend/access/heap/heapam.c
      12              :  *
      13              :  *
      14              :  * INTERFACE ROUTINES
      15              :  *      heap_beginscan  - begin relation scan
      16              :  *      heap_rescan     - restart a relation scan
      17              :  *      heap_endscan    - end relation scan
      18              :  *      heap_getnext    - retrieve next tuple in scan
      19              :  *      heap_fetch      - retrieve tuple with given tid
      20              :  *      heap_insert     - insert tuple into a relation
      21              :  *      heap_multi_insert - insert multiple tuples into a relation
      22              :  *      heap_delete     - delete a tuple from a relation
      23              :  *      heap_update     - replace a tuple in a relation with another tuple
      24              :  *
      25              :  * NOTES
      26              :  *    This file contains the heap_ routines which implement
      27              :  *    the POSTGRES heap access method used for all POSTGRES
      28              :  *    relations.
      29              :  *
      30              :  *-------------------------------------------------------------------------
      31              :  */
      32              : #include "postgres.h"
      33              : 
      34              : #include "access/heapam.h"
      35              : #include "access/heaptoast.h"
      36              : #include "access/hio.h"
      37              : #include "access/multixact.h"
      38              : #include "access/subtrans.h"
      39              : #include "access/syncscan.h"
      40              : #include "access/valid.h"
      41              : #include "access/visibilitymap.h"
      42              : #include "access/xloginsert.h"
      43              : #include "catalog/pg_database.h"
      44              : #include "catalog/pg_database_d.h"
      45              : #include "commands/vacuum.h"
      46              : #include "executor/instrument_node.h"
      47              : #include "pgstat.h"
      48              : #include "port/pg_bitutils.h"
      49              : #include "storage/lmgr.h"
      50              : #include "storage/predicate.h"
      51              : #include "storage/proc.h"
      52              : #include "storage/procarray.h"
      53              : #include "utils/datum.h"
      54              : #include "utils/injection_point.h"
      55              : #include "utils/inval.h"
      56              : #include "utils/spccache.h"
      57              : #include "utils/syscache.h"
      58              : 
      59              : 
      60              : static HeapTuple heap_prepare_insert(Relation relation, HeapTuple tup,
      61              :                                      TransactionId xid, CommandId cid, uint32 options);
      62              : static XLogRecPtr log_heap_update(Relation reln, Buffer oldbuf,
      63              :                                   Buffer newbuf, HeapTuple oldtup,
      64              :                                   HeapTuple newtup, HeapTuple old_key_tuple,
      65              :                                   bool all_visible_cleared, bool new_all_visible_cleared,
      66              :                                   bool walLogical);
      67              : #ifdef USE_ASSERT_CHECKING
      68              : static void check_lock_if_inplace_updateable_rel(Relation relation,
      69              :                                                  const ItemPointerData *otid,
      70              :                                                  HeapTuple newtup);
      71              : static void check_inplace_rel_lock(HeapTuple oldtup);
      72              : #endif
      73              : static Bitmapset *HeapDetermineColumnsInfo(Relation relation,
      74              :                                            Bitmapset *interesting_cols,
      75              :                                            Bitmapset *external_cols,
      76              :                                            HeapTuple oldtup, HeapTuple newtup,
      77              :                                            bool *has_external);
      78              : static bool heap_acquire_tuplock(Relation relation, const ItemPointerData *tid,
      79              :                                  LockTupleMode mode, LockWaitPolicy wait_policy,
      80              :                                  bool *have_tuple_lock);
      81              : static inline BlockNumber heapgettup_advance_block(HeapScanDesc scan,
      82              :                                                    BlockNumber block,
      83              :                                                    ScanDirection dir);
      84              : static pg_noinline BlockNumber heapgettup_initial_block(HeapScanDesc scan,
      85              :                                                         ScanDirection dir);
      86              : static void compute_new_xmax_infomask(TransactionId xmax, uint16 old_infomask,
      87              :                                       uint16 old_infomask2, TransactionId add_to_xmax,
      88              :                                       LockTupleMode mode, bool is_update,
      89              :                                       TransactionId *result_xmax, uint16 *result_infomask,
      90              :                                       uint16 *result_infomask2);
      91              : static TM_Result heap_lock_updated_tuple(Relation rel,
      92              :                                          uint16 prior_infomask,
      93              :                                          TransactionId prior_raw_xmax,
      94              :                                          const ItemPointerData *prior_ctid,
      95              :                                          TransactionId xid,
      96              :                                          LockTupleMode mode);
      97              : static void GetMultiXactIdHintBits(MultiXactId multi, uint16 *new_infomask,
      98              :                                    uint16 *new_infomask2);
      99              : static TransactionId MultiXactIdGetUpdateXid(TransactionId xmax,
     100              :                                              uint16 t_infomask);
     101              : static bool DoesMultiXactIdConflict(MultiXactId multi, uint16 infomask,
     102              :                                     LockTupleMode lockmode, bool *current_is_member);
     103              : static void MultiXactIdWait(MultiXactId multi, MultiXactStatus status, uint16 infomask,
     104              :                             Relation rel, const ItemPointerData *ctid, XLTW_Oper oper,
     105              :                             int *remaining);
     106              : static bool ConditionalMultiXactIdWait(MultiXactId multi, MultiXactStatus status,
     107              :                                        uint16 infomask, Relation rel, int *remaining,
     108              :                                        bool logLockFailure);
     109              : static void index_delete_sort(TM_IndexDeleteOp *delstate);
     110              : static int  bottomup_sort_and_shrink(TM_IndexDeleteOp *delstate);
     111              : static XLogRecPtr log_heap_new_cid(Relation relation, HeapTuple tup);
     112              : static HeapTuple ExtractReplicaIdentity(Relation relation, HeapTuple tp, bool key_required,
     113              :                                         bool *copy);
     114              : 
     115              : 
     116              : /*
     117              :  * This table lists the heavyweight lock mode that corresponds to each tuple
     118              :  * lock mode, as well as one or two corresponding MultiXactStatus values:
     119              :  * .lockstatus to merely lock tuples, and .updstatus to update them.  The
     120              :  * latter is set to -1 if the corresponding tuple lock mode does not allow
     121              :  * updating tuples -- see get_mxact_status_for_lock().
     122              :  *
     123              :  * These interact with InplaceUpdateTupleLock, an alias for ExclusiveLock.
     124              :  *
     125              :  * Don't look at lockstatus/updstatus directly!  Use get_mxact_status_for_lock
     126              :  * instead.
     127              :  */
     128              : static const struct
     129              : {
     130              :     LOCKMODE    hwlock;
     131              :     int         lockstatus;
     132              :     int         updstatus;
     133              : }           tupleLockExtraInfo[] =
     134              : 
     135              : {
     136              :     [LockTupleKeyShare] = {
     137              :         .hwlock = AccessShareLock,
     138              :         .lockstatus = MultiXactStatusForKeyShare,
     139              :         /* KeyShare does not allow updating tuples */
     140              :         .updstatus = -1
     141              :     },
     142              :     [LockTupleShare] = {
     143              :         .hwlock = RowShareLock,
     144              :         .lockstatus = MultiXactStatusForShare,
     145              :         /* Share does not allow updating tuples */
     146              :         .updstatus = -1
     147              :     },
     148              :     [LockTupleNoKeyExclusive] = {
     149              :         .hwlock = ExclusiveLock,
     150              :         .lockstatus = MultiXactStatusForNoKeyUpdate,
     151              :         .updstatus = MultiXactStatusNoKeyUpdate
     152              :     },
     153              :     [LockTupleExclusive] = {
     154              :         .hwlock = AccessExclusiveLock,
     155              :         .lockstatus = MultiXactStatusForUpdate,
     156              :         .updstatus = MultiXactStatusUpdate
     157              :     }
     158              : };
     159              : 
     160              : /* Get the LOCKMODE for a given MultiXactStatus */
     161              : #define LOCKMODE_from_mxstatus(status) \
     162              :             (tupleLockExtraInfo[TUPLOCK_from_mxstatus((status))].hwlock)
     163              : 
     164              : /*
     165              :  * Acquire heavyweight locks on tuples, using a LockTupleMode strength value.
     166              :  * This is more readable than having every caller translate it to lock.h's
     167              :  * LOCKMODE.
     168              :  */
     169              : #define LockTupleTuplock(rel, tup, mode) \
     170              :     LockTuple((rel), (tup), tupleLockExtraInfo[mode].hwlock)
     171              : #define UnlockTupleTuplock(rel, tup, mode) \
     172              :     UnlockTuple((rel), (tup), tupleLockExtraInfo[mode].hwlock)
     173              : #define ConditionalLockTupleTuplock(rel, tup, mode, log) \
     174              :     ConditionalLockTuple((rel), (tup), tupleLockExtraInfo[mode].hwlock, (log))
     175              : 
     176              : #ifdef USE_PREFETCH
     177              : /*
     178              :  * heap_index_delete_tuples and index_delete_prefetch_buffer use this
     179              :  * structure to coordinate prefetching activity
     180              :  */
     181              : typedef struct
     182              : {
     183              :     BlockNumber cur_hblkno;
     184              :     int         next_item;
     185              :     int         ndeltids;
     186              :     TM_IndexDelete *deltids;
     187              : } IndexDeletePrefetchState;
     188              : #endif
     189              : 
     190              : /* heap_index_delete_tuples bottom-up index deletion costing constants */
     191              : #define BOTTOMUP_MAX_NBLOCKS            6
     192              : #define BOTTOMUP_TOLERANCE_NBLOCKS      3
     193              : 
     194              : /*
     195              :  * heap_index_delete_tuples uses this when determining which heap blocks it
     196              :  * must visit to help its bottom-up index deletion caller
     197              :  */
     198              : typedef struct IndexDeleteCounts
     199              : {
     200              :     int16       npromisingtids; /* Number of "promising" TIDs in group */
     201              :     int16       ntids;          /* Number of TIDs in group */
     202              :     int16       ifirsttid;      /* Offset to group's first deltid */
     203              : } IndexDeleteCounts;
     204              : 
     205              : /*
     206              :  * This table maps tuple lock strength values for each particular
     207              :  * MultiXactStatus value.
     208              :  */
     209              : static const int MultiXactStatusLock[MaxMultiXactStatus + 1] =
     210              : {
     211              :     LockTupleKeyShare,          /* ForKeyShare */
     212              :     LockTupleShare,             /* ForShare */
     213              :     LockTupleNoKeyExclusive,    /* ForNoKeyUpdate */
     214              :     LockTupleExclusive,         /* ForUpdate */
     215              :     LockTupleNoKeyExclusive,    /* NoKeyUpdate */
     216              :     LockTupleExclusive          /* Update */
     217              : };
     218              : 
     219              : /* Get the LockTupleMode for a given MultiXactStatus */
     220              : #define TUPLOCK_from_mxstatus(status) \
     221              :             (MultiXactStatusLock[(status)])
     222              : 
     223              : /*
     224              :  * Check that we have a valid snapshot if we might need TOAST access.
     225              :  */
     226              : static inline void
     227     16323188 : AssertHasSnapshotForToast(Relation rel)
     228              : {
     229              : #ifdef USE_ASSERT_CHECKING
     230              : 
     231              :     /* bootstrap mode in particular breaks this rule */
     232              :     if (!IsNormalProcessingMode())
     233              :         return;
     234              : 
     235              :     /* if the relation doesn't have a TOAST table, we are good */
     236              :     if (!OidIsValid(rel->rd_rel->reltoastrelid))
     237              :         return;
     238              : 
     239              :     Assert(HaveRegisteredOrActiveSnapshot());
     240              : 
     241              : #endif                          /* USE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
     242     16323188 : }
     243              : 
     244              : /* ----------------------------------------------------------------
     245              :  *                       heap support routines
     246              :  * ----------------------------------------------------------------
     247              :  */
     248              : 
     249              : /*
     250              :  * Streaming read API callback for parallel sequential scans. Returns the next
     251              :  * block the caller wants from the read stream or InvalidBlockNumber when done.
     252              :  */
     253              : static BlockNumber
     254       146260 : heap_scan_stream_read_next_parallel(ReadStream *stream,
     255              :                                     void *callback_private_data,
     256              :                                     void *per_buffer_data)
     257              : {
     258       146260 :     HeapScanDesc scan = (HeapScanDesc) callback_private_data;
     259              : 
     260              :     Assert(ScanDirectionIsForward(scan->rs_dir));
     261              :     Assert(scan->rs_base.rs_parallel);
     262              : 
     263       146260 :     if (unlikely(!scan->rs_inited))
     264              :     {
     265              :         /* parallel scan */
     266         2783 :         table_block_parallelscan_startblock_init(scan->rs_base.rs_rd,
     267         2783 :                                                  scan->rs_parallelworkerdata,
     268         2783 :                                                  (ParallelBlockTableScanDesc) scan->rs_base.rs_parallel,
     269              :                                                  scan->rs_startblock,
     270              :                                                  scan->rs_numblocks);
     271              : 
     272              :         /* may return InvalidBlockNumber if there are no more blocks */
     273         5566 :         scan->rs_prefetch_block = table_block_parallelscan_nextpage(scan->rs_base.rs_rd,
     274         2783 :                                                                     scan->rs_parallelworkerdata,
     275         2783 :                                                                     (ParallelBlockTableScanDesc) scan->rs_base.rs_parallel);
     276         2783 :         scan->rs_inited = true;
     277              :     }
     278              :     else
     279              :     {
     280       143477 :         scan->rs_prefetch_block = table_block_parallelscan_nextpage(scan->rs_base.rs_rd,
     281       143477 :                                                                     scan->rs_parallelworkerdata, (ParallelBlockTableScanDesc)
     282       143477 :                                                                     scan->rs_base.rs_parallel);
     283              :     }
     284              : 
     285       146260 :     return scan->rs_prefetch_block;
     286              : }
     287              : 
     288              : /*
     289              :  * Streaming read API callback for serial sequential and TID range scans.
     290              :  * Returns the next block the caller wants from the read stream or
     291              :  * InvalidBlockNumber when done.
     292              :  */
     293              : static BlockNumber
     294      5061409 : heap_scan_stream_read_next_serial(ReadStream *stream,
     295              :                                   void *callback_private_data,
     296              :                                   void *per_buffer_data)
     297              : {
     298      5061409 :     HeapScanDesc scan = (HeapScanDesc) callback_private_data;
     299              : 
     300      5061409 :     if (unlikely(!scan->rs_inited))
     301              :     {
     302      1320561 :         scan->rs_prefetch_block = heapgettup_initial_block(scan, scan->rs_dir);
     303      1320561 :         scan->rs_inited = true;
     304              :     }
     305              :     else
     306      3740848 :         scan->rs_prefetch_block = heapgettup_advance_block(scan,
     307              :                                                            scan->rs_prefetch_block,
     308              :                                                            scan->rs_dir);
     309              : 
     310      5061409 :     return scan->rs_prefetch_block;
     311              : }
     312              : 
     313              : /*
     314              :  * Read stream API callback for bitmap heap scans.
     315              :  * Returns the next block the caller wants from the read stream or
     316              :  * InvalidBlockNumber when done.
     317              :  */
     318              : static BlockNumber
     319       263837 : bitmapheap_stream_read_next(ReadStream *pgsr, void *private_data,
     320              :                             void *per_buffer_data)
     321              : {
     322       263837 :     TBMIterateResult *tbmres = per_buffer_data;
     323       263837 :     BitmapHeapScanDesc bscan = (BitmapHeapScanDesc) private_data;
     324       263837 :     HeapScanDesc hscan = (HeapScanDesc) bscan;
     325       263837 :     TableScanDesc sscan = &hscan->rs_base;
     326              : 
     327              :     for (;;)
     328              :     {
     329       263837 :         CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS();
     330              : 
     331              :         /* no more entries in the bitmap */
     332       263837 :         if (!tbm_iterate(&sscan->st.rs_tbmiterator, tbmres))
     333        15968 :             return InvalidBlockNumber;
     334              : 
     335              :         /*
     336              :          * Ignore any claimed entries past what we think is the end of the
     337              :          * relation. It may have been extended after the start of our scan (we
     338              :          * only hold an AccessShareLock, and it could be inserts from this
     339              :          * backend).  We don't take this optimization in SERIALIZABLE
     340              :          * isolation though, as we need to examine all invisible tuples
     341              :          * reachable by the index.
     342              :          */
     343       247869 :         if (!IsolationIsSerializable() &&
     344       247760 :             tbmres->blockno >= hscan->rs_nblocks)
     345            0 :             continue;
     346              : 
     347       247869 :         return tbmres->blockno;
     348              :     }
     349              : 
     350              :     /* not reachable */
     351              :     Assert(false);
     352              : }
     353              : 
     354              : /* ----------------
     355              :  *      initscan - scan code common to heap_beginscan and heap_rescan
     356              :  * ----------------
     357              :  */
     358              : static void
     359      1352856 : initscan(HeapScanDesc scan, ScanKey key, bool keep_startblock)
     360              : {
     361      1352856 :     ParallelBlockTableScanDesc bpscan = NULL;
     362              :     bool        allow_strat;
     363              :     bool        allow_sync;
     364              : 
     365              :     /*
     366              :      * Determine the number of blocks we have to scan.
     367              :      *
     368              :      * It is sufficient to do this once at scan start, since any tuples added
     369              :      * while the scan is in progress will be invisible to my snapshot anyway.
     370              :      * (That is not true when using a non-MVCC snapshot.  However, we couldn't
     371              :      * guarantee to return tuples added after scan start anyway, since they
     372              :      * might go into pages we already scanned.  To guarantee consistent
     373              :      * results for a non-MVCC snapshot, the caller must hold some higher-level
     374              :      * lock that ensures the interesting tuple(s) won't change.)
     375              :      */
     376      1352856 :     if (scan->rs_base.rs_parallel != NULL)
     377              :     {
     378         4678 :         bpscan = (ParallelBlockTableScanDesc) scan->rs_base.rs_parallel;
     379         4678 :         scan->rs_nblocks = bpscan->phs_nblocks;
     380              :     }
     381              :     else
     382      1348178 :         scan->rs_nblocks = RelationGetNumberOfBlocks(scan->rs_base.rs_rd);
     383              : 
     384              :     /*
     385              :      * If the table is large relative to NBuffers, use a bulk-read access
     386              :      * strategy and enable synchronized scanning (see syncscan.c).  Although
     387              :      * the thresholds for these features could be different, we make them the
     388              :      * same so that there are only two behaviors to tune rather than four.
     389              :      * (However, some callers need to be able to disable one or both of these
     390              :      * behaviors, independently of the size of the table; also there is a GUC
     391              :      * variable that can disable synchronized scanning.)
     392              :      *
     393              :      * Note that table_block_parallelscan_initialize has a very similar test;
     394              :      * if you change this, consider changing that one, too.
     395              :      */
     396      1352854 :     if (!RelationUsesLocalBuffers(scan->rs_base.rs_rd) &&
     397      1343045 :         scan->rs_nblocks > NBuffers / 4)
     398              :     {
     399        14862 :         allow_strat = (scan->rs_base.rs_flags & SO_ALLOW_STRAT) != 0;
     400        14862 :         allow_sync = (scan->rs_base.rs_flags & SO_ALLOW_SYNC) != 0;
     401              :     }
     402              :     else
     403      1337992 :         allow_strat = allow_sync = false;
     404              : 
     405      1352854 :     if (allow_strat)
     406              :     {
     407              :         /* During a rescan, keep the previous strategy object. */
     408        13507 :         if (scan->rs_strategy == NULL)
     409        13312 :             scan->rs_strategy = GetAccessStrategy(BAS_BULKREAD);
     410              :     }
     411              :     else
     412              :     {
     413      1339347 :         if (scan->rs_strategy != NULL)
     414            0 :             FreeAccessStrategy(scan->rs_strategy);
     415      1339347 :         scan->rs_strategy = NULL;
     416              :     }
     417              : 
     418      1352854 :     if (scan->rs_base.rs_parallel != NULL)
     419              :     {
     420              :         /* For parallel scan, believe whatever ParallelTableScanDesc says. */
     421         4678 :         if (scan->rs_base.rs_parallel->phs_syncscan)
     422            5 :             scan->rs_base.rs_flags |= SO_ALLOW_SYNC;
     423              :         else
     424         4673 :             scan->rs_base.rs_flags &= ~SO_ALLOW_SYNC;
     425              : 
     426              :         /*
     427              :          * If not rescanning, initialize the startblock.  Finding the actual
     428              :          * start location is done in table_block_parallelscan_startblock_init,
     429              :          * based on whether an alternative start location has been set with
     430              :          * heap_setscanlimits, or using the syncscan location, when syncscan
     431              :          * is enabled.
     432              :          */
     433         4678 :         if (!keep_startblock)
     434         4526 :             scan->rs_startblock = InvalidBlockNumber;
     435              :     }
     436              :     else
     437              :     {
     438      1348176 :         if (keep_startblock)
     439              :         {
     440              :             /*
     441              :              * When rescanning, we want to keep the previous startblock
     442              :              * setting, so that rewinding a cursor doesn't generate surprising
     443              :              * results.  Reset the active syncscan setting, though.
     444              :              */
     445       862854 :             if (allow_sync && synchronize_seqscans)
     446           50 :                 scan->rs_base.rs_flags |= SO_ALLOW_SYNC;
     447              :             else
     448       862804 :                 scan->rs_base.rs_flags &= ~SO_ALLOW_SYNC;
     449              :         }
     450       485322 :         else if (allow_sync && synchronize_seqscans)
     451              :         {
     452           78 :             scan->rs_base.rs_flags |= SO_ALLOW_SYNC;
     453           78 :             scan->rs_startblock = ss_get_location(scan->rs_base.rs_rd, scan->rs_nblocks);
     454              :         }
     455              :         else
     456              :         {
     457       485244 :             scan->rs_base.rs_flags &= ~SO_ALLOW_SYNC;
     458       485244 :             scan->rs_startblock = 0;
     459              :         }
     460              :     }
     461              : 
     462      1352854 :     scan->rs_numblocks = InvalidBlockNumber;
     463      1352854 :     scan->rs_inited = false;
     464      1352854 :     scan->rs_ctup.t_data = NULL;
     465      1352854 :     ItemPointerSetInvalid(&scan->rs_ctup.t_self);
     466      1352854 :     scan->rs_cbuf = InvalidBuffer;
     467      1352854 :     scan->rs_cblock = InvalidBlockNumber;
     468      1352854 :     scan->rs_ntuples = 0;
     469      1352854 :     scan->rs_cindex = 0;
     470              : 
     471              :     /*
     472              :      * Initialize to ForwardScanDirection because it is most common and
     473              :      * because heap scans go forward before going backward (e.g. CURSORs).
     474              :      */
     475      1352854 :     scan->rs_dir = ForwardScanDirection;
     476      1352854 :     scan->rs_prefetch_block = InvalidBlockNumber;
     477              : 
     478              :     /* page-at-a-time fields are always invalid when not rs_inited */
     479              : 
     480              :     /*
     481              :      * copy the scan key, if appropriate
     482              :      */
     483      1352854 :     if (key != NULL && scan->rs_base.rs_nkeys > 0)
     484       268742 :         memcpy(scan->rs_base.rs_key, key, scan->rs_base.rs_nkeys * sizeof(ScanKeyData));
     485              : 
     486              :     /*
     487              :      * Currently, we only have a stats counter for sequential heap scans (but
     488              :      * e.g for bitmap scans the underlying bitmap index scans will be counted,
     489              :      * and for sample scans we update stats for tuple fetches).
     490              :      */
     491      1352854 :     if (scan->rs_base.rs_flags & SO_TYPE_SEQSCAN)
     492      1323902 :         pgstat_count_heap_scan(scan->rs_base.rs_rd);
     493      1352854 : }
     494              : 
     495              : /*
     496              :  * heap_setscanlimits - restrict range of a heapscan
     497              :  *
     498              :  * startBlk is the page to start at
     499              :  * numBlks is number of pages to scan (InvalidBlockNumber means "all")
     500              :  */
     501              : void
     502         3279 : heap_setscanlimits(TableScanDesc sscan, BlockNumber startBlk, BlockNumber numBlks)
     503              : {
     504         3279 :     HeapScanDesc scan = (HeapScanDesc) sscan;
     505              : 
     506              :     Assert(!scan->rs_inited);    /* else too late to change */
     507              :     /* else rs_startblock is significant */
     508              :     Assert(!(scan->rs_base.rs_flags & SO_ALLOW_SYNC));
     509              : 
     510              :     /* Check startBlk is valid (but allow case of zero blocks...) */
     511              :     Assert(startBlk == 0 || startBlk < scan->rs_nblocks);
     512              : 
     513         3279 :     scan->rs_startblock = startBlk;
     514         3279 :     scan->rs_numblocks = numBlks;
     515         3279 : }
     516              : 
     517              : /*
     518              :  * Per-tuple loop for heap_prepare_pagescan(). Pulled out so it can be called
     519              :  * multiple times, with constant arguments for all_visible,
     520              :  * check_serializable.
     521              :  */
     522              : pg_attribute_always_inline
     523              : static int
     524      3753111 : page_collect_tuples(HeapScanDesc scan, Snapshot snapshot,
     525              :                     Page page, Buffer buffer,
     526              :                     BlockNumber block, int lines,
     527              :                     bool all_visible, bool check_serializable)
     528              : {
     529      3753111 :     Oid         relid = RelationGetRelid(scan->rs_base.rs_rd);
     530      3753111 :     int         ntup = 0;
     531      3753111 :     int         nvis = 0;
     532              :     BatchMVCCState batchmvcc;
     533              : 
     534              :     /* page at a time should have been disabled otherwise */
     535              :     Assert(IsMVCCSnapshot(snapshot));
     536              : 
     537              :     /* first find all tuples on the page */
     538    202231837 :     for (OffsetNumber lineoff = FirstOffsetNumber; lineoff <= lines; lineoff++)
     539              :     {
     540    198478726 :         ItemId      lpp = PageGetItemId(page, lineoff);
     541              :         HeapTuple   tup;
     542              : 
     543    198478726 :         if (unlikely(!ItemIdIsNormal(lpp)))
     544     52366959 :             continue;
     545              : 
     546              :         /*
     547              :          * If the page is not all-visible or we need to check serializability,
     548              :          * maintain enough state to be able to refind the tuple efficiently,
     549              :          * without again first needing to fetch the item and then via that the
     550              :          * tuple.
     551              :          */
     552    146111767 :         if (!all_visible || check_serializable)
     553              :         {
     554     83301592 :             tup = &batchmvcc.tuples[ntup];
     555              : 
     556     83301592 :             tup->t_data = (HeapTupleHeader) PageGetItem(page, lpp);
     557     83301592 :             tup->t_len = ItemIdGetLength(lpp);
     558     83301592 :             tup->t_tableOid = relid;
     559     83301592 :             ItemPointerSet(&(tup->t_self), block, lineoff);
     560              :         }
     561              : 
     562              :         /*
     563              :          * If the page is all visible, these fields otherwise won't be
     564              :          * populated in loop below.
     565              :          */
     566    146111767 :         if (all_visible)
     567              :         {
     568     62810175 :             if (check_serializable)
     569              :             {
     570            0 :                 batchmvcc.visible[ntup] = true;
     571              :             }
     572     62810175 :             scan->rs_vistuples[ntup] = lineoff;
     573              :         }
     574              : 
     575    146111767 :         ntup++;
     576              :     }
     577              : 
     578              :     Assert(ntup <= MaxHeapTuplesPerPage);
     579              : 
     580              :     /*
     581              :      * Unless the page is all visible, test visibility for all tuples one go.
     582              :      * That is considerably more efficient than calling
     583              :      * HeapTupleSatisfiesMVCC() one-by-one.
     584              :      */
     585      3753111 :     if (all_visible)
     586      1334987 :         nvis = ntup;
     587              :     else
     588      2418124 :         nvis = HeapTupleSatisfiesMVCCBatch(snapshot, buffer,
     589              :                                            ntup,
     590              :                                            &batchmvcc,
     591      2418124 :                                            scan->rs_vistuples);
     592              : 
     593              :     /*
     594              :      * So far we don't have batch API for testing serializabilty, so do so
     595              :      * one-by-one.
     596              :      */
     597      3753111 :     if (check_serializable)
     598              :     {
     599         2087 :         for (int i = 0; i < ntup; i++)
     600              :         {
     601         1464 :             HeapCheckForSerializableConflictOut(batchmvcc.visible[i],
     602              :                                                 scan->rs_base.rs_rd,
     603              :                                                 &batchmvcc.tuples[i],
     604              :                                                 buffer, snapshot);
     605              :         }
     606              :     }
     607              : 
     608      3753103 :     return nvis;
     609              : }
     610              : 
     611              : /*
     612              :  * heap_prepare_pagescan - Prepare current scan page to be scanned in pagemode
     613              :  *
     614              :  * Preparation currently consists of 1. prune the scan's rs_cbuf page, and 2.
     615              :  * fill the rs_vistuples[] array with the OffsetNumbers of visible tuples.
     616              :  */
     617              : void
     618      3753111 : heap_prepare_pagescan(TableScanDesc sscan)
     619              : {
     620      3753111 :     HeapScanDesc scan = (HeapScanDesc) sscan;
     621      3753111 :     Buffer      buffer = scan->rs_cbuf;
     622      3753111 :     BlockNumber block = scan->rs_cblock;
     623              :     Snapshot    snapshot;
     624              :     Page        page;
     625              :     int         lines;
     626              :     bool        all_visible;
     627              :     bool        check_serializable;
     628              : 
     629              :     Assert(BufferGetBlockNumber(buffer) == block);
     630              : 
     631              :     /* ensure we're not accidentally being used when not in pagemode */
     632              :     Assert(scan->rs_base.rs_flags & SO_ALLOW_PAGEMODE);
     633      3753111 :     snapshot = scan->rs_base.rs_snapshot;
     634              : 
     635              :     /*
     636              :      * Prune and repair fragmentation for the whole page, if possible.
     637              :      */
     638      3753111 :     heap_page_prune_opt(scan->rs_base.rs_rd, buffer, &scan->rs_vmbuffer,
     639      3753111 :                         sscan->rs_flags & SO_HINT_REL_READ_ONLY);
     640              : 
     641              :     /*
     642              :      * We must hold share lock on the buffer content while examining tuple
     643              :      * visibility.  Afterwards, however, the tuples we have found to be
     644              :      * visible are guaranteed good as long as we hold the buffer pin.
     645              :      */
     646      3753111 :     LockBuffer(buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_SHARE);
     647              : 
     648      3753111 :     page = BufferGetPage(buffer);
     649      3753111 :     lines = PageGetMaxOffsetNumber(page);
     650              : 
     651              :     /*
     652              :      * If the all-visible flag indicates that all tuples on the page are
     653              :      * visible to everyone, we can skip the per-tuple visibility tests.
     654              :      *
     655              :      * Note: In hot standby, a tuple that's already visible to all
     656              :      * transactions on the primary might still be invisible to a read-only
     657              :      * transaction in the standby. We partly handle this problem by tracking
     658              :      * the minimum xmin of visible tuples as the cut-off XID while marking a
     659              :      * page all-visible on the primary and WAL log that along with the
     660              :      * visibility map SET operation. In hot standby, we wait for (or abort)
     661              :      * all transactions that can potentially may not see one or more tuples on
     662              :      * the page. That's how index-only scans work fine in hot standby. A
     663              :      * crucial difference between index-only scans and heap scans is that the
     664              :      * index-only scan completely relies on the visibility map where as heap
     665              :      * scan looks at the page-level PD_ALL_VISIBLE flag. We are not sure if
     666              :      * the page-level flag can be trusted in the same way, because it might
     667              :      * get propagated somehow without being explicitly WAL-logged, e.g. via a
     668              :      * full page write. Until we can prove that beyond doubt, let's check each
     669              :      * tuple for visibility the hard way.
     670              :      */
     671      3753111 :     all_visible = PageIsAllVisible(page) && !snapshot->takenDuringRecovery;
     672              :     check_serializable =
     673      3753111 :         CheckForSerializableConflictOutNeeded(scan->rs_base.rs_rd, snapshot);
     674              : 
     675              :     /*
     676              :      * We call page_collect_tuples() with constant arguments, to get the
     677              :      * compiler to constant fold the constant arguments. Separate calls with
     678              :      * constant arguments, rather than variables, are needed on several
     679              :      * compilers to actually perform constant folding.
     680              :      */
     681      3753111 :     if (likely(all_visible))
     682              :     {
     683      1334987 :         if (likely(!check_serializable))
     684      1334987 :             scan->rs_ntuples = page_collect_tuples(scan, snapshot, page, buffer,
     685              :                                                    block, lines, true, false);
     686              :         else
     687            0 :             scan->rs_ntuples = page_collect_tuples(scan, snapshot, page, buffer,
     688              :                                                    block, lines, true, true);
     689              :     }
     690              :     else
     691              :     {
     692      2418124 :         if (likely(!check_serializable))
     693      2417493 :             scan->rs_ntuples = page_collect_tuples(scan, snapshot, page, buffer,
     694              :                                                    block, lines, false, false);
     695              :         else
     696          631 :             scan->rs_ntuples = page_collect_tuples(scan, snapshot, page, buffer,
     697              :                                                    block, lines, false, true);
     698              :     }
     699              : 
     700      3753103 :     LockBuffer(buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_UNLOCK);
     701      3753103 : }
     702              : 
     703              : /*
     704              :  * heap_fetch_next_buffer - read and pin the next block from MAIN_FORKNUM.
     705              :  *
     706              :  * Read the next block of the scan relation from the read stream and save it
     707              :  * in the scan descriptor.  It is already pinned.
     708              :  */
     709              : static inline void
     710      4989874 : heap_fetch_next_buffer(HeapScanDesc scan, ScanDirection dir)
     711              : {
     712              :     Assert(scan->rs_read_stream);
     713              : 
     714              :     /* release previous scan buffer, if any */
     715      4989874 :     if (BufferIsValid(scan->rs_cbuf))
     716              :     {
     717      3666530 :         ReleaseBuffer(scan->rs_cbuf);
     718      3666530 :         scan->rs_cbuf = InvalidBuffer;
     719              :     }
     720              : 
     721              :     /*
     722              :      * Be sure to check for interrupts at least once per page.  Checks at
     723              :      * higher code levels won't be able to stop a seqscan that encounters many
     724              :      * pages' worth of consecutive dead tuples.
     725              :      */
     726      4989874 :     CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS();
     727              : 
     728              :     /*
     729              :      * If the scan direction is changing, reset the prefetch block to the
     730              :      * current block. Otherwise, we will incorrectly prefetch the blocks
     731              :      * between the prefetch block and the current block again before
     732              :      * prefetching blocks in the new, correct scan direction.
     733              :      */
     734      4989874 :     if (unlikely(scan->rs_dir != dir))
     735              :     {
     736          102 :         scan->rs_prefetch_block = scan->rs_cblock;
     737          102 :         read_stream_reset(scan->rs_read_stream);
     738              :     }
     739              : 
     740      4989874 :     scan->rs_dir = dir;
     741              : 
     742      4989874 :     scan->rs_cbuf = read_stream_next_buffer(scan->rs_read_stream, NULL);
     743      4989847 :     if (BufferIsValid(scan->rs_cbuf))
     744      3863573 :         scan->rs_cblock = BufferGetBlockNumber(scan->rs_cbuf);
     745      4989847 : }
     746              : 
     747              : /*
     748              :  * heapgettup_initial_block - return the first BlockNumber to scan
     749              :  *
     750              :  * Returns InvalidBlockNumber when there are no blocks to scan.  This can
     751              :  * occur with empty tables and in parallel scans when parallel workers get all
     752              :  * of the pages before we can get a chance to get our first page.
     753              :  */
     754              : static pg_noinline BlockNumber
     755      1320561 : heapgettup_initial_block(HeapScanDesc scan, ScanDirection dir)
     756              : {
     757              :     Assert(!scan->rs_inited);
     758              :     Assert(scan->rs_base.rs_parallel == NULL);
     759              : 
     760              :     /* When there are no pages to scan, return InvalidBlockNumber */
     761      1320561 :     if (scan->rs_nblocks == 0 || scan->rs_numblocks == 0)
     762       760754 :         return InvalidBlockNumber;
     763              : 
     764       559807 :     if (ScanDirectionIsForward(dir))
     765              :     {
     766       559765 :         return scan->rs_startblock;
     767              :     }
     768              :     else
     769              :     {
     770              :         /*
     771              :          * Disable reporting to syncscan logic in a backwards scan; it's not
     772              :          * very likely anyone else is doing the same thing at the same time,
     773              :          * and much more likely that we'll just bollix things for forward
     774              :          * scanners.
     775              :          */
     776           42 :         scan->rs_base.rs_flags &= ~SO_ALLOW_SYNC;
     777              : 
     778              :         /*
     779              :          * Start from last page of the scan.  Ensure we take into account
     780              :          * rs_numblocks if it's been adjusted by heap_setscanlimits().
     781              :          */
     782           42 :         if (scan->rs_numblocks != InvalidBlockNumber)
     783            4 :             return (scan->rs_startblock + scan->rs_numblocks - 1) % scan->rs_nblocks;
     784              : 
     785           38 :         if (scan->rs_startblock > 0)
     786            0 :             return scan->rs_startblock - 1;
     787              : 
     788           38 :         return scan->rs_nblocks - 1;
     789              :     }
     790              : }
     791              : 
     792              : 
     793              : /*
     794              :  * heapgettup_start_page - helper function for heapgettup()
     795              :  *
     796              :  * Return the next page to scan based on the scan->rs_cbuf and set *linesleft
     797              :  * to the number of tuples on this page.  Also set *lineoff to the first
     798              :  * offset to scan with forward scans getting the first offset and backward
     799              :  * getting the final offset on the page.
     800              :  */
     801              : static Page
     802       116146 : heapgettup_start_page(HeapScanDesc scan, ScanDirection dir, int *linesleft,
     803              :                       OffsetNumber *lineoff)
     804              : {
     805              :     Page        page;
     806              : 
     807              :     Assert(scan->rs_inited);
     808              :     Assert(BufferIsValid(scan->rs_cbuf));
     809              : 
     810              :     /* Caller is responsible for ensuring buffer is locked if needed */
     811       116146 :     page = BufferGetPage(scan->rs_cbuf);
     812              : 
     813       116146 :     *linesleft = PageGetMaxOffsetNumber(page) - FirstOffsetNumber + 1;
     814              : 
     815       116146 :     if (ScanDirectionIsForward(dir))
     816       116146 :         *lineoff = FirstOffsetNumber;
     817              :     else
     818            0 :         *lineoff = (OffsetNumber) (*linesleft);
     819              : 
     820              :     /* lineoff now references the physically previous or next tid */
     821       116146 :     return page;
     822              : }
     823              : 
     824              : 
     825              : /*
     826              :  * heapgettup_continue_page - helper function for heapgettup()
     827              :  *
     828              :  * Return the next page to scan based on the scan->rs_cbuf and set *linesleft
     829              :  * to the number of tuples left to scan on this page.  Also set *lineoff to
     830              :  * the next offset to scan according to the ScanDirection in 'dir'.
     831              :  */
     832              : static inline Page
     833      9258225 : heapgettup_continue_page(HeapScanDesc scan, ScanDirection dir, int *linesleft,
     834              :                          OffsetNumber *lineoff)
     835              : {
     836              :     Page        page;
     837              : 
     838              :     Assert(scan->rs_inited);
     839              :     Assert(BufferIsValid(scan->rs_cbuf));
     840              : 
     841              :     /* Caller is responsible for ensuring buffer is locked if needed */
     842      9258225 :     page = BufferGetPage(scan->rs_cbuf);
     843              : 
     844      9258225 :     if (ScanDirectionIsForward(dir))
     845              :     {
     846      9258225 :         *lineoff = OffsetNumberNext(scan->rs_coffset);
     847      9258225 :         *linesleft = PageGetMaxOffsetNumber(page) - (*lineoff) + 1;
     848              :     }
     849              :     else
     850              :     {
     851              :         /*
     852              :          * The previous returned tuple may have been vacuumed since the
     853              :          * previous scan when we use a non-MVCC snapshot, so we must
     854              :          * re-establish the lineoff <= PageGetMaxOffsetNumber(page) invariant
     855              :          */
     856            0 :         *lineoff = Min(PageGetMaxOffsetNumber(page), OffsetNumberPrev(scan->rs_coffset));
     857            0 :         *linesleft = *lineoff;
     858              :     }
     859              : 
     860              :     /* lineoff now references the physically previous or next tid */
     861      9258225 :     return page;
     862              : }
     863              : 
     864              : /*
     865              :  * heapgettup_advance_block - helper for heap_fetch_next_buffer()
     866              :  *
     867              :  * Given the current block number, the scan direction, and various information
     868              :  * contained in the scan descriptor, calculate the BlockNumber to scan next
     869              :  * and return it.  If there are no further blocks to scan, return
     870              :  * InvalidBlockNumber to indicate this fact to the caller.
     871              :  *
     872              :  * This should not be called to determine the initial block number -- only for
     873              :  * subsequent blocks.
     874              :  *
     875              :  * This also adjusts rs_numblocks when a limit has been imposed by
     876              :  * heap_setscanlimits().
     877              :  */
     878              : static inline BlockNumber
     879      3740848 : heapgettup_advance_block(HeapScanDesc scan, BlockNumber block, ScanDirection dir)
     880              : {
     881              :     Assert(scan->rs_base.rs_parallel == NULL);
     882              : 
     883      3740848 :     if (likely(ScanDirectionIsForward(dir)))
     884              :     {
     885      3740770 :         block++;
     886              : 
     887              :         /* wrap back to the start of the heap */
     888      3740770 :         if (block >= scan->rs_nblocks)
     889       438525 :             block = 0;
     890              : 
     891              :         /*
     892              :          * Report our new scan position for synchronization purposes. We don't
     893              :          * do that when moving backwards, however. That would just mess up any
     894              :          * other forward-moving scanners.
     895              :          *
     896              :          * Note: we do this before checking for end of scan so that the final
     897              :          * state of the position hint is back at the start of the rel.  That's
     898              :          * not strictly necessary, but otherwise when you run the same query
     899              :          * multiple times the starting position would shift a little bit
     900              :          * backwards on every invocation, which is confusing. We don't
     901              :          * guarantee any specific ordering in general, though.
     902              :          */
     903      3740770 :         if (scan->rs_base.rs_flags & SO_ALLOW_SYNC)
     904        38364 :             ss_report_location(scan->rs_base.rs_rd, block);
     905              : 
     906              :         /* we're done if we're back at where we started */
     907      3740770 :         if (block == scan->rs_startblock)
     908       438475 :             return InvalidBlockNumber;
     909              : 
     910              :         /* check if the limit imposed by heap_setscanlimits() is met */
     911      3302295 :         if (scan->rs_numblocks != InvalidBlockNumber)
     912              :         {
     913         2818 :             if (--scan->rs_numblocks == 0)
     914         1590 :                 return InvalidBlockNumber;
     915              :         }
     916              : 
     917      3300705 :         return block;
     918              :     }
     919              :     else
     920              :     {
     921              :         /* we're done if the last block is the start position */
     922           78 :         if (block == scan->rs_startblock)
     923           78 :             return InvalidBlockNumber;
     924              : 
     925              :         /* check if the limit imposed by heap_setscanlimits() is met */
     926            0 :         if (scan->rs_numblocks != InvalidBlockNumber)
     927              :         {
     928            0 :             if (--scan->rs_numblocks == 0)
     929            0 :                 return InvalidBlockNumber;
     930              :         }
     931              : 
     932              :         /* wrap to the end of the heap when the last page was page 0 */
     933            0 :         if (block == 0)
     934            0 :             block = scan->rs_nblocks;
     935              : 
     936            0 :         block--;
     937              : 
     938            0 :         return block;
     939              :     }
     940              : }
     941              : 
     942              : /* ----------------
     943              :  *      heapgettup - fetch next heap tuple
     944              :  *
     945              :  *      Initialize the scan if not already done; then advance to the next
     946              :  *      tuple as indicated by "dir"; return the next tuple in scan->rs_ctup,
     947              :  *      or set scan->rs_ctup.t_data = NULL if no more tuples.
     948              :  *
     949              :  * Note: the reason nkeys/key are passed separately, even though they are
     950              :  * kept in the scan descriptor, is that the caller may not want us to check
     951              :  * the scankeys.
     952              :  *
     953              :  * Note: when we fall off the end of the scan in either direction, we
     954              :  * reset rs_inited.  This means that a further request with the same
     955              :  * scan direction will restart the scan, which is a bit odd, but a
     956              :  * request with the opposite scan direction will start a fresh scan
     957              :  * in the proper direction.  The latter is required behavior for cursors,
     958              :  * while the former case is generally undefined behavior in Postgres
     959              :  * so we don't care too much.
     960              :  * ----------------
     961              :  */
     962              : static void
     963      9285289 : heapgettup(HeapScanDesc scan,
     964              :            ScanDirection dir,
     965              :            int nkeys,
     966              :            ScanKey key)
     967              : {
     968      9285289 :     HeapTuple   tuple = &(scan->rs_ctup);
     969              :     Page        page;
     970              :     OffsetNumber lineoff;
     971              :     int         linesleft;
     972              : 
     973      9285289 :     if (likely(scan->rs_inited))
     974              :     {
     975              :         /* continue from previously returned page/tuple */
     976      9258225 :         LockBuffer(scan->rs_cbuf, BUFFER_LOCK_SHARE);
     977      9258225 :         page = heapgettup_continue_page(scan, dir, &linesleft, &lineoff);
     978      9258225 :         goto continue_page;
     979              :     }
     980              : 
     981              :     /*
     982              :      * advance the scan until we find a qualifying tuple or run out of stuff
     983              :      * to scan
     984              :      */
     985              :     while (true)
     986              :     {
     987       142328 :         heap_fetch_next_buffer(scan, dir);
     988              : 
     989              :         /* did we run out of blocks to scan? */
     990       142328 :         if (!BufferIsValid(scan->rs_cbuf))
     991        26182 :             break;
     992              : 
     993              :         Assert(BufferGetBlockNumber(scan->rs_cbuf) == scan->rs_cblock);
     994              : 
     995       116146 :         LockBuffer(scan->rs_cbuf, BUFFER_LOCK_SHARE);
     996       116146 :         page = heapgettup_start_page(scan, dir, &linesleft, &lineoff);
     997      9374371 : continue_page:
     998              : 
     999              :         /*
    1000              :          * Only continue scanning the page while we have lines left.
    1001              :          *
    1002              :          * Note that this protects us from accessing line pointers past
    1003              :          * PageGetMaxOffsetNumber(); both for forward scans when we resume the
    1004              :          * table scan, and for when we start scanning a new page.
    1005              :          */
    1006      9441864 :         for (; linesleft > 0; linesleft--, lineoff += dir)
    1007              :         {
    1008              :             bool        visible;
    1009      9326600 :             ItemId      lpp = PageGetItemId(page, lineoff);
    1010              : 
    1011      9326600 :             if (!ItemIdIsNormal(lpp))
    1012        45754 :                 continue;
    1013              : 
    1014      9280846 :             tuple->t_data = (HeapTupleHeader) PageGetItem(page, lpp);
    1015      9280846 :             tuple->t_len = ItemIdGetLength(lpp);
    1016      9280846 :             ItemPointerSet(&(tuple->t_self), scan->rs_cblock, lineoff);
    1017              : 
    1018      9280846 :             visible = HeapTupleSatisfiesVisibility(tuple,
    1019              :                                                    scan->rs_base.rs_snapshot,
    1020              :                                                    scan->rs_cbuf);
    1021              : 
    1022      9280846 :             HeapCheckForSerializableConflictOut(visible, scan->rs_base.rs_rd,
    1023              :                                                 tuple, scan->rs_cbuf,
    1024              :                                                 scan->rs_base.rs_snapshot);
    1025              : 
    1026              :             /* skip tuples not visible to this snapshot */
    1027      9280846 :             if (!visible)
    1028         7362 :                 continue;
    1029              : 
    1030              :             /* skip any tuples that don't match the scan key */
    1031      9273484 :             if (key != NULL &&
    1032        15106 :                 !HeapKeyTest(tuple, RelationGetDescr(scan->rs_base.rs_rd),
    1033              :                              nkeys, key))
    1034        14377 :                 continue;
    1035              : 
    1036      9259107 :             LockBuffer(scan->rs_cbuf, BUFFER_LOCK_UNLOCK);
    1037      9259107 :             scan->rs_coffset = lineoff;
    1038      9259107 :             return;
    1039              :         }
    1040              : 
    1041              :         /*
    1042              :          * if we get here, it means we've exhausted the items on this page and
    1043              :          * it's time to move to the next.
    1044              :          */
    1045       115264 :         LockBuffer(scan->rs_cbuf, BUFFER_LOCK_UNLOCK);
    1046              :     }
    1047              : 
    1048              :     /* end of scan */
    1049        26182 :     if (BufferIsValid(scan->rs_cbuf))
    1050            0 :         ReleaseBuffer(scan->rs_cbuf);
    1051              : 
    1052        26182 :     scan->rs_cbuf = InvalidBuffer;
    1053        26182 :     scan->rs_cblock = InvalidBlockNumber;
    1054        26182 :     scan->rs_prefetch_block = InvalidBlockNumber;
    1055        26182 :     tuple->t_data = NULL;
    1056        26182 :     scan->rs_inited = false;
    1057              : }
    1058              : 
    1059              : /* ----------------
    1060              :  *      heapgettup_pagemode - fetch next heap tuple in page-at-a-time mode
    1061              :  *
    1062              :  *      Same API as heapgettup, but used in page-at-a-time mode
    1063              :  *
    1064              :  * The internal logic is much the same as heapgettup's too, but there are some
    1065              :  * differences: we do not take the buffer content lock (that only needs to
    1066              :  * happen inside heap_prepare_pagescan), and we iterate through just the
    1067              :  * tuples listed in rs_vistuples[] rather than all tuples on the page.  Notice
    1068              :  * that lineindex is 0-based, where the corresponding loop variable lineoff in
    1069              :  * heapgettup is 1-based.
    1070              :  * ----------------
    1071              :  */
    1072              : static void
    1073     69984125 : heapgettup_pagemode(HeapScanDesc scan,
    1074              :                     ScanDirection dir,
    1075              :                     int nkeys,
    1076              :                     ScanKey key)
    1077              : {
    1078     69984125 :     HeapTuple   tuple = &(scan->rs_ctup);
    1079              :     Page        page;
    1080              :     uint32      lineindex;
    1081              :     uint32      linesleft;
    1082              : 
    1083     69984125 :     if (likely(scan->rs_inited))
    1084              :     {
    1085              :         /* continue from previously returned page/tuple */
    1086     68687845 :         page = BufferGetPage(scan->rs_cbuf);
    1087              : 
    1088     68687845 :         lineindex = scan->rs_cindex + dir;
    1089     68687845 :         if (ScanDirectionIsForward(dir))
    1090     68687407 :             linesleft = scan->rs_ntuples - lineindex;
    1091              :         else
    1092          438 :             linesleft = scan->rs_cindex;
    1093              :         /* lineindex now references the next or previous visible tid */
    1094              : 
    1095     68687845 :         goto continue_page;
    1096              :     }
    1097              : 
    1098              :     /*
    1099              :      * advance the scan until we find a qualifying tuple or run out of stuff
    1100              :      * to scan
    1101              :      */
    1102              :     while (true)
    1103              :     {
    1104      4847546 :         heap_fetch_next_buffer(scan, dir);
    1105              : 
    1106              :         /* did we run out of blocks to scan? */
    1107      4847519 :         if (!BufferIsValid(scan->rs_cbuf))
    1108      1100092 :             break;
    1109              : 
    1110              :         Assert(BufferGetBlockNumber(scan->rs_cbuf) == scan->rs_cblock);
    1111              : 
    1112              :         /* prune the page and determine visible tuple offsets */
    1113      3747427 :         heap_prepare_pagescan((TableScanDesc) scan);
    1114      3747419 :         page = BufferGetPage(scan->rs_cbuf);
    1115      3747419 :         linesleft = scan->rs_ntuples;
    1116      3747419 :         lineindex = ScanDirectionIsForward(dir) ? 0 : linesleft - 1;
    1117              : 
    1118              :         /* block is the same for all tuples, set it once outside the loop */
    1119      3747419 :         ItemPointerSetBlockNumber(&tuple->t_self, scan->rs_cblock);
    1120              : 
    1121              :         /* lineindex now references the next or previous visible tid */
    1122     72435264 : continue_page:
    1123              : 
    1124    134158396 :         for (; linesleft > 0; linesleft--, lineindex += dir)
    1125              :         {
    1126              :             ItemId      lpp;
    1127              :             OffsetNumber lineoff;
    1128              : 
    1129              :             Assert(lineindex < scan->rs_ntuples);
    1130    130607130 :             lineoff = scan->rs_vistuples[lineindex];
    1131    130607130 :             lpp = PageGetItemId(page, lineoff);
    1132              :             Assert(ItemIdIsNormal(lpp));
    1133              : 
    1134    130607130 :             tuple->t_data = (HeapTupleHeader) PageGetItem(page, lpp);
    1135    130607130 :             tuple->t_len = ItemIdGetLength(lpp);
    1136    130607130 :             ItemPointerSetOffsetNumber(&tuple->t_self, lineoff);
    1137              : 
    1138              :             /* skip any tuples that don't match the scan key */
    1139    130607130 :             if (key != NULL &&
    1140     62165641 :                 !HeapKeyTest(tuple, RelationGetDescr(scan->rs_base.rs_rd),
    1141              :                              nkeys, key))
    1142     61723132 :                 continue;
    1143              : 
    1144     68883998 :             scan->rs_cindex = lineindex;
    1145     68883998 :             return;
    1146              :         }
    1147              :     }
    1148              : 
    1149              :     /* end of scan */
    1150      1100092 :     if (BufferIsValid(scan->rs_cbuf))
    1151            0 :         ReleaseBuffer(scan->rs_cbuf);
    1152      1100092 :     scan->rs_cbuf = InvalidBuffer;
    1153      1100092 :     scan->rs_cblock = InvalidBlockNumber;
    1154      1100092 :     scan->rs_prefetch_block = InvalidBlockNumber;
    1155      1100092 :     tuple->t_data = NULL;
    1156      1100092 :     scan->rs_inited = false;
    1157              : }
    1158              : 
    1159              : 
    1160              : /* ----------------------------------------------------------------
    1161              :  *                   heap access method interface
    1162              :  * ----------------------------------------------------------------
    1163              :  */
    1164              : 
    1165              : 
    1166              : TableScanDesc
    1167       489850 : heap_beginscan(Relation relation, Snapshot snapshot,
    1168              :                int nkeys, ScanKey key,
    1169              :                ParallelTableScanDesc parallel_scan,
    1170              :                uint32 flags)
    1171              : {
    1172              :     HeapScanDesc scan;
    1173              : 
    1174              :     /*
    1175              :      * increment relation ref count while scanning relation
    1176              :      *
    1177              :      * This is just to make really sure the relcache entry won't go away while
    1178              :      * the scan has a pointer to it.  Caller should be holding the rel open
    1179              :      * anyway, so this is redundant in all normal scenarios...
    1180              :      */
    1181       489850 :     RelationIncrementReferenceCount(relation);
    1182              : 
    1183              :     /*
    1184              :      * allocate and initialize scan descriptor
    1185              :      */
    1186       489850 :     if (flags & SO_TYPE_BITMAPSCAN)
    1187              :     {
    1188        13663 :         BitmapHeapScanDesc bscan = palloc_object(BitmapHeapScanDescData);
    1189              : 
    1190              :         /*
    1191              :          * Bitmap Heap scans do not have any fields that a normal Heap Scan
    1192              :          * does not have, so no special initializations required here.
    1193              :          */
    1194        13663 :         scan = (HeapScanDesc) bscan;
    1195              :     }
    1196              :     else
    1197       476187 :         scan = (HeapScanDesc) palloc_object(HeapScanDescData);
    1198              : 
    1199       489850 :     scan->rs_base.rs_rd = relation;
    1200       489850 :     scan->rs_base.rs_snapshot = snapshot;
    1201       489850 :     scan->rs_base.rs_nkeys = nkeys;
    1202       489850 :     scan->rs_base.rs_flags = flags;
    1203       489850 :     scan->rs_base.rs_parallel = parallel_scan;
    1204       489850 :     scan->rs_base.rs_instrument = NULL;
    1205       489850 :     scan->rs_strategy = NULL;    /* set in initscan */
    1206       489850 :     scan->rs_cbuf = InvalidBuffer;
    1207              : 
    1208              :     /*
    1209              :      * Disable page-at-a-time mode if it's not a MVCC-safe snapshot.
    1210              :      */
    1211       489850 :     if (!(snapshot && IsMVCCSnapshot(snapshot)))
    1212        37976 :         scan->rs_base.rs_flags &= ~SO_ALLOW_PAGEMODE;
    1213              : 
    1214              :     /* Check that a historic snapshot is not used for non-catalog tables */
    1215       489850 :     if (snapshot &&
    1216       478938 :         IsHistoricMVCCSnapshot(snapshot) &&
    1217          729 :         !RelationIsAccessibleInLogicalDecoding(relation))
    1218              :     {
    1219            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    1220              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_TRANSACTION_STATE),
    1221              :                  errmsg("cannot query non-catalog table \"%s\" during logical decoding",
    1222              :                         RelationGetRelationName(relation))));
    1223              :     }
    1224              : 
    1225              :     /*
    1226              :      * For seqscan and sample scans in a serializable transaction, acquire a
    1227              :      * predicate lock on the entire relation. This is required not only to
    1228              :      * lock all the matching tuples, but also to conflict with new insertions
    1229              :      * into the table. In an indexscan, we take page locks on the index pages
    1230              :      * covering the range specified in the scan qual, but in a heap scan there
    1231              :      * is nothing more fine-grained to lock. A bitmap scan is a different
    1232              :      * story, there we have already scanned the index and locked the index
    1233              :      * pages covering the predicate. But in that case we still have to lock
    1234              :      * any matching heap tuples. For sample scan we could optimize the locking
    1235              :      * to be at least page-level granularity, but we'd need to add per-tuple
    1236              :      * locking for that.
    1237              :      */
    1238       489850 :     if (scan->rs_base.rs_flags & (SO_TYPE_SEQSCAN | SO_TYPE_SAMPLESCAN))
    1239              :     {
    1240              :         /*
    1241              :          * Ensure a missing snapshot is noticed reliably, even if the
    1242              :          * isolation mode means predicate locking isn't performed (and
    1243              :          * therefore the snapshot isn't used here).
    1244              :          */
    1245              :         Assert(snapshot);
    1246       463479 :         PredicateLockRelation(relation, snapshot);
    1247              :     }
    1248              : 
    1249              :     /* we only need to set this up once */
    1250       489850 :     scan->rs_ctup.t_tableOid = RelationGetRelid(relation);
    1251              : 
    1252              :     /*
    1253              :      * Allocate memory to keep track of page allocation for parallel workers
    1254              :      * when doing a parallel scan.
    1255              :      */
    1256       489850 :     if (parallel_scan != NULL)
    1257         4526 :         scan->rs_parallelworkerdata = palloc_object(ParallelBlockTableScanWorkerData);
    1258              :     else
    1259       485324 :         scan->rs_parallelworkerdata = NULL;
    1260              : 
    1261              :     /*
    1262              :      * we do this here instead of in initscan() because heap_rescan also calls
    1263              :      * initscan() and we don't want to allocate memory again
    1264              :      */
    1265       489850 :     if (nkeys > 0)
    1266       268742 :         scan->rs_base.rs_key = palloc_array(ScanKeyData, nkeys);
    1267              :     else
    1268       221108 :         scan->rs_base.rs_key = NULL;
    1269              : 
    1270       489850 :     initscan(scan, key, false);
    1271              : 
    1272       489848 :     scan->rs_read_stream = NULL;
    1273              : 
    1274              :     /*
    1275              :      * Set up a read stream for sequential scans and TID range scans. This
    1276              :      * should be done after initscan() because initscan() allocates the
    1277              :      * BufferAccessStrategy object passed to the read stream API.
    1278              :      */
    1279       489848 :     if (scan->rs_base.rs_flags & SO_TYPE_SEQSCAN ||
    1280        26465 :         scan->rs_base.rs_flags & SO_TYPE_TIDRANGESCAN)
    1281       464697 :     {
    1282              :         ReadStreamBlockNumberCB cb;
    1283              : 
    1284       464697 :         if (scan->rs_base.rs_parallel)
    1285         4526 :             cb = heap_scan_stream_read_next_parallel;
    1286              :         else
    1287       460171 :             cb = heap_scan_stream_read_next_serial;
    1288              : 
    1289              :         /* ---
    1290              :          * It is safe to use batchmode as the only locks taken by `cb`
    1291              :          * are never taken while waiting for IO:
    1292              :          * - SyncScanLock is used in the non-parallel case
    1293              :          * - in the parallel case, only spinlocks and atomics are used
    1294              :          * ---
    1295              :          */
    1296       464697 :         scan->rs_read_stream = read_stream_begin_relation(READ_STREAM_SEQUENTIAL |
    1297              :                                                           READ_STREAM_USE_BATCHING,
    1298              :                                                           scan->rs_strategy,
    1299              :                                                           scan->rs_base.rs_rd,
    1300              :                                                           MAIN_FORKNUM,
    1301              :                                                           cb,
    1302              :                                                           scan,
    1303              :                                                           0);
    1304              :     }
    1305        25151 :     else if (scan->rs_base.rs_flags & SO_TYPE_BITMAPSCAN)
    1306              :     {
    1307        13663 :         scan->rs_read_stream = read_stream_begin_relation(READ_STREAM_DEFAULT |
    1308              :                                                           READ_STREAM_USE_BATCHING,
    1309              :                                                           scan->rs_strategy,
    1310              :                                                           scan->rs_base.rs_rd,
    1311              :                                                           MAIN_FORKNUM,
    1312              :                                                           bitmapheap_stream_read_next,
    1313              :                                                           scan,
    1314              :                                                           sizeof(TBMIterateResult));
    1315              :     }
    1316              : 
    1317              :     /* enable read stream instrumentation */
    1318       489848 :     if ((flags & SO_SCAN_INSTRUMENT) && (scan->rs_read_stream != NULL))
    1319              :     {
    1320            8 :         scan->rs_base.rs_instrument = palloc0_object(TableScanInstrumentation);
    1321            8 :         read_stream_enable_stats(scan->rs_read_stream,
    1322            8 :                                  &scan->rs_base.rs_instrument->io);
    1323              :     }
    1324              : 
    1325       489848 :     scan->rs_vmbuffer = InvalidBuffer;
    1326              : 
    1327       489848 :     return (TableScanDesc) scan;
    1328              : }
    1329              : 
    1330              : void
    1331       863006 : heap_rescan(TableScanDesc sscan, ScanKey key, bool set_params,
    1332              :             bool allow_strat, bool allow_sync, bool allow_pagemode)
    1333              : {
    1334       863006 :     HeapScanDesc scan = (HeapScanDesc) sscan;
    1335              : 
    1336       863006 :     if (set_params)
    1337              :     {
    1338           19 :         if (allow_strat)
    1339           19 :             scan->rs_base.rs_flags |= SO_ALLOW_STRAT;
    1340              :         else
    1341            0 :             scan->rs_base.rs_flags &= ~SO_ALLOW_STRAT;
    1342              : 
    1343           19 :         if (allow_sync)
    1344            8 :             scan->rs_base.rs_flags |= SO_ALLOW_SYNC;
    1345              :         else
    1346           11 :             scan->rs_base.rs_flags &= ~SO_ALLOW_SYNC;
    1347              : 
    1348           19 :         if (allow_pagemode && scan->rs_base.rs_snapshot &&
    1349           19 :             IsMVCCSnapshot(scan->rs_base.rs_snapshot))
    1350           19 :             scan->rs_base.rs_flags |= SO_ALLOW_PAGEMODE;
    1351              :         else
    1352            0 :             scan->rs_base.rs_flags &= ~SO_ALLOW_PAGEMODE;
    1353              :     }
    1354              : 
    1355              :     /*
    1356              :      * unpin scan buffers
    1357              :      */
    1358       863006 :     if (BufferIsValid(scan->rs_cbuf))
    1359              :     {
    1360         3023 :         ReleaseBuffer(scan->rs_cbuf);
    1361         3023 :         scan->rs_cbuf = InvalidBuffer;
    1362              :     }
    1363              : 
    1364       863006 :     if (BufferIsValid(scan->rs_vmbuffer))
    1365              :     {
    1366           18 :         ReleaseBuffer(scan->rs_vmbuffer);
    1367           18 :         scan->rs_vmbuffer = InvalidBuffer;
    1368              :     }
    1369              : 
    1370              :     /*
    1371              :      * SO_TYPE_BITMAPSCAN would be cleaned up here, but it does not hold any
    1372              :      * additional data vs a normal HeapScan
    1373              :      */
    1374              : 
    1375              :     /*
    1376              :      * The read stream is reset on rescan. This must be done before
    1377              :      * initscan(), as some state referred to by read_stream_reset() is reset
    1378              :      * in initscan().
    1379              :      */
    1380       863006 :     if (scan->rs_read_stream)
    1381       862983 :         read_stream_reset(scan->rs_read_stream);
    1382              : 
    1383              :     /*
    1384              :      * reinitialize scan descriptor
    1385              :      */
    1386       863006 :     initscan(scan, key, true);
    1387       863006 : }
    1388              : 
    1389              : void
    1390       486565 : heap_endscan(TableScanDesc sscan)
    1391              : {
    1392       486565 :     HeapScanDesc scan = (HeapScanDesc) sscan;
    1393              : 
    1394              :     /* Note: no locking manipulations needed */
    1395              : 
    1396              :     /*
    1397              :      * unpin scan buffers
    1398              :      */
    1399       486565 :     if (BufferIsValid(scan->rs_cbuf))
    1400       191784 :         ReleaseBuffer(scan->rs_cbuf);
    1401              : 
    1402       486565 :     if (BufferIsValid(scan->rs_vmbuffer))
    1403         2899 :         ReleaseBuffer(scan->rs_vmbuffer);
    1404              : 
    1405              :     /*
    1406              :      * Must free the read stream before freeing the BufferAccessStrategy.
    1407              :      */
    1408       486565 :     if (scan->rs_read_stream)
    1409       475144 :         read_stream_end(scan->rs_read_stream);
    1410              : 
    1411              :     /*
    1412              :      * decrement relation reference count and free scan descriptor storage
    1413              :      */
    1414       486565 :     RelationDecrementReferenceCount(scan->rs_base.rs_rd);
    1415              : 
    1416       486565 :     if (scan->rs_base.rs_key)
    1417       268707 :         pfree(scan->rs_base.rs_key);
    1418              : 
    1419       486565 :     if (scan->rs_strategy != NULL)
    1420        13303 :         FreeAccessStrategy(scan->rs_strategy);
    1421              : 
    1422       486565 :     if (scan->rs_parallelworkerdata != NULL)
    1423         4526 :         pfree(scan->rs_parallelworkerdata);
    1424              : 
    1425       486565 :     if (scan->rs_base.rs_flags & SO_TEMP_SNAPSHOT)
    1426        51110 :         UnregisterSnapshot(scan->rs_base.rs_snapshot);
    1427              : 
    1428       486565 :     if (scan->rs_base.rs_instrument)
    1429            8 :         pfree(scan->rs_base.rs_instrument);
    1430              : 
    1431       486565 :     pfree(scan);
    1432       486565 : }
    1433              : 
    1434              : HeapTuple
    1435     11797065 : heap_getnext(TableScanDesc sscan, ScanDirection direction)
    1436              : {
    1437     11797065 :     HeapScanDesc scan = (HeapScanDesc) sscan;
    1438              : 
    1439              :     /*
    1440              :      * This is still widely used directly, without going through table AM, so
    1441              :      * add a safety check.  It's possible we should, at a later point,
    1442              :      * downgrade this to an assert. The reason for checking the AM routine,
    1443              :      * rather than the AM oid, is that this allows to write regression tests
    1444              :      * that create another AM reusing the heap handler.
    1445              :      */
    1446     11797065 :     if (unlikely(sscan->rs_rd->rd_tableam != GetHeapamTableAmRoutine()))
    1447            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    1448              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED),
    1449              :                  errmsg_internal("only heap AM is supported")));
    1450              : 
    1451              :     /* Note: no locking manipulations needed */
    1452              : 
    1453     11797065 :     if (scan->rs_base.rs_flags & SO_ALLOW_PAGEMODE)
    1454      3094772 :         heapgettup_pagemode(scan, direction,
    1455      3094772 :                             scan->rs_base.rs_nkeys, scan->rs_base.rs_key);
    1456              :     else
    1457      8702293 :         heapgettup(scan, direction,
    1458      8702293 :                    scan->rs_base.rs_nkeys, scan->rs_base.rs_key);
    1459              : 
    1460     11797065 :     if (scan->rs_ctup.t_data == NULL)
    1461        82509 :         return NULL;
    1462              : 
    1463              :     /*
    1464              :      * if we get here it means we have a new current scan tuple, so point to
    1465              :      * the proper return buffer and return the tuple.
    1466              :      */
    1467              : 
    1468     11714556 :     pgstat_count_heap_getnext(scan->rs_base.rs_rd);
    1469              : 
    1470     11714556 :     return &scan->rs_ctup;
    1471              : }
    1472              : 
    1473              : bool
    1474     67465713 : heap_getnextslot(TableScanDesc sscan, ScanDirection direction, TupleTableSlot *slot)
    1475              : {
    1476     67465713 :     HeapScanDesc scan = (HeapScanDesc) sscan;
    1477              : 
    1478              :     /* Note: no locking manipulations needed */
    1479              : 
    1480     67465713 :     if (sscan->rs_flags & SO_ALLOW_PAGEMODE)
    1481     66882717 :         heapgettup_pagemode(scan, direction, sscan->rs_nkeys, sscan->rs_key);
    1482              :     else
    1483       582996 :         heapgettup(scan, direction, sscan->rs_nkeys, sscan->rs_key);
    1484              : 
    1485     67465688 :     if (scan->rs_ctup.t_data == NULL)
    1486              :     {
    1487      1043627 :         ExecClearTuple(slot);
    1488      1043627 :         return false;
    1489              :     }
    1490              : 
    1491              :     /*
    1492              :      * if we get here it means we have a new current scan tuple, so point to
    1493              :      * the proper return buffer and return the tuple.
    1494              :      */
    1495              : 
    1496     66422061 :     pgstat_count_heap_getnext(scan->rs_base.rs_rd);
    1497              : 
    1498     66422061 :     ExecStoreBufferHeapTuple(&scan->rs_ctup, slot,
    1499              :                              scan->rs_cbuf);
    1500     66422061 :     return true;
    1501              : }
    1502              : 
    1503              : void
    1504         1374 : heap_set_tidrange(TableScanDesc sscan, ItemPointer mintid,
    1505              :                   ItemPointer maxtid)
    1506              : {
    1507         1374 :     HeapScanDesc scan = (HeapScanDesc) sscan;
    1508              :     BlockNumber startBlk;
    1509              :     BlockNumber numBlks;
    1510              :     ItemPointerData highestItem;
    1511              :     ItemPointerData lowestItem;
    1512              : 
    1513              :     /*
    1514              :      * For relations without any pages, we can simply leave the TID range
    1515              :      * unset.  There will be no tuples to scan, therefore no tuples outside
    1516              :      * the given TID range.
    1517              :      */
    1518         1374 :     if (scan->rs_nblocks == 0)
    1519           32 :         return;
    1520              : 
    1521              :     /*
    1522              :      * Set up some ItemPointers which point to the first and last possible
    1523              :      * tuples in the heap.
    1524              :      */
    1525         1366 :     ItemPointerSet(&highestItem, scan->rs_nblocks - 1, MaxOffsetNumber);
    1526         1366 :     ItemPointerSet(&lowestItem, 0, FirstOffsetNumber);
    1527              : 
    1528              :     /*
    1529              :      * If the given maximum TID is below the highest possible TID in the
    1530              :      * relation, then restrict the range to that, otherwise we scan to the end
    1531              :      * of the relation.
    1532              :      */
    1533         1366 :     if (ItemPointerCompare(maxtid, &highestItem) < 0)
    1534          172 :         ItemPointerCopy(maxtid, &highestItem);
    1535              : 
    1536              :     /*
    1537              :      * If the given minimum TID is above the lowest possible TID in the
    1538              :      * relation, then restrict the range to only scan for TIDs above that.
    1539              :      */
    1540         1366 :     if (ItemPointerCompare(mintid, &lowestItem) > 0)
    1541         1210 :         ItemPointerCopy(mintid, &lowestItem);
    1542              : 
    1543              :     /*
    1544              :      * Check for an empty range and protect from would be negative results
    1545              :      * from the numBlks calculation below.
    1546              :      */
    1547         1366 :     if (ItemPointerCompare(&highestItem, &lowestItem) < 0)
    1548              :     {
    1549              :         /* Set an empty range of blocks to scan */
    1550           24 :         heap_setscanlimits(sscan, 0, 0);
    1551           24 :         return;
    1552              :     }
    1553              : 
    1554              :     /*
    1555              :      * Calculate the first block and the number of blocks we must scan. We
    1556              :      * could be more aggressive here and perform some more validation to try
    1557              :      * and further narrow the scope of blocks to scan by checking if the
    1558              :      * lowestItem has an offset above MaxOffsetNumber.  In this case, we could
    1559              :      * advance startBlk by one.  Likewise, if highestItem has an offset of 0
    1560              :      * we could scan one fewer blocks.  However, such an optimization does not
    1561              :      * seem worth troubling over, currently.
    1562              :      */
    1563         1342 :     startBlk = ItemPointerGetBlockNumberNoCheck(&lowestItem);
    1564              : 
    1565         1342 :     numBlks = ItemPointerGetBlockNumberNoCheck(&highestItem) -
    1566         1342 :         ItemPointerGetBlockNumberNoCheck(&lowestItem) + 1;
    1567              : 
    1568              :     /* Set the start block and number of blocks to scan */
    1569         1342 :     heap_setscanlimits(sscan, startBlk, numBlks);
    1570              : 
    1571              :     /* Finally, set the TID range in sscan */
    1572         1342 :     ItemPointerCopy(&lowestItem, &sscan->st.tidrange.rs_mintid);
    1573         1342 :     ItemPointerCopy(&highestItem, &sscan->st.tidrange.rs_maxtid);
    1574              : }
    1575              : 
    1576              : bool
    1577         6512 : heap_getnextslot_tidrange(TableScanDesc sscan, ScanDirection direction,
    1578              :                           TupleTableSlot *slot)
    1579              : {
    1580         6512 :     HeapScanDesc scan = (HeapScanDesc) sscan;
    1581         6512 :     ItemPointer mintid = &sscan->st.tidrange.rs_mintid;
    1582         6512 :     ItemPointer maxtid = &sscan->st.tidrange.rs_maxtid;
    1583              : 
    1584              :     /* Note: no locking manipulations needed */
    1585              :     for (;;)
    1586              :     {
    1587         6636 :         if (sscan->rs_flags & SO_ALLOW_PAGEMODE)
    1588         6636 :             heapgettup_pagemode(scan, direction, sscan->rs_nkeys, sscan->rs_key);
    1589              :         else
    1590            0 :             heapgettup(scan, direction, sscan->rs_nkeys, sscan->rs_key);
    1591              : 
    1592         6626 :         if (scan->rs_ctup.t_data == NULL)
    1593              :         {
    1594          138 :             ExecClearTuple(slot);
    1595          138 :             return false;
    1596              :         }
    1597              : 
    1598              :         /*
    1599              :          * heap_set_tidrange will have used heap_setscanlimits to limit the
    1600              :          * range of pages we scan to only ones that can contain the TID range
    1601              :          * we're scanning for.  Here we must filter out any tuples from these
    1602              :          * pages that are outside of that range.
    1603              :          */
    1604         6488 :         if (ItemPointerCompare(&scan->rs_ctup.t_self, mintid) < 0)
    1605              :         {
    1606          124 :             ExecClearTuple(slot);
    1607              : 
    1608              :             /*
    1609              :              * When scanning backwards, the TIDs will be in descending order.
    1610              :              * Future tuples in this direction will be lower still, so we can
    1611              :              * just return false to indicate there will be no more tuples.
    1612              :              */
    1613          124 :             if (ScanDirectionIsBackward(direction))
    1614            0 :                 return false;
    1615              : 
    1616          124 :             continue;
    1617              :         }
    1618              : 
    1619              :         /*
    1620              :          * Likewise for the final page, we must filter out TIDs greater than
    1621              :          * maxtid.
    1622              :          */
    1623         6364 :         if (ItemPointerCompare(&scan->rs_ctup.t_self, maxtid) > 0)
    1624              :         {
    1625           74 :             ExecClearTuple(slot);
    1626              : 
    1627              :             /*
    1628              :              * When scanning forward, the TIDs will be in ascending order.
    1629              :              * Future tuples in this direction will be higher still, so we can
    1630              :              * just return false to indicate there will be no more tuples.
    1631              :              */
    1632           74 :             if (ScanDirectionIsForward(direction))
    1633           74 :                 return false;
    1634            0 :             continue;
    1635              :         }
    1636              : 
    1637         6290 :         break;
    1638              :     }
    1639              : 
    1640              :     /*
    1641              :      * if we get here it means we have a new current scan tuple, so point to
    1642              :      * the proper return buffer and return the tuple.
    1643              :      */
    1644         6290 :     pgstat_count_heap_getnext(scan->rs_base.rs_rd);
    1645              : 
    1646         6290 :     ExecStoreBufferHeapTuple(&scan->rs_ctup, slot, scan->rs_cbuf);
    1647         6290 :     return true;
    1648              : }
    1649              : 
    1650              : /*
    1651              :  *  heap_fetch      - retrieve tuple with given tid
    1652              :  *
    1653              :  * On entry, tuple->t_self is the TID to fetch.  We pin the buffer holding
    1654              :  * the tuple, fill in the remaining fields of *tuple, and check the tuple
    1655              :  * against the specified snapshot.
    1656              :  *
    1657              :  * If successful (tuple found and passes snapshot time qual), then *userbuf
    1658              :  * is set to the buffer holding the tuple and true is returned.  The caller
    1659              :  * must unpin the buffer when done with the tuple.
    1660              :  *
    1661              :  * If the tuple is not found (ie, item number references a deleted slot),
    1662              :  * then tuple->t_data is set to NULL, *userbuf is set to InvalidBuffer,
    1663              :  * and false is returned.
    1664              :  *
    1665              :  * If the tuple is found but fails the time qual check, then the behavior
    1666              :  * depends on the keep_buf parameter.  If keep_buf is false, the results
    1667              :  * are the same as for the tuple-not-found case.  If keep_buf is true,
    1668              :  * then tuple->t_data and *userbuf are returned as for the success case,
    1669              :  * and again the caller must unpin the buffer; but false is returned.
    1670              :  *
    1671              :  * heap_fetch does not follow HOT chains: only the exact TID requested will
    1672              :  * be fetched.
    1673              :  *
    1674              :  * It is somewhat inconsistent that we ereport() on invalid block number but
    1675              :  * return false on invalid item number.  There are a couple of reasons though.
    1676              :  * One is that the caller can relatively easily check the block number for
    1677              :  * validity, but cannot check the item number without reading the page
    1678              :  * himself.  Another is that when we are following a t_ctid link, we can be
    1679              :  * reasonably confident that the page number is valid (since VACUUM shouldn't
    1680              :  * truncate off the destination page without having killed the referencing
    1681              :  * tuple first), but the item number might well not be good.
    1682              :  */
    1683              : bool
    1684      2851882 : heap_fetch(Relation relation,
    1685              :            Snapshot snapshot,
    1686              :            HeapTuple tuple,
    1687              :            Buffer *userbuf,
    1688              :            bool keep_buf)
    1689              : {
    1690      2851882 :     ItemPointer tid = &(tuple->t_self);
    1691              :     ItemId      lp;
    1692              :     Buffer      buffer;
    1693              :     Page        page;
    1694              :     OffsetNumber offnum;
    1695              :     bool        valid;
    1696              : 
    1697              :     /*
    1698              :      * Fetch and pin the appropriate page of the relation.
    1699              :      */
    1700      2851882 :     buffer = ReadBuffer(relation, ItemPointerGetBlockNumber(tid));
    1701              : 
    1702              :     /*
    1703              :      * Need share lock on buffer to examine tuple commit status.
    1704              :      */
    1705      2851874 :     LockBuffer(buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_SHARE);
    1706      2851874 :     page = BufferGetPage(buffer);
    1707              : 
    1708              :     /*
    1709              :      * We'd better check for out-of-range offnum in case of VACUUM since the
    1710              :      * TID was obtained.
    1711              :      */
    1712      2851874 :     offnum = ItemPointerGetOffsetNumber(tid);
    1713      2851874 :     if (offnum < FirstOffsetNumber || offnum > PageGetMaxOffsetNumber(page))
    1714              :     {
    1715            4 :         UnlockReleaseBuffer(buffer);
    1716            4 :         *userbuf = InvalidBuffer;
    1717            4 :         tuple->t_data = NULL;
    1718            4 :         return false;
    1719              :     }
    1720              : 
    1721              :     /*
    1722              :      * get the item line pointer corresponding to the requested tid
    1723              :      */
    1724      2851870 :     lp = PageGetItemId(page, offnum);
    1725              : 
    1726              :     /*
    1727              :      * Must check for deleted tuple.
    1728              :      */
    1729      2851870 :     if (!ItemIdIsNormal(lp))
    1730              :     {
    1731          281 :         UnlockReleaseBuffer(buffer);
    1732          281 :         *userbuf = InvalidBuffer;
    1733          281 :         tuple->t_data = NULL;
    1734          281 :         return false;
    1735              :     }
    1736              : 
    1737              :     /*
    1738              :      * fill in *tuple fields
    1739              :      */
    1740      2851589 :     tuple->t_data = (HeapTupleHeader) PageGetItem(page, lp);
    1741      2851589 :     tuple->t_len = ItemIdGetLength(lp);
    1742      2851589 :     tuple->t_tableOid = RelationGetRelid(relation);
    1743              : 
    1744              :     /*
    1745              :      * check tuple visibility, then release lock
    1746              :      */
    1747      2851589 :     valid = HeapTupleSatisfiesVisibility(tuple, snapshot, buffer);
    1748              : 
    1749      2851589 :     if (valid)
    1750      2851532 :         PredicateLockTID(relation, &(tuple->t_self), snapshot,
    1751      2851532 :                          HeapTupleHeaderGetXmin(tuple->t_data));
    1752              : 
    1753      2851589 :     HeapCheckForSerializableConflictOut(valid, relation, tuple, buffer, snapshot);
    1754              : 
    1755      2851589 :     LockBuffer(buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_UNLOCK);
    1756              : 
    1757      2851589 :     if (valid)
    1758              :     {
    1759              :         /*
    1760              :          * All checks passed, so return the tuple as valid. Caller is now
    1761              :          * responsible for releasing the buffer.
    1762              :          */
    1763      2851532 :         *userbuf = buffer;
    1764              : 
    1765      2851532 :         return true;
    1766              :     }
    1767              : 
    1768              :     /* Tuple failed time qual, but maybe caller wants to see it anyway. */
    1769           57 :     if (keep_buf)
    1770           35 :         *userbuf = buffer;
    1771              :     else
    1772              :     {
    1773           22 :         ReleaseBuffer(buffer);
    1774           22 :         *userbuf = InvalidBuffer;
    1775           22 :         tuple->t_data = NULL;
    1776              :     }
    1777              : 
    1778           57 :     return false;
    1779              : }
    1780              : 
    1781              : /*
    1782              :  *  heap_get_latest_tid -  get the latest tid of a specified tuple
    1783              :  *
    1784              :  * Actually, this gets the latest version that is visible according to the
    1785              :  * scan's snapshot.  Create a scan using SnapshotDirty to get the very latest,
    1786              :  * possibly uncommitted version.
    1787              :  *
    1788              :  * *tid is both an input and an output parameter: it is updated to
    1789              :  * show the latest version of the row.  Note that it will not be changed
    1790              :  * if no version of the row passes the snapshot test.
    1791              :  */
    1792              : void
    1793          207 : heap_get_latest_tid(TableScanDesc sscan,
    1794              :                     ItemPointer tid)
    1795              : {
    1796          207 :     Relation    relation = sscan->rs_rd;
    1797          207 :     Snapshot    snapshot = sscan->rs_snapshot;
    1798              :     ItemPointerData ctid;
    1799              :     TransactionId priorXmax;
    1800              : 
    1801              :     /*
    1802              :      * table_tuple_get_latest_tid() verified that the passed in tid is valid.
    1803              :      * Assume that t_ctid links are valid however - there shouldn't be invalid
    1804              :      * ones in the table.
    1805              :      */
    1806              :     Assert(ItemPointerIsValid(tid));
    1807              : 
    1808              :     /*
    1809              :      * Loop to chase down t_ctid links.  At top of loop, ctid is the tuple we
    1810              :      * need to examine, and *tid is the TID we will return if ctid turns out
    1811              :      * to be bogus.
    1812              :      *
    1813              :      * Note that we will loop until we reach the end of the t_ctid chain.
    1814              :      * Depending on the snapshot passed, there might be at most one visible
    1815              :      * version of the row, but we don't try to optimize for that.
    1816              :      */
    1817          207 :     ctid = *tid;
    1818          207 :     priorXmax = InvalidTransactionId;   /* cannot check first XMIN */
    1819              :     for (;;)
    1820           64 :     {
    1821              :         Buffer      buffer;
    1822              :         Page        page;
    1823              :         OffsetNumber offnum;
    1824              :         ItemId      lp;
    1825              :         HeapTupleData tp;
    1826              :         bool        valid;
    1827              : 
    1828              :         /*
    1829              :          * Read, pin, and lock the page.
    1830              :          */
    1831          271 :         buffer = ReadBuffer(relation, ItemPointerGetBlockNumber(&ctid));
    1832          271 :         LockBuffer(buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_SHARE);
    1833          271 :         page = BufferGetPage(buffer);
    1834              : 
    1835              :         /*
    1836              :          * Check for bogus item number.  This is not treated as an error
    1837              :          * condition because it can happen while following a t_ctid link. We
    1838              :          * just assume that the prior tid is OK and return it unchanged.
    1839              :          */
    1840          271 :         offnum = ItemPointerGetOffsetNumber(&ctid);
    1841          271 :         if (offnum < FirstOffsetNumber || offnum > PageGetMaxOffsetNumber(page))
    1842              :         {
    1843            0 :             UnlockReleaseBuffer(buffer);
    1844            0 :             break;
    1845              :         }
    1846          271 :         lp = PageGetItemId(page, offnum);
    1847          271 :         if (!ItemIdIsNormal(lp))
    1848              :         {
    1849            0 :             UnlockReleaseBuffer(buffer);
    1850            0 :             break;
    1851              :         }
    1852              : 
    1853              :         /* OK to access the tuple */
    1854          271 :         tp.t_self = ctid;
    1855          271 :         tp.t_data = (HeapTupleHeader) PageGetItem(page, lp);
    1856          271 :         tp.t_len = ItemIdGetLength(lp);
    1857          271 :         tp.t_tableOid = RelationGetRelid(relation);
    1858              : 
    1859              :         /*
    1860              :          * After following a t_ctid link, we might arrive at an unrelated
    1861              :          * tuple.  Check for XMIN match.
    1862              :          */
    1863          335 :         if (TransactionIdIsValid(priorXmax) &&
    1864           64 :             !TransactionIdEquals(priorXmax, HeapTupleHeaderGetXmin(tp.t_data)))
    1865              :         {
    1866            0 :             UnlockReleaseBuffer(buffer);
    1867            0 :             break;
    1868              :         }
    1869              : 
    1870              :         /*
    1871              :          * Check tuple visibility; if visible, set it as the new result
    1872              :          * candidate.
    1873              :          */
    1874          271 :         valid = HeapTupleSatisfiesVisibility(&tp, snapshot, buffer);
    1875          271 :         HeapCheckForSerializableConflictOut(valid, relation, &tp, buffer, snapshot);
    1876          271 :         if (valid)
    1877          191 :             *tid = ctid;
    1878              : 
    1879              :         /*
    1880              :          * If there's a valid t_ctid link, follow it, else we're done.
    1881              :          */
    1882          391 :         if ((tp.t_data->t_infomask & HEAP_XMAX_INVALID) ||
    1883          200 :             HeapTupleHeaderIsOnlyLocked(tp.t_data) ||
    1884          160 :             HeapTupleHeaderIndicatesMovedPartitions(tp.t_data) ||
    1885           80 :             ItemPointerEquals(&tp.t_self, &tp.t_data->t_ctid))
    1886              :         {
    1887          207 :             UnlockReleaseBuffer(buffer);
    1888          207 :             break;
    1889              :         }
    1890              : 
    1891           64 :         ctid = tp.t_data->t_ctid;
    1892           64 :         priorXmax = HeapTupleHeaderGetUpdateXid(tp.t_data);
    1893           64 :         UnlockReleaseBuffer(buffer);
    1894              :     }                           /* end of loop */
    1895          207 : }
    1896              : 
    1897              : 
    1898              : /*
    1899              :  * UpdateXmaxHintBits - update tuple hint bits after xmax transaction ends
    1900              :  *
    1901              :  * This is called after we have waited for the XMAX transaction to terminate.
    1902              :  * If the transaction aborted, we guarantee the XMAX_INVALID hint bit will
    1903              :  * be set on exit.  If the transaction committed, we set the XMAX_COMMITTED
    1904              :  * hint bit if possible --- but beware that that may not yet be possible,
    1905              :  * if the transaction committed asynchronously.
    1906              :  *
    1907              :  * Note that if the transaction was a locker only, we set HEAP_XMAX_INVALID
    1908              :  * even if it commits.
    1909              :  *
    1910              :  * Hence callers should look only at XMAX_INVALID.
    1911              :  *
    1912              :  * Note this is not allowed for tuples whose xmax is a multixact.
    1913              :  */
    1914              : static void
    1915          279 : UpdateXmaxHintBits(HeapTupleHeader tuple, Buffer buffer, TransactionId xid)
    1916              : {
    1917              :     Assert(TransactionIdEquals(HeapTupleHeaderGetRawXmax(tuple), xid));
    1918              :     Assert(!(tuple->t_infomask & HEAP_XMAX_IS_MULTI));
    1919              : 
    1920          279 :     if (!(tuple->t_infomask & (HEAP_XMAX_COMMITTED | HEAP_XMAX_INVALID)))
    1921              :     {
    1922          506 :         if (!HEAP_XMAX_IS_LOCKED_ONLY(tuple->t_infomask) &&
    1923          228 :             TransactionIdDidCommit(xid))
    1924          201 :             HeapTupleSetHintBits(tuple, buffer, HEAP_XMAX_COMMITTED,
    1925              :                                  xid);
    1926              :         else
    1927           77 :             HeapTupleSetHintBits(tuple, buffer, HEAP_XMAX_INVALID,
    1928              :                                  InvalidTransactionId);
    1929              :     }
    1930          279 : }
    1931              : 
    1932              : 
    1933              : /*
    1934              :  * GetBulkInsertState - prepare status object for a bulk insert
    1935              :  */
    1936              : BulkInsertState
    1937         3540 : GetBulkInsertState(void)
    1938              : {
    1939              :     BulkInsertState bistate;
    1940              : 
    1941         3540 :     bistate = (BulkInsertState) palloc_object(BulkInsertStateData);
    1942         3540 :     bistate->strategy = GetAccessStrategy(BAS_BULKWRITE);
    1943         3540 :     bistate->current_buf = InvalidBuffer;
    1944         3540 :     bistate->next_free = InvalidBlockNumber;
    1945         3540 :     bistate->last_free = InvalidBlockNumber;
    1946         3540 :     bistate->already_extended_by = 0;
    1947         3540 :     return bistate;
    1948              : }
    1949              : 
    1950              : /*
    1951              :  * FreeBulkInsertState - clean up after finishing a bulk insert
    1952              :  */
    1953              : void
    1954         3299 : FreeBulkInsertState(BulkInsertState bistate)
    1955              : {
    1956         3299 :     if (bistate->current_buf != InvalidBuffer)
    1957         2593 :         ReleaseBuffer(bistate->current_buf);
    1958         3299 :     FreeAccessStrategy(bistate->strategy);
    1959         3299 :     pfree(bistate);
    1960         3299 : }
    1961              : 
    1962              : /*
    1963              :  * ReleaseBulkInsertStatePin - release a buffer currently held in bistate
    1964              :  */
    1965              : void
    1966        90779 : ReleaseBulkInsertStatePin(BulkInsertState bistate)
    1967              : {
    1968        90779 :     if (bistate->current_buf != InvalidBuffer)
    1969        40028 :         ReleaseBuffer(bistate->current_buf);
    1970        90779 :     bistate->current_buf = InvalidBuffer;
    1971              : 
    1972              :     /*
    1973              :      * Despite the name, we also reset bulk relation extension state.
    1974              :      * Otherwise we can end up erroring out due to looking for free space in
    1975              :      * ->next_free of one partition, even though ->next_free was set when
    1976              :      * extending another partition. It could obviously also be bad for
    1977              :      * efficiency to look at existing blocks at offsets from another
    1978              :      * partition, even if we don't error out.
    1979              :      */
    1980        90779 :     bistate->next_free = InvalidBlockNumber;
    1981        90779 :     bistate->last_free = InvalidBlockNumber;
    1982        90779 : }
    1983              : 
    1984              : 
    1985              : /*
    1986              :  *  heap_insert     - insert tuple into a heap
    1987              :  *
    1988              :  * The new tuple is stamped with current transaction ID and the specified
    1989              :  * command ID.
    1990              :  *
    1991              :  * See table_tuple_insert for comments about most of the input flags, except
    1992              :  * that this routine directly takes a tuple rather than a slot.
    1993              :  *
    1994              :  * There's corresponding HEAP_INSERT_ options to all the TABLE_INSERT_
    1995              :  * options, and there additionally is HEAP_INSERT_SPECULATIVE which is used to
    1996              :  * implement table_tuple_insert_speculative().
    1997              :  *
    1998              :  * On return the header fields of *tup are updated to match the stored tuple;
    1999              :  * in particular tup->t_self receives the actual TID where the tuple was
    2000              :  * stored.  But note that any toasting of fields within the tuple data is NOT
    2001              :  * reflected into *tup.
    2002              :  */
    2003              : void
    2004     11549319 : heap_insert(Relation relation, HeapTuple tup, CommandId cid,
    2005              :             uint32 options, BulkInsertState bistate)
    2006              : {
    2007     11549319 :     TransactionId xid = GetCurrentTransactionId();
    2008              :     HeapTuple   heaptup;
    2009              :     Buffer      buffer;
    2010              :     Page        page;
    2011     11549312 :     Buffer      vmbuffer = InvalidBuffer;
    2012     11549312 :     bool        all_visible_cleared = false;
    2013              : 
    2014              :     /* Cheap, simplistic check that the tuple matches the rel's rowtype. */
    2015              :     Assert(HeapTupleHeaderGetNatts(tup->t_data) <=
    2016              :            RelationGetNumberOfAttributes(relation));
    2017              : 
    2018     11549312 :     AssertHasSnapshotForToast(relation);
    2019              : 
    2020              :     /*
    2021              :      * Fill in tuple header fields and toast the tuple if necessary.
    2022              :      *
    2023              :      * Note: below this point, heaptup is the data we actually intend to store
    2024              :      * into the relation; tup is the caller's original untoasted data.
    2025              :      */
    2026     11549312 :     heaptup = heap_prepare_insert(relation, tup, xid, cid, options);
    2027              : 
    2028              :     /*
    2029              :      * Find buffer to insert this tuple into.  If the page is all visible,
    2030              :      * this will also pin the requisite visibility map page.
    2031              :      */
    2032     11549312 :     buffer = RelationGetBufferForTuple(relation, heaptup->t_len,
    2033              :                                        InvalidBuffer, options, bistate,
    2034              :                                        &vmbuffer, NULL,
    2035              :                                        0);
    2036              : 
    2037     11549312 :     page = BufferGetPage(buffer);
    2038              : 
    2039              :     /*
    2040              :      * We're about to do the actual insert -- but check for conflict first, to
    2041              :      * avoid possibly having to roll back work we've just done.
    2042              :      *
    2043              :      * This is safe without a recheck as long as there is no possibility of
    2044              :      * another process scanning the page between this check and the insert
    2045              :      * being visible to the scan (i.e., an exclusive buffer content lock is
    2046              :      * continuously held from this point until the tuple insert is visible).
    2047              :      *
    2048              :      * For a heap insert, we only need to check for table-level SSI locks. Our
    2049              :      * new tuple can't possibly conflict with existing tuple locks, and heap
    2050              :      * page locks are only consolidated versions of tuple locks; they do not
    2051              :      * lock "gaps" as index page locks do.  So we don't need to specify a
    2052              :      * buffer when making the call, which makes for a faster check.
    2053              :      */
    2054     11549312 :     CheckForSerializableConflictIn(relation, NULL, InvalidBlockNumber);
    2055              : 
    2056              :     /* NO EREPORT(ERROR) from here till changes are logged */
    2057     11549300 :     START_CRIT_SECTION();
    2058              : 
    2059     11549300 :     RelationPutHeapTuple(relation, buffer, heaptup,
    2060     11549300 :                          (options & HEAP_INSERT_SPECULATIVE) != 0);
    2061              : 
    2062     11549300 :     if (PageIsAllVisible(page))
    2063              :     {
    2064         7346 :         all_visible_cleared = true;
    2065         7346 :         PageClearAllVisible(page);
    2066         7346 :         visibilitymap_clear(relation,
    2067         7346 :                             ItemPointerGetBlockNumber(&(heaptup->t_self)),
    2068              :                             vmbuffer, VISIBILITYMAP_VALID_BITS);
    2069              :     }
    2070              : 
    2071              :     /*
    2072              :      * Set pd_prune_xid to trigger heap_page_prune_and_freeze() once the page
    2073              :      * is full so that we can set the page all-visible in the VM on the next
    2074              :      * page access.
    2075              :      *
    2076              :      * Setting pd_prune_xid is also handy if the inserting transaction
    2077              :      * eventually aborts making this tuple DEAD and hence available for
    2078              :      * pruning. If no other tuple in this page is UPDATEd/DELETEd, the aborted
    2079              :      * tuple would never otherwise be pruned until next vacuum is triggered.
    2080              :      *
    2081              :      * Don't set it if we are in bootstrap mode or we are inserting a frozen
    2082              :      * tuple, as there is no further pruning/freezing needed in those cases.
    2083              :      */
    2084     11549300 :     if (TransactionIdIsNormal(xid) && !(options & HEAP_INSERT_FROZEN))
    2085     10896755 :         PageSetPrunable(page, xid);
    2086              : 
    2087     11549300 :     MarkBufferDirty(buffer);
    2088              : 
    2089              :     /* XLOG stuff */
    2090     11549300 :     if (RelationNeedsWAL(relation))
    2091              :     {
    2092              :         xl_heap_insert xlrec;
    2093              :         xl_heap_header xlhdr;
    2094              :         XLogRecPtr  recptr;
    2095     10437215 :         uint8       info = XLOG_HEAP_INSERT;
    2096     10437215 :         int         bufflags = 0;
    2097              : 
    2098              :         /*
    2099              :          * If this is a catalog, we need to transmit combo CIDs to properly
    2100              :          * decode, so log that as well.
    2101              :          */
    2102     10437215 :         if (RelationIsAccessibleInLogicalDecoding(relation))
    2103         5241 :             log_heap_new_cid(relation, heaptup);
    2104              : 
    2105              :         /*
    2106              :          * If this is the single and first tuple on page, we can reinit the
    2107              :          * page instead of restoring the whole thing.  Set flag, and hide
    2108              :          * buffer references from XLogInsert.
    2109              :          */
    2110     10559698 :         if (ItemPointerGetOffsetNumber(&(heaptup->t_self)) == FirstOffsetNumber &&
    2111       122483 :             PageGetMaxOffsetNumber(page) == FirstOffsetNumber)
    2112              :         {
    2113       121609 :             info |= XLOG_HEAP_INIT_PAGE;
    2114       121609 :             bufflags |= REGBUF_WILL_INIT;
    2115              :         }
    2116              : 
    2117     10437215 :         xlrec.offnum = ItemPointerGetOffsetNumber(&heaptup->t_self);
    2118     10437215 :         xlrec.flags = 0;
    2119     10437215 :         if (all_visible_cleared)
    2120         7342 :             xlrec.flags |= XLH_INSERT_ALL_VISIBLE_CLEARED;
    2121     10437215 :         if (options & HEAP_INSERT_SPECULATIVE)
    2122         2206 :             xlrec.flags |= XLH_INSERT_IS_SPECULATIVE;
    2123              :         Assert(ItemPointerGetBlockNumber(&heaptup->t_self) == BufferGetBlockNumber(buffer));
    2124              : 
    2125              :         /*
    2126              :          * For logical decoding, we need the tuple even if we're doing a full
    2127              :          * page write, so make sure it's included even if we take a full-page
    2128              :          * image. (XXX We could alternatively store a pointer into the FPW).
    2129              :          */
    2130     10437215 :         if (RelationIsLogicallyLogged(relation) &&
    2131       273506 :             !(options & HEAP_INSERT_NO_LOGICAL))
    2132              :         {
    2133       273394 :             xlrec.flags |= XLH_INSERT_CONTAINS_NEW_TUPLE;
    2134       273394 :             bufflags |= REGBUF_KEEP_DATA;
    2135              : 
    2136       273394 :             if (IsToastRelation(relation))
    2137         1927 :                 xlrec.flags |= XLH_INSERT_ON_TOAST_RELATION;
    2138              :         }
    2139              : 
    2140     10437215 :         XLogBeginInsert();
    2141     10437215 :         XLogRegisterData(&xlrec, SizeOfHeapInsert);
    2142              : 
    2143     10437215 :         xlhdr.t_infomask2 = heaptup->t_data->t_infomask2;
    2144     10437215 :         xlhdr.t_infomask = heaptup->t_data->t_infomask;
    2145     10437215 :         xlhdr.t_hoff = heaptup->t_data->t_hoff;
    2146              : 
    2147              :         /*
    2148              :          * note we mark xlhdr as belonging to buffer; if XLogInsert decides to
    2149              :          * write the whole page to the xlog, we don't need to store
    2150              :          * xl_heap_header in the xlog.
    2151              :          */
    2152     10437215 :         XLogRegisterBuffer(0, buffer, REGBUF_STANDARD | bufflags);
    2153     10437215 :         XLogRegisterBufData(0, &xlhdr, SizeOfHeapHeader);
    2154              :         /* PG73FORMAT: write bitmap [+ padding] [+ oid] + data */
    2155     10437215 :         XLogRegisterBufData(0,
    2156     10437215 :                             (char *) heaptup->t_data + SizeofHeapTupleHeader,
    2157     10437215 :                             heaptup->t_len - SizeofHeapTupleHeader);
    2158              : 
    2159              :         /* filtering by origin on a row level is much more efficient */
    2160     10437215 :         XLogSetRecordFlags(XLOG_INCLUDE_ORIGIN);
    2161              : 
    2162     10437215 :         recptr = XLogInsert(RM_HEAP_ID, info);
    2163              : 
    2164     10437215 :         PageSetLSN(page, recptr);
    2165              :     }
    2166              : 
    2167     11549300 :     END_CRIT_SECTION();
    2168              : 
    2169     11549300 :     UnlockReleaseBuffer(buffer);
    2170     11549300 :     if (vmbuffer != InvalidBuffer)
    2171         7689 :         ReleaseBuffer(vmbuffer);
    2172              : 
    2173              :     /*
    2174              :      * If tuple is cacheable, mark it for invalidation from the caches in case
    2175              :      * we abort.  Note it is OK to do this after releasing the buffer, because
    2176              :      * the heaptup data structure is all in local memory, not in the shared
    2177              :      * buffer.
    2178              :      */
    2179     11549300 :     CacheInvalidateHeapTuple(relation, heaptup, NULL);
    2180              : 
    2181              :     /* Note: speculative insertions are counted too, even if aborted later */
    2182     11549300 :     pgstat_count_heap_insert(relation, 1);
    2183              : 
    2184              :     /*
    2185              :      * If heaptup is a private copy, release it.  Don't forget to copy t_self
    2186              :      * back to the caller's image, too.
    2187              :      */
    2188     11549300 :     if (heaptup != tup)
    2189              :     {
    2190        22661 :         tup->t_self = heaptup->t_self;
    2191        22661 :         heap_freetuple(heaptup);
    2192              :     }
    2193     11549300 : }
    2194              : 
    2195              : /*
    2196              :  * Subroutine for heap_insert(). Prepares a tuple for insertion. This sets the
    2197              :  * tuple header fields and toasts the tuple if necessary.  Returns a toasted
    2198              :  * version of the tuple if it was toasted, or the original tuple if not. Note
    2199              :  * that in any case, the header fields are also set in the original tuple.
    2200              :  */
    2201              : static HeapTuple
    2202     13382794 : heap_prepare_insert(Relation relation, HeapTuple tup, TransactionId xid,
    2203              :                     CommandId cid, uint32 options)
    2204              : {
    2205              :     /*
    2206              :      * To allow parallel inserts, we need to ensure that they are safe to be
    2207              :      * performed in workers. We have the infrastructure to allow parallel
    2208              :      * inserts in general except for the cases where inserts generate a new
    2209              :      * CommandId (eg. inserts into a table having a foreign key column).
    2210              :      */
    2211     13382794 :     if (IsParallelWorker())
    2212            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    2213              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_TRANSACTION_STATE),
    2214              :                  errmsg("cannot insert tuples in a parallel worker")));
    2215              : 
    2216     13382794 :     tup->t_data->t_infomask &= ~(HEAP_XACT_MASK);
    2217     13382794 :     tup->t_data->t_infomask2 &= ~(HEAP2_XACT_MASK);
    2218     13382794 :     tup->t_data->t_infomask |= HEAP_XMAX_INVALID;
    2219     13382794 :     HeapTupleHeaderSetXmin(tup->t_data, xid);
    2220     13382794 :     if (options & HEAP_INSERT_FROZEN)
    2221       102651 :         HeapTupleHeaderSetXminFrozen(tup->t_data);
    2222              : 
    2223     13382794 :     HeapTupleHeaderSetCmin(tup->t_data, cid);
    2224     13382794 :     HeapTupleHeaderSetXmax(tup->t_data, 0); /* for cleanliness */
    2225     13382794 :     tup->t_tableOid = RelationGetRelid(relation);
    2226              : 
    2227              :     /*
    2228              :      * If the new tuple is too big for storage or contains already toasted
    2229              :      * out-of-line attributes from some other relation, invoke the toaster.
    2230              :      */
    2231     13382794 :     if (relation->rd_rel->relkind != RELKIND_RELATION &&
    2232        36358 :         relation->rd_rel->relkind != RELKIND_MATVIEW)
    2233              :     {
    2234              :         /* toast table entries should never be recursively toasted */
    2235              :         Assert(!HeapTupleHasExternal(tup));
    2236        36297 :         return tup;
    2237              :     }
    2238     13346497 :     else if (HeapTupleHasExternal(tup) || tup->t_len > TOAST_TUPLE_THRESHOLD)
    2239        22720 :         return heap_toast_insert_or_update(relation, tup, NULL, options);
    2240              :     else
    2241     13323777 :         return tup;
    2242              : }
    2243              : 
    2244              : /*
    2245              :  * Helper for heap_multi_insert() that computes the number of entire pages
    2246              :  * that inserting the remaining heaptuples requires. Used to determine how
    2247              :  * much the relation needs to be extended by.
    2248              :  */
    2249              : static int
    2250       491828 : heap_multi_insert_pages(HeapTuple *heaptuples, int done, int ntuples, Size saveFreeSpace)
    2251              : {
    2252       491828 :     size_t      page_avail = BLCKSZ - SizeOfPageHeaderData - saveFreeSpace;
    2253       491828 :     int         npages = 1;
    2254              : 
    2255      3006123 :     for (int i = done; i < ntuples; i++)
    2256              :     {
    2257      2514295 :         size_t      tup_sz = sizeof(ItemIdData) + MAXALIGN(heaptuples[i]->t_len);
    2258              : 
    2259      2514295 :         if (page_avail < tup_sz)
    2260              :         {
    2261        17563 :             npages++;
    2262        17563 :             page_avail = BLCKSZ - SizeOfPageHeaderData - saveFreeSpace;
    2263              :         }
    2264      2514295 :         page_avail -= tup_sz;
    2265              :     }
    2266              : 
    2267       491828 :     return npages;
    2268              : }
    2269              : 
    2270              : /*
    2271              :  *  heap_multi_insert   - insert multiple tuples into a heap
    2272              :  *
    2273              :  * This is like heap_insert(), but inserts multiple tuples in one operation.
    2274              :  * That's faster than calling heap_insert() in a loop, because when multiple
    2275              :  * tuples can be inserted on a single page, we can write just a single WAL
    2276              :  * record covering all of them, and only need to lock/unlock the page once.
    2277              :  *
    2278              :  * Note: this leaks memory into the current memory context. You can create a
    2279              :  * temporary context before calling this, if that's a problem.
    2280              :  */
    2281              : void
    2282       483565 : heap_multi_insert(Relation relation, TupleTableSlot **slots, int ntuples,
    2283              :                   CommandId cid, uint32 options, BulkInsertState bistate)
    2284              : {
    2285       483565 :     TransactionId xid = GetCurrentTransactionId();
    2286              :     HeapTuple  *heaptuples;
    2287              :     int         i;
    2288              :     int         ndone;
    2289              :     PGAlignedBlock scratch;
    2290              :     Page        page;
    2291       483565 :     Buffer      vmbuffer = InvalidBuffer;
    2292              :     bool        needwal;
    2293              :     Size        saveFreeSpace;
    2294       483565 :     bool        need_tuple_data = RelationIsLogicallyLogged(relation);
    2295       483565 :     bool        need_cids = RelationIsAccessibleInLogicalDecoding(relation);
    2296       483565 :     bool        starting_with_empty_page = false;
    2297       483565 :     int         npages = 0;
    2298       483565 :     int         npages_used = 0;
    2299              : 
    2300              :     /* currently not needed (thus unsupported) for heap_multi_insert() */
    2301              :     Assert(!(options & HEAP_INSERT_NO_LOGICAL));
    2302              : 
    2303       483565 :     AssertHasSnapshotForToast(relation);
    2304              : 
    2305       483565 :     needwal = RelationNeedsWAL(relation);
    2306       483565 :     saveFreeSpace = RelationGetTargetPageFreeSpace(relation,
    2307              :                                                    HEAP_DEFAULT_FILLFACTOR);
    2308              : 
    2309              :     /* Toast and set header data in all the slots */
    2310       483565 :     heaptuples = palloc(ntuples * sizeof(HeapTuple));
    2311      2317047 :     for (i = 0; i < ntuples; i++)
    2312              :     {
    2313              :         HeapTuple   tuple;
    2314              : 
    2315      1833482 :         tuple = ExecFetchSlotHeapTuple(slots[i], true, NULL);
    2316      1833482 :         slots[i]->tts_tableOid = RelationGetRelid(relation);
    2317      1833482 :         tuple->t_tableOid = slots[i]->tts_tableOid;
    2318      1833482 :         heaptuples[i] = heap_prepare_insert(relation, tuple, xid, cid,
    2319              :                                             options);
    2320              :     }
    2321              : 
    2322              :     /*
    2323              :      * We're about to do the actual inserts -- but check for conflict first,
    2324              :      * to minimize the possibility of having to roll back work we've just
    2325              :      * done.
    2326              :      *
    2327              :      * A check here does not definitively prevent a serialization anomaly;
    2328              :      * that check MUST be done at least past the point of acquiring an
    2329              :      * exclusive buffer content lock on every buffer that will be affected,
    2330              :      * and MAY be done after all inserts are reflected in the buffers and
    2331              :      * those locks are released; otherwise there is a race condition.  Since
    2332              :      * multiple buffers can be locked and unlocked in the loop below, and it
    2333              :      * would not be feasible to identify and lock all of those buffers before
    2334              :      * the loop, we must do a final check at the end.
    2335              :      *
    2336              :      * The check here could be omitted with no loss of correctness; it is
    2337              :      * present strictly as an optimization.
    2338              :      *
    2339              :      * For heap inserts, we only need to check for table-level SSI locks. Our
    2340              :      * new tuples can't possibly conflict with existing tuple locks, and heap
    2341              :      * page locks are only consolidated versions of tuple locks; they do not
    2342              :      * lock "gaps" as index page locks do.  So we don't need to specify a
    2343              :      * buffer when making the call, which makes for a faster check.
    2344              :      */
    2345       483565 :     CheckForSerializableConflictIn(relation, NULL, InvalidBlockNumber);
    2346              : 
    2347       483565 :     ndone = 0;
    2348       984672 :     while (ndone < ntuples)
    2349              :     {
    2350              :         Buffer      buffer;
    2351       501107 :         bool        all_visible_cleared = false;
    2352       501107 :         bool        all_frozen_set = false;
    2353              :         int         nthispage;
    2354              : 
    2355       501107 :         CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS();
    2356              : 
    2357              :         /*
    2358              :          * Compute number of pages needed to fit the to-be-inserted tuples in
    2359              :          * the worst case.  This will be used to determine how much to extend
    2360              :          * the relation by in RelationGetBufferForTuple(), if needed.  If we
    2361              :          * filled a prior page from scratch, we can just update our last
    2362              :          * computation, but if we started with a partially filled page,
    2363              :          * recompute from scratch, the number of potentially required pages
    2364              :          * can vary due to tuples needing to fit onto the page, page headers
    2365              :          * etc.
    2366              :          */
    2367       501107 :         if (ndone == 0 || !starting_with_empty_page)
    2368              :         {
    2369       491828 :             npages = heap_multi_insert_pages(heaptuples, ndone, ntuples,
    2370              :                                              saveFreeSpace);
    2371       491828 :             npages_used = 0;
    2372              :         }
    2373              :         else
    2374         9279 :             npages_used++;
    2375              : 
    2376              :         /*
    2377              :          * Find buffer where at least the next tuple will fit.  If the page is
    2378              :          * all-visible, this will also pin the requisite visibility map page.
    2379              :          *
    2380              :          * Also pin visibility map page if COPY FREEZE inserts tuples into an
    2381              :          * empty page. See all_frozen_set below.
    2382              :          */
    2383       501107 :         buffer = RelationGetBufferForTuple(relation, heaptuples[ndone]->t_len,
    2384              :                                            InvalidBuffer, options, bistate,
    2385              :                                            &vmbuffer, NULL,
    2386              :                                            npages - npages_used);
    2387       501107 :         page = BufferGetPage(buffer);
    2388              : 
    2389       501107 :         starting_with_empty_page = PageGetMaxOffsetNumber(page) == 0;
    2390              : 
    2391       501107 :         if (starting_with_empty_page && (options & HEAP_INSERT_FROZEN))
    2392              :         {
    2393         1665 :             all_frozen_set = true;
    2394              :             /* Lock the vmbuffer before entering the critical section */
    2395         1665 :             LockBuffer(vmbuffer, BUFFER_LOCK_EXCLUSIVE);
    2396              :         }
    2397              : 
    2398              :         /* NO EREPORT(ERROR) from here till changes are logged */
    2399       501107 :         START_CRIT_SECTION();
    2400              : 
    2401              :         /*
    2402              :          * RelationGetBufferForTuple has ensured that the first tuple fits.
    2403              :          * Put that on the page, and then as many other tuples as fit.
    2404              :          */
    2405       501107 :         RelationPutHeapTuple(relation, buffer, heaptuples[ndone], false);
    2406              : 
    2407              :         /*
    2408              :          * For logical decoding we need combo CIDs to properly decode the
    2409              :          * catalog.
    2410              :          */
    2411       501107 :         if (needwal && need_cids)
    2412         7037 :             log_heap_new_cid(relation, heaptuples[ndone]);
    2413              : 
    2414      1833482 :         for (nthispage = 1; ndone + nthispage < ntuples; nthispage++)
    2415              :         {
    2416      1349917 :             HeapTuple   heaptup = heaptuples[ndone + nthispage];
    2417              : 
    2418      1349917 :             if (PageGetHeapFreeSpace(page) < MAXALIGN(heaptup->t_len) + saveFreeSpace)
    2419        17542 :                 break;
    2420              : 
    2421      1332375 :             RelationPutHeapTuple(relation, buffer, heaptup, false);
    2422              : 
    2423              :             /*
    2424              :              * For logical decoding we need combo CIDs to properly decode the
    2425              :              * catalog.
    2426              :              */
    2427      1332375 :             if (needwal && need_cids)
    2428         5054 :                 log_heap_new_cid(relation, heaptup);
    2429              :         }
    2430              : 
    2431              :         /*
    2432              :          * If the page is all visible, need to clear that, unless we're only
    2433              :          * going to add further frozen rows to it.
    2434              :          *
    2435              :          * If we're only adding already frozen rows to a previously empty
    2436              :          * page, mark it as all-frozen and update the visibility map. We're
    2437              :          * already holding a pin on the vmbuffer.
    2438              :          */
    2439       501107 :         if (PageIsAllVisible(page) && !(options & HEAP_INSERT_FROZEN))
    2440              :         {
    2441         3501 :             all_visible_cleared = true;
    2442         3501 :             PageClearAllVisible(page);
    2443         3501 :             visibilitymap_clear(relation,
    2444              :                                 BufferGetBlockNumber(buffer),
    2445              :                                 vmbuffer, VISIBILITYMAP_VALID_BITS);
    2446              :         }
    2447       497606 :         else if (all_frozen_set)
    2448              :         {
    2449         1665 :             PageSetAllVisible(page);
    2450         1665 :             PageClearPrunable(page);
    2451         1665 :             visibilitymap_set(BufferGetBlockNumber(buffer),
    2452              :                               vmbuffer,
    2453              :                               VISIBILITYMAP_ALL_VISIBLE |
    2454              :                               VISIBILITYMAP_ALL_FROZEN,
    2455              :                               relation->rd_locator);
    2456              :         }
    2457              : 
    2458              :         /*
    2459              :          * Set pd_prune_xid. See heap_insert() for more on why we do this when
    2460              :          * inserting tuples. This only makes sense if we aren't already
    2461              :          * setting the page frozen in the VM and we're not in bootstrap mode.
    2462              :          */
    2463       501107 :         if (!all_frozen_set && TransactionIdIsNormal(xid))
    2464       476870 :             PageSetPrunable(page, xid);
    2465              : 
    2466       501107 :         MarkBufferDirty(buffer);
    2467              : 
    2468              :         /* XLOG stuff */
    2469       501107 :         if (needwal)
    2470              :         {
    2471              :             XLogRecPtr  recptr;
    2472              :             xl_heap_multi_insert *xlrec;
    2473       497212 :             uint8       info = XLOG_HEAP2_MULTI_INSERT;
    2474              :             char       *tupledata;
    2475              :             int         totaldatalen;
    2476       497212 :             char       *scratchptr = scratch.data;
    2477              :             bool        init;
    2478       497212 :             int         bufflags = 0;
    2479              : 
    2480              :             /*
    2481              :              * If the page was previously empty, we can reinit the page
    2482              :              * instead of restoring the whole thing.
    2483              :              */
    2484       497212 :             init = starting_with_empty_page;
    2485              : 
    2486              :             /* allocate xl_heap_multi_insert struct from the scratch area */
    2487       497212 :             xlrec = (xl_heap_multi_insert *) scratchptr;
    2488       497212 :             scratchptr += SizeOfHeapMultiInsert;
    2489              : 
    2490              :             /*
    2491              :              * Allocate offsets array. Unless we're reinitializing the page,
    2492              :              * in that case the tuples are stored in order starting at
    2493              :              * FirstOffsetNumber and we don't need to store the offsets
    2494              :              * explicitly.
    2495              :              */
    2496       497212 :             if (!init)
    2497       480448 :                 scratchptr += nthispage * sizeof(OffsetNumber);
    2498              : 
    2499              :             /* the rest of the scratch space is used for tuple data */
    2500       497212 :             tupledata = scratchptr;
    2501              : 
    2502              :             /* check that the mutually exclusive flags are not both set */
    2503              :             Assert(!(all_visible_cleared && all_frozen_set));
    2504              : 
    2505       497212 :             xlrec->flags = 0;
    2506       497212 :             if (all_visible_cleared)
    2507         3501 :                 xlrec->flags = XLH_INSERT_ALL_VISIBLE_CLEARED;
    2508              : 
    2509              :             /*
    2510              :              * We don't have to worry about including a conflict xid in the
    2511              :              * WAL record, as HEAP_INSERT_FROZEN intentionally violates
    2512              :              * visibility rules.
    2513              :              */
    2514       497212 :             if (all_frozen_set)
    2515           21 :                 xlrec->flags = XLH_INSERT_ALL_FROZEN_SET;
    2516              : 
    2517       497212 :             xlrec->ntuples = nthispage;
    2518              : 
    2519              :             /*
    2520              :              * Write out an xl_multi_insert_tuple and the tuple data itself
    2521              :              * for each tuple.
    2522              :              */
    2523      2123523 :             for (i = 0; i < nthispage; i++)
    2524              :             {
    2525      1626311 :                 HeapTuple   heaptup = heaptuples[ndone + i];
    2526              :                 xl_multi_insert_tuple *tuphdr;
    2527              :                 int         datalen;
    2528              : 
    2529      1626311 :                 if (!init)
    2530       986921 :                     xlrec->offsets[i] = ItemPointerGetOffsetNumber(&heaptup->t_self);
    2531              :                 /* xl_multi_insert_tuple needs two-byte alignment. */
    2532      1626311 :                 tuphdr = (xl_multi_insert_tuple *) SHORTALIGN(scratchptr);
    2533      1626311 :                 scratchptr = ((char *) tuphdr) + SizeOfMultiInsertTuple;
    2534              : 
    2535      1626311 :                 tuphdr->t_infomask2 = heaptup->t_data->t_infomask2;
    2536      1626311 :                 tuphdr->t_infomask = heaptup->t_data->t_infomask;
    2537      1626311 :                 tuphdr->t_hoff = heaptup->t_data->t_hoff;
    2538              : 
    2539              :                 /* write bitmap [+ padding] [+ oid] + data */
    2540      1626311 :                 datalen = heaptup->t_len - SizeofHeapTupleHeader;
    2541      1626311 :                 memcpy(scratchptr,
    2542      1626311 :                        (char *) heaptup->t_data + SizeofHeapTupleHeader,
    2543              :                        datalen);
    2544      1626311 :                 tuphdr->datalen = datalen;
    2545      1626311 :                 scratchptr += datalen;
    2546              :             }
    2547       497212 :             totaldatalen = scratchptr - tupledata;
    2548              :             Assert((scratchptr - scratch.data) < BLCKSZ);
    2549              : 
    2550       497212 :             if (need_tuple_data)
    2551           56 :                 xlrec->flags |= XLH_INSERT_CONTAINS_NEW_TUPLE;
    2552              : 
    2553              :             /*
    2554              :              * Signal that this is the last xl_heap_multi_insert record
    2555              :              * emitted by this call to heap_multi_insert(). Needed for logical
    2556              :              * decoding so it knows when to cleanup temporary data.
    2557              :              */
    2558       497212 :             if (ndone + nthispage == ntuples)
    2559       483115 :                 xlrec->flags |= XLH_INSERT_LAST_IN_MULTI;
    2560              : 
    2561       497212 :             if (init)
    2562              :             {
    2563        16764 :                 info |= XLOG_HEAP_INIT_PAGE;
    2564        16764 :                 bufflags |= REGBUF_WILL_INIT;
    2565              :             }
    2566              : 
    2567              :             /*
    2568              :              * If we're doing logical decoding, include the new tuple data
    2569              :              * even if we take a full-page image of the page.
    2570              :              */
    2571       497212 :             if (need_tuple_data)
    2572           56 :                 bufflags |= REGBUF_KEEP_DATA;
    2573              : 
    2574       497212 :             XLogBeginInsert();
    2575       497212 :             XLogRegisterData(xlrec, tupledata - scratch.data);
    2576       497212 :             XLogRegisterBuffer(0, buffer, REGBUF_STANDARD | bufflags);
    2577       497212 :             if (all_frozen_set)
    2578           21 :                 XLogRegisterBuffer(1, vmbuffer, 0);
    2579              : 
    2580       497212 :             XLogRegisterBufData(0, tupledata, totaldatalen);
    2581              : 
    2582              :             /* filtering by origin on a row level is much more efficient */
    2583       497212 :             XLogSetRecordFlags(XLOG_INCLUDE_ORIGIN);
    2584              : 
    2585       497212 :             recptr = XLogInsert(RM_HEAP2_ID, info);
    2586              : 
    2587       497212 :             PageSetLSN(page, recptr);
    2588       497212 :             if (all_frozen_set)
    2589              :             {
    2590              :                 Assert(BufferIsDirty(vmbuffer));
    2591           21 :                 PageSetLSN(BufferGetPage(vmbuffer), recptr);
    2592              :             }
    2593              :         }
    2594              : 
    2595       501107 :         END_CRIT_SECTION();
    2596              : 
    2597       501107 :         if (all_frozen_set)
    2598         1665 :             LockBuffer(vmbuffer, BUFFER_LOCK_UNLOCK);
    2599              : 
    2600       501107 :         UnlockReleaseBuffer(buffer);
    2601       501107 :         ndone += nthispage;
    2602              : 
    2603              :         /*
    2604              :          * NB: Only release vmbuffer after inserting all tuples - it's fairly
    2605              :          * likely that we'll insert into subsequent heap pages that are likely
    2606              :          * to use the same vm page.
    2607              :          */
    2608              :     }
    2609              : 
    2610              :     /* We're done with inserting all tuples, so release the last vmbuffer. */
    2611       483565 :     if (vmbuffer != InvalidBuffer)
    2612         3594 :         ReleaseBuffer(vmbuffer);
    2613              : 
    2614              :     /*
    2615              :      * We're done with the actual inserts.  Check for conflicts again, to
    2616              :      * ensure that all rw-conflicts in to these inserts are detected.  Without
    2617              :      * this final check, a sequential scan of the heap may have locked the
    2618              :      * table after the "before" check, missing one opportunity to detect the
    2619              :      * conflict, and then scanned the table before the new tuples were there,
    2620              :      * missing the other chance to detect the conflict.
    2621              :      *
    2622              :      * For heap inserts, we only need to check for table-level SSI locks. Our
    2623              :      * new tuples can't possibly conflict with existing tuple locks, and heap
    2624              :      * page locks are only consolidated versions of tuple locks; they do not
    2625              :      * lock "gaps" as index page locks do.  So we don't need to specify a
    2626              :      * buffer when making the call.
    2627              :      */
    2628       483565 :     CheckForSerializableConflictIn(relation, NULL, InvalidBlockNumber);
    2629              : 
    2630              :     /*
    2631              :      * If tuples are cacheable, mark them for invalidation from the caches in
    2632              :      * case we abort.  Note it is OK to do this after releasing the buffer,
    2633              :      * because the heaptuples data structure is all in local memory, not in
    2634              :      * the shared buffer.
    2635              :      */
    2636       483565 :     if (IsCatalogRelation(relation))
    2637              :     {
    2638      1600487 :         for (i = 0; i < ntuples; i++)
    2639      1118386 :             CacheInvalidateHeapTuple(relation, heaptuples[i], NULL);
    2640              :     }
    2641              : 
    2642              :     /* copy t_self fields back to the caller's slots */
    2643      2317047 :     for (i = 0; i < ntuples; i++)
    2644      1833482 :         slots[i]->tts_tid = heaptuples[i]->t_self;
    2645              : 
    2646       483565 :     pgstat_count_heap_insert(relation, ntuples);
    2647       483565 : }
    2648              : 
    2649              : /*
    2650              :  *  simple_heap_insert - insert a tuple
    2651              :  *
    2652              :  * Currently, this routine differs from heap_insert only in supplying
    2653              :  * a default command ID and not allowing access to the speedup options.
    2654              :  *
    2655              :  * This should be used rather than using heap_insert directly in most places
    2656              :  * where we are modifying system catalogs.
    2657              :  */
    2658              : void
    2659      1083987 : simple_heap_insert(Relation relation, HeapTuple tup)
    2660              : {
    2661      1083987 :     heap_insert(relation, tup, GetCurrentCommandId(true), 0, NULL);
    2662      1083987 : }
    2663              : 
    2664              : /*
    2665              :  * Given infomask/infomask2, compute the bits that must be saved in the
    2666              :  * "infobits" field of xl_heap_delete, xl_heap_update, xl_heap_lock,
    2667              :  * xl_heap_lock_updated WAL records.
    2668              :  *
    2669              :  * See fix_infomask_from_infobits.
    2670              :  */
    2671              : static uint8
    2672      6553712 : compute_infobits(uint16 infomask, uint16 infomask2)
    2673              : {
    2674              :     return
    2675      6553712 :         ((infomask & HEAP_XMAX_IS_MULTI) != 0 ? XLHL_XMAX_IS_MULTI : 0) |
    2676      6553712 :         ((infomask & HEAP_XMAX_LOCK_ONLY) != 0 ? XLHL_XMAX_LOCK_ONLY : 0) |
    2677      6553712 :         ((infomask & HEAP_XMAX_EXCL_LOCK) != 0 ? XLHL_XMAX_EXCL_LOCK : 0) |
    2678              :     /* note we ignore HEAP_XMAX_SHR_LOCK here */
    2679     13107424 :         ((infomask & HEAP_XMAX_KEYSHR_LOCK) != 0 ? XLHL_XMAX_KEYSHR_LOCK : 0) |
    2680              :         ((infomask2 & HEAP_KEYS_UPDATED) != 0 ?
    2681      6553712 :          XLHL_KEYS_UPDATED : 0);
    2682              : }
    2683              : 
    2684              : /*
    2685              :  * Given two versions of the same t_infomask for a tuple, compare them and
    2686              :  * return whether the relevant status for a tuple Xmax has changed.  This is
    2687              :  * used after a buffer lock has been released and reacquired: we want to ensure
    2688              :  * that the tuple state continues to be the same it was when we previously
    2689              :  * examined it.
    2690              :  *
    2691              :  * Note the Xmax field itself must be compared separately.
    2692              :  */
    2693              : static inline bool
    2694         5448 : xmax_infomask_changed(uint16 new_infomask, uint16 old_infomask)
    2695              : {
    2696         5448 :     const uint16 interesting =
    2697              :         HEAP_XMAX_IS_MULTI | HEAP_XMAX_LOCK_ONLY | HEAP_LOCK_MASK;
    2698              : 
    2699         5448 :     if ((new_infomask & interesting) != (old_infomask & interesting))
    2700           18 :         return true;
    2701              : 
    2702         5430 :     return false;
    2703              : }
    2704              : 
    2705              : /*
    2706              :  *  heap_delete - delete a tuple
    2707              :  *
    2708              :  * See table_tuple_delete() for an explanation of the parameters, except that
    2709              :  * this routine directly takes a tuple rather than a slot.
    2710              :  *
    2711              :  * In the failure cases, the routine fills *tmfd with the tuple's t_ctid,
    2712              :  * t_xmax (resolving a possible MultiXact, if necessary), and t_cmax (the last
    2713              :  * only for TM_SelfModified, since we cannot obtain cmax from a combo CID
    2714              :  * generated by another transaction).
    2715              :  */
    2716              : TM_Result
    2717      1895514 : heap_delete(Relation relation, const ItemPointerData *tid,
    2718              :             CommandId cid, uint32 options, Snapshot crosscheck,
    2719              :             bool wait, TM_FailureData *tmfd)
    2720              : {
    2721              :     TM_Result   result;
    2722      1895514 :     TransactionId xid = GetCurrentTransactionId();
    2723              :     ItemId      lp;
    2724              :     HeapTupleData tp;
    2725              :     Page        page;
    2726              :     BlockNumber block;
    2727              :     Buffer      buffer;
    2728      1895514 :     Buffer      vmbuffer = InvalidBuffer;
    2729              :     TransactionId new_xmax;
    2730              :     uint16      new_infomask,
    2731              :                 new_infomask2;
    2732      1895514 :     bool        changingPart = (options & TABLE_DELETE_CHANGING_PARTITION) != 0;
    2733      1895514 :     bool        walLogical = (options & TABLE_DELETE_NO_LOGICAL) == 0;
    2734      1895514 :     bool        have_tuple_lock = false;
    2735              :     bool        iscombo;
    2736      1895514 :     bool        all_visible_cleared = false;
    2737      1895514 :     HeapTuple   old_key_tuple = NULL;   /* replica identity of the tuple */
    2738      1895514 :     bool        old_key_copied = false;
    2739              : 
    2740              :     Assert(ItemPointerIsValid(tid));
    2741              : 
    2742      1895514 :     AssertHasSnapshotForToast(relation);
    2743              : 
    2744              :     /*
    2745              :      * Forbid this during a parallel operation, lest it allocate a combo CID.
    2746              :      * Other workers might need that combo CID for visibility checks, and we
    2747              :      * have no provision for broadcasting it to them.
    2748              :      */
    2749      1895514 :     if (IsInParallelMode())
    2750            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    2751              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_TRANSACTION_STATE),
    2752              :                  errmsg("cannot delete tuples during a parallel operation")));
    2753              : 
    2754      1895514 :     block = ItemPointerGetBlockNumber(tid);
    2755      1895514 :     buffer = ReadBuffer(relation, block);
    2756      1895514 :     page = BufferGetPage(buffer);
    2757              : 
    2758              :     /*
    2759              :      * Before locking the buffer, pin the visibility map page if it appears to
    2760              :      * be necessary.  Since we haven't got the lock yet, someone else might be
    2761              :      * in the middle of changing this, so we'll need to recheck after we have
    2762              :      * the lock.
    2763              :      */
    2764      1895514 :     if (PageIsAllVisible(page))
    2765         1773 :         visibilitymap_pin(relation, block, &vmbuffer);
    2766              : 
    2767      1895514 :     LockBuffer(buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_EXCLUSIVE);
    2768              : 
    2769      1895514 :     lp = PageGetItemId(page, ItemPointerGetOffsetNumber(tid));
    2770              :     Assert(ItemIdIsNormal(lp));
    2771              : 
    2772      1895514 :     tp.t_tableOid = RelationGetRelid(relation);
    2773      1895514 :     tp.t_data = (HeapTupleHeader) PageGetItem(page, lp);
    2774      1895514 :     tp.t_len = ItemIdGetLength(lp);
    2775      1895514 :     tp.t_self = *tid;
    2776              : 
    2777            1 : l1:
    2778              : 
    2779              :     /*
    2780              :      * If we didn't pin the visibility map page and the page has become all
    2781              :      * visible while we were busy locking the buffer, we'll have to unlock and
    2782              :      * re-lock, to avoid holding the buffer lock across an I/O.  That's a bit
    2783              :      * unfortunate, but hopefully shouldn't happen often.
    2784              :      */
    2785      1895515 :     if (vmbuffer == InvalidBuffer && PageIsAllVisible(page))
    2786              :     {
    2787            0 :         LockBuffer(buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_UNLOCK);
    2788            0 :         visibilitymap_pin(relation, block, &vmbuffer);
    2789            0 :         LockBuffer(buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_EXCLUSIVE);
    2790              :     }
    2791              : 
    2792      1895515 :     result = HeapTupleSatisfiesUpdate(&tp, cid, buffer);
    2793              : 
    2794      1895515 :     if (result == TM_Invisible)
    2795              :     {
    2796            0 :         UnlockReleaseBuffer(buffer);
    2797            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    2798              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    2799              :                  errmsg("attempted to delete invisible tuple")));
    2800              :     }
    2801      1895515 :     else if (result == TM_BeingModified && wait)
    2802              :     {
    2803              :         TransactionId xwait;
    2804              :         uint16      infomask;
    2805              : 
    2806              :         /* must copy state data before unlocking buffer */
    2807        40668 :         xwait = HeapTupleHeaderGetRawXmax(tp.t_data);
    2808        40668 :         infomask = tp.t_data->t_infomask;
    2809              : 
    2810              :         /*
    2811              :          * Sleep until concurrent transaction ends -- except when there's a
    2812              :          * single locker and it's our own transaction.  Note we don't care
    2813              :          * which lock mode the locker has, because we need the strongest one.
    2814              :          *
    2815              :          * Before sleeping, we need to acquire tuple lock to establish our
    2816              :          * priority for the tuple (see heap_lock_tuple).  LockTuple will
    2817              :          * release us when we are next-in-line for the tuple.
    2818              :          *
    2819              :          * If we are forced to "start over" below, we keep the tuple lock;
    2820              :          * this arranges that we stay at the head of the line while rechecking
    2821              :          * tuple state.
    2822              :          */
    2823        40668 :         if (infomask & HEAP_XMAX_IS_MULTI)
    2824              :         {
    2825            8 :             bool        current_is_member = false;
    2826              : 
    2827            8 :             if (DoesMultiXactIdConflict((MultiXactId) xwait, infomask,
    2828              :                                         LockTupleExclusive, &current_is_member))
    2829              :             {
    2830            8 :                 LockBuffer(buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_UNLOCK);
    2831              : 
    2832              :                 /*
    2833              :                  * Acquire the lock, if necessary (but skip it when we're
    2834              :                  * requesting a lock and already have one; avoids deadlock).
    2835              :                  */
    2836            8 :                 if (!current_is_member)
    2837            6 :                     heap_acquire_tuplock(relation, &(tp.t_self), LockTupleExclusive,
    2838              :                                          LockWaitBlock, &have_tuple_lock);
    2839              : 
    2840              :                 /* wait for multixact */
    2841            8 :                 MultiXactIdWait((MultiXactId) xwait, MultiXactStatusUpdate, infomask,
    2842              :                                 relation, &(tp.t_self), XLTW_Delete,
    2843              :                                 NULL);
    2844            8 :                 LockBuffer(buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_EXCLUSIVE);
    2845              : 
    2846              :                 /*
    2847              :                  * If xwait had just locked the tuple then some other xact
    2848              :                  * could update this tuple before we get to this point.  Check
    2849              :                  * for xmax change, and start over if so.
    2850              :                  *
    2851              :                  * We also must start over if we didn't pin the VM page, and
    2852              :                  * the page has become all visible.
    2853              :                  */
    2854           16 :                 if ((vmbuffer == InvalidBuffer && PageIsAllVisible(page)) ||
    2855           16 :                     xmax_infomask_changed(tp.t_data->t_infomask, infomask) ||
    2856            8 :                     !TransactionIdEquals(HeapTupleHeaderGetRawXmax(tp.t_data),
    2857              :                                          xwait))
    2858            0 :                     goto l1;
    2859              :             }
    2860              : 
    2861              :             /*
    2862              :              * You might think the multixact is necessarily done here, but not
    2863              :              * so: it could have surviving members, namely our own xact or
    2864              :              * other subxacts of this backend.  It is legal for us to delete
    2865              :              * the tuple in either case, however (the latter case is
    2866              :              * essentially a situation of upgrading our former shared lock to
    2867              :              * exclusive).  We don't bother changing the on-disk hint bits
    2868              :              * since we are about to overwrite the xmax altogether.
    2869              :              */
    2870              :         }
    2871        40660 :         else if (!TransactionIdIsCurrentTransactionId(xwait))
    2872              :         {
    2873              :             /*
    2874              :              * Wait for regular transaction to end; but first, acquire tuple
    2875              :              * lock.
    2876              :              */
    2877           70 :             LockBuffer(buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_UNLOCK);
    2878           70 :             heap_acquire_tuplock(relation, &(tp.t_self), LockTupleExclusive,
    2879              :                                  LockWaitBlock, &have_tuple_lock);
    2880           70 :             XactLockTableWait(xwait, relation, &(tp.t_self), XLTW_Delete);
    2881           66 :             LockBuffer(buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_EXCLUSIVE);
    2882              : 
    2883              :             /*
    2884              :              * xwait is done, but if xwait had just locked the tuple then some
    2885              :              * other xact could update this tuple before we get to this point.
    2886              :              * Check for xmax change, and start over if so.
    2887              :              *
    2888              :              * We also must start over if we didn't pin the VM page, and the
    2889              :              * page has become all visible.
    2890              :              */
    2891          132 :             if ((vmbuffer == InvalidBuffer && PageIsAllVisible(page)) ||
    2892          131 :                 xmax_infomask_changed(tp.t_data->t_infomask, infomask) ||
    2893           65 :                 !TransactionIdEquals(HeapTupleHeaderGetRawXmax(tp.t_data),
    2894              :                                      xwait))
    2895            1 :                 goto l1;
    2896              : 
    2897              :             /* Otherwise check if it committed or aborted */
    2898           65 :             UpdateXmaxHintBits(tp.t_data, buffer, xwait);
    2899              :         }
    2900              : 
    2901              :         /*
    2902              :          * We may overwrite if previous xmax aborted, or if it committed but
    2903              :          * only locked the tuple without updating it.
    2904              :          */
    2905        81306 :         if ((tp.t_data->t_infomask & HEAP_XMAX_INVALID) ||
    2906        40692 :             HEAP_XMAX_IS_LOCKED_ONLY(tp.t_data->t_infomask) ||
    2907           49 :             HeapTupleHeaderIsOnlyLocked(tp.t_data))
    2908        40618 :             result = TM_Ok;
    2909           45 :         else if (!ItemPointerEquals(&tp.t_self, &tp.t_data->t_ctid))
    2910           32 :             result = TM_Updated;
    2911              :         else
    2912           13 :             result = TM_Deleted;
    2913              :     }
    2914              : 
    2915              :     /* sanity check the result HeapTupleSatisfiesUpdate() and the logic above */
    2916              :     if (result != TM_Ok)
    2917              :     {
    2918              :         Assert(result == TM_SelfModified ||
    2919              :                result == TM_Updated ||
    2920              :                result == TM_Deleted ||
    2921              :                result == TM_BeingModified);
    2922              :         Assert(!(tp.t_data->t_infomask & HEAP_XMAX_INVALID));
    2923              :         Assert(result != TM_Updated ||
    2924              :                !ItemPointerEquals(&tp.t_self, &tp.t_data->t_ctid));
    2925              :     }
    2926              : 
    2927      1895510 :     if (crosscheck != InvalidSnapshot && result == TM_Ok)
    2928              :     {
    2929              :         /* Perform additional check for transaction-snapshot mode RI updates */
    2930            1 :         if (!HeapTupleSatisfiesVisibility(&tp, crosscheck, buffer))
    2931            1 :             result = TM_Updated;
    2932              :     }
    2933              : 
    2934      1895510 :     if (result != TM_Ok)
    2935              :     {
    2936          101 :         tmfd->ctid = tp.t_data->t_ctid;
    2937          101 :         tmfd->xmax = HeapTupleHeaderGetUpdateXid(tp.t_data);
    2938          101 :         if (result == TM_SelfModified)
    2939           36 :             tmfd->cmax = HeapTupleHeaderGetCmax(tp.t_data);
    2940              :         else
    2941           65 :             tmfd->cmax = InvalidCommandId;
    2942          101 :         UnlockReleaseBuffer(buffer);
    2943          101 :         if (have_tuple_lock)
    2944           45 :             UnlockTupleTuplock(relation, &(tp.t_self), LockTupleExclusive);
    2945          101 :         if (vmbuffer != InvalidBuffer)
    2946            0 :             ReleaseBuffer(vmbuffer);
    2947          101 :         return result;
    2948              :     }
    2949              : 
    2950              :     /*
    2951              :      * We're about to do the actual delete -- check for conflict first, to
    2952              :      * avoid possibly having to roll back work we've just done.
    2953              :      *
    2954              :      * This is safe without a recheck as long as there is no possibility of
    2955              :      * another process scanning the page between this check and the delete
    2956              :      * being visible to the scan (i.e., an exclusive buffer content lock is
    2957              :      * continuously held from this point until the tuple delete is visible).
    2958              :      */
    2959      1895409 :     CheckForSerializableConflictIn(relation, tid, BufferGetBlockNumber(buffer));
    2960              : 
    2961              :     /* replace cid with a combo CID if necessary */
    2962      1895395 :     HeapTupleHeaderAdjustCmax(tp.t_data, &cid, &iscombo);
    2963              : 
    2964              :     /*
    2965              :      * Compute replica identity tuple before entering the critical section so
    2966              :      * we don't PANIC upon a memory allocation failure.
    2967              :      */
    2968      1895395 :     old_key_tuple = walLogical ?
    2969      1895395 :         ExtractReplicaIdentity(relation, &tp, true, &old_key_copied) : NULL;
    2970              : 
    2971              :     /*
    2972              :      * If this is the first possibly-multixact-able operation in the current
    2973              :      * transaction, set my per-backend OldestMemberMXactId setting. We can be
    2974              :      * certain that the transaction will never become a member of any older
    2975              :      * MultiXactIds than that.  (We have to do this even if we end up just
    2976              :      * using our own TransactionId below, since some other backend could
    2977              :      * incorporate our XID into a MultiXact immediately afterwards.)
    2978              :      */
    2979      1895395 :     MultiXactIdSetOldestMember();
    2980              : 
    2981      1895395 :     compute_new_xmax_infomask(HeapTupleHeaderGetRawXmax(tp.t_data),
    2982      1895395 :                               tp.t_data->t_infomask, tp.t_data->t_infomask2,
    2983              :                               xid, LockTupleExclusive, true,
    2984              :                               &new_xmax, &new_infomask, &new_infomask2);
    2985              : 
    2986      1895395 :     START_CRIT_SECTION();
    2987              : 
    2988              :     /*
    2989              :      * If this transaction commits, the tuple will become DEAD sooner or
    2990              :      * later.  Set flag that this page is a candidate for pruning once our xid
    2991              :      * falls below the OldestXmin horizon.  If the transaction finally aborts,
    2992              :      * the subsequent page pruning will be a no-op and the hint will be
    2993              :      * cleared.
    2994              :      */
    2995      1895395 :     PageSetPrunable(page, xid);
    2996              : 
    2997      1895395 :     if (PageIsAllVisible(page))
    2998              :     {
    2999         1773 :         all_visible_cleared = true;
    3000         1773 :         PageClearAllVisible(page);
    3001         1773 :         visibilitymap_clear(relation, BufferGetBlockNumber(buffer),
    3002              :                             vmbuffer, VISIBILITYMAP_VALID_BITS);
    3003              :     }
    3004              : 
    3005              :     /* store transaction information of xact deleting the tuple */
    3006      1895395 :     tp.t_data->t_infomask &= ~(HEAP_XMAX_BITS | HEAP_MOVED);
    3007      1895395 :     tp.t_data->t_infomask2 &= ~HEAP_KEYS_UPDATED;
    3008      1895395 :     tp.t_data->t_infomask |= new_infomask;
    3009      1895395 :     tp.t_data->t_infomask2 |= new_infomask2;
    3010      1895395 :     HeapTupleHeaderClearHotUpdated(tp.t_data);
    3011      1895395 :     HeapTupleHeaderSetXmax(tp.t_data, new_xmax);
    3012      1895395 :     HeapTupleHeaderSetCmax(tp.t_data, cid, iscombo);
    3013              :     /* Make sure there is no forward chain link in t_ctid */
    3014      1895395 :     tp.t_data->t_ctid = tp.t_self;
    3015              : 
    3016              :     /* Signal that this is actually a move into another partition */
    3017      1895395 :     if (changingPart)
    3018          666 :         HeapTupleHeaderSetMovedPartitions(tp.t_data);
    3019              : 
    3020      1895395 :     MarkBufferDirty(buffer);
    3021              : 
    3022              :     /*
    3023              :      * XLOG stuff
    3024              :      *
    3025              :      * NB: heap_abort_speculative() uses the same xlog record and replay
    3026              :      * routines.
    3027              :      */
    3028      1895395 :     if (RelationNeedsWAL(relation))
    3029              :     {
    3030              :         xl_heap_delete xlrec;
    3031              :         xl_heap_header xlhdr;
    3032              :         XLogRecPtr  recptr;
    3033              : 
    3034              :         /*
    3035              :          * For logical decode we need combo CIDs to properly decode the
    3036              :          * catalog
    3037              :          */
    3038      1812152 :         if (RelationIsAccessibleInLogicalDecoding(relation))
    3039        10308 :             log_heap_new_cid(relation, &tp);
    3040              : 
    3041      1812152 :         xlrec.flags = 0;
    3042      1812152 :         if (all_visible_cleared)
    3043         1773 :             xlrec.flags |= XLH_DELETE_ALL_VISIBLE_CLEARED;
    3044      1812152 :         if (changingPart)
    3045          666 :             xlrec.flags |= XLH_DELETE_IS_PARTITION_MOVE;
    3046      3624304 :         xlrec.infobits_set = compute_infobits(tp.t_data->t_infomask,
    3047      1812152 :                                               tp.t_data->t_infomask2);
    3048      1812152 :         xlrec.offnum = ItemPointerGetOffsetNumber(&tp.t_self);
    3049      1812152 :         xlrec.xmax = new_xmax;
    3050              : 
    3051      1812152 :         if (old_key_tuple != NULL)
    3052              :         {
    3053        47028 :             if (relation->rd_rel->relreplident == REPLICA_IDENTITY_FULL)
    3054          135 :                 xlrec.flags |= XLH_DELETE_CONTAINS_OLD_TUPLE;
    3055              :             else
    3056        46893 :                 xlrec.flags |= XLH_DELETE_CONTAINS_OLD_KEY;
    3057              :         }
    3058              : 
    3059              :         /*
    3060              :          * Mark the change as not-for-logical-decoding if caller requested so.
    3061              :          *
    3062              :          * (This is used for changes that affect relations not visible to
    3063              :          * other transactions, such as the transient table during concurrent
    3064              :          * repack.)
    3065              :          */
    3066      1812152 :         if (!walLogical)
    3067            3 :             xlrec.flags |= XLH_DELETE_NO_LOGICAL;
    3068              : 
    3069      1812152 :         XLogBeginInsert();
    3070      1812152 :         XLogRegisterData(&xlrec, SizeOfHeapDelete);
    3071              : 
    3072      1812152 :         XLogRegisterBuffer(0, buffer, REGBUF_STANDARD);
    3073              : 
    3074              :         /*
    3075              :          * Log replica identity of the deleted tuple if there is one
    3076              :          */
    3077      1812152 :         if (old_key_tuple != NULL)
    3078              :         {
    3079        47028 :             xlhdr.t_infomask2 = old_key_tuple->t_data->t_infomask2;
    3080        47028 :             xlhdr.t_infomask = old_key_tuple->t_data->t_infomask;
    3081        47028 :             xlhdr.t_hoff = old_key_tuple->t_data->t_hoff;
    3082              : 
    3083        47028 :             XLogRegisterData(&xlhdr, SizeOfHeapHeader);
    3084        47028 :             XLogRegisterData((char *) old_key_tuple->t_data
    3085              :                              + SizeofHeapTupleHeader,
    3086        47028 :                              old_key_tuple->t_len
    3087              :                              - SizeofHeapTupleHeader);
    3088              :         }
    3089              : 
    3090              :         /* filtering by origin on a row level is much more efficient */
    3091      1812152 :         XLogSetRecordFlags(XLOG_INCLUDE_ORIGIN);
    3092              : 
    3093      1812152 :         recptr = XLogInsert(RM_HEAP_ID, XLOG_HEAP_DELETE);
    3094              : 
    3095      1812152 :         PageSetLSN(page, recptr);
    3096              :     }
    3097              : 
    3098      1895395 :     END_CRIT_SECTION();
    3099              : 
    3100      1895395 :     LockBuffer(buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_UNLOCK);
    3101              : 
    3102      1895395 :     if (vmbuffer != InvalidBuffer)
    3103         1773 :         ReleaseBuffer(vmbuffer);
    3104              : 
    3105              :     /*
    3106              :      * If the tuple has toasted out-of-line attributes, we need to delete
    3107              :      * those items too.  We have to do this before releasing the buffer
    3108              :      * because we need to look at the contents of the tuple, but it's OK to
    3109              :      * release the content lock on the buffer first.
    3110              :      */
    3111      1899175 :     if (relation->rd_rel->relkind != RELKIND_RELATION &&
    3112         3793 :         relation->rd_rel->relkind != RELKIND_MATVIEW)
    3113              :     {
    3114              :         /* toast table entries should never be recursively toasted */
    3115              :         Assert(!HeapTupleHasExternal(&tp));
    3116              :     }
    3117      1891615 :     else if (HeapTupleHasExternal(&tp))
    3118          534 :         heap_toast_delete(relation, &tp, false);
    3119              : 
    3120              :     /*
    3121              :      * Mark tuple for invalidation from system caches at next command
    3122              :      * boundary. We have to do this before releasing the buffer because we
    3123              :      * need to look at the contents of the tuple.
    3124              :      */
    3125      1895395 :     CacheInvalidateHeapTuple(relation, &tp, NULL);
    3126              : 
    3127              :     /* Now we can release the buffer */
    3128      1895395 :     ReleaseBuffer(buffer);
    3129              : 
    3130              :     /*
    3131              :      * Release the lmgr tuple lock, if we had it.
    3132              :      */
    3133      1895395 :     if (have_tuple_lock)
    3134           26 :         UnlockTupleTuplock(relation, &(tp.t_self), LockTupleExclusive);
    3135              : 
    3136      1895395 :     pgstat_count_heap_delete(relation);
    3137              : 
    3138      1895395 :     if (old_key_tuple != NULL && old_key_copied)
    3139        46894 :         heap_freetuple(old_key_tuple);
    3140              : 
    3141      1895395 :     return TM_Ok;
    3142              : }
    3143              : 
    3144              : /*
    3145              :  *  simple_heap_delete - delete a tuple
    3146              :  *
    3147              :  * This routine may be used to delete a tuple when concurrent updates of
    3148              :  * the target tuple are not expected (for example, because we have a lock
    3149              :  * on the relation associated with the tuple).  Any failure is reported
    3150              :  * via ereport().
    3151              :  */
    3152              : void
    3153       823639 : simple_heap_delete(Relation relation, const ItemPointerData *tid)
    3154              : {
    3155              :     TM_Result   result;
    3156              :     TM_FailureData tmfd;
    3157              : 
    3158       823639 :     result = heap_delete(relation, tid,
    3159              :                          GetCurrentCommandId(true),
    3160              :                          0,
    3161              :                          InvalidSnapshot,
    3162              :                          true /* wait for commit */ ,
    3163              :                          &tmfd);
    3164       823639 :     switch (result)
    3165              :     {
    3166            0 :         case TM_SelfModified:
    3167              :             /* Tuple was already updated in current command? */
    3168            0 :             elog(ERROR, "tuple already updated by self");
    3169              :             break;
    3170              : 
    3171       823639 :         case TM_Ok:
    3172              :             /* done successfully */
    3173       823639 :             break;
    3174              : 
    3175            0 :         case TM_Updated:
    3176            0 :             elog(ERROR, "tuple concurrently updated");
    3177              :             break;
    3178              : 
    3179            0 :         case TM_Deleted:
    3180            0 :             elog(ERROR, "tuple concurrently deleted");
    3181              :             break;
    3182              : 
    3183            0 :         default:
    3184            0 :             elog(ERROR, "unrecognized heap_delete status: %u", result);
    3185              :             break;
    3186              :     }
    3187       823639 : }
    3188              : 
    3189              : /*
    3190              :  *  heap_update - replace a tuple
    3191              :  *
    3192              :  * See table_tuple_update() for an explanation of the parameters, except that
    3193              :  * this routine directly takes a tuple rather than a slot.
    3194              :  *
    3195              :  * In the failure cases, the routine fills *tmfd with the tuple's t_ctid,
    3196              :  * t_xmax (resolving a possible MultiXact, if necessary), and t_cmax (the last
    3197              :  * only for TM_SelfModified, since we cannot obtain cmax from a combo CID
    3198              :  * generated by another transaction).
    3199              :  */
    3200              : TM_Result
    3201      2394797 : heap_update(Relation relation, const ItemPointerData *otid, HeapTuple newtup,
    3202              :             CommandId cid, uint32 options pg_attribute_unused(), Snapshot crosscheck, bool wait,
    3203              :             TM_FailureData *tmfd, LockTupleMode *lockmode,
    3204              :             TU_UpdateIndexes *update_indexes)
    3205              : {
    3206              :     TM_Result   result;
    3207      2394797 :     TransactionId xid = GetCurrentTransactionId();
    3208              :     Bitmapset  *hot_attrs;
    3209              :     Bitmapset  *sum_attrs;
    3210              :     Bitmapset  *key_attrs;
    3211              :     Bitmapset  *id_attrs;
    3212              :     Bitmapset  *interesting_attrs;
    3213              :     Bitmapset  *modified_attrs;
    3214              :     ItemId      lp;
    3215              :     HeapTupleData oldtup;
    3216              :     HeapTuple   heaptup;
    3217      2394797 :     HeapTuple   old_key_tuple = NULL;
    3218      2394797 :     bool        old_key_copied = false;
    3219      2394797 :     bool        walLogical = (options & TABLE_UPDATE_NO_LOGICAL) == 0;
    3220              :     Page        page,
    3221              :                 newpage;
    3222              :     BlockNumber block;
    3223              :     MultiXactStatus mxact_status;
    3224              :     Buffer      buffer,
    3225              :                 newbuf,
    3226      2394797 :                 vmbuffer = InvalidBuffer,
    3227      2394797 :                 vmbuffer_new = InvalidBuffer;
    3228              :     bool        need_toast;
    3229              :     Size        newtupsize,
    3230              :                 pagefree;
    3231      2394797 :     bool        have_tuple_lock = false;
    3232              :     bool        iscombo;
    3233      2394797 :     bool        use_hot_update = false;
    3234      2394797 :     bool        summarized_update = false;
    3235              :     bool        key_intact;
    3236      2394797 :     bool        all_visible_cleared = false;
    3237      2394797 :     bool        all_visible_cleared_new = false;
    3238              :     bool        checked_lockers;
    3239              :     bool        locker_remains;
    3240      2394797 :     bool        id_has_external = false;
    3241              :     TransactionId xmax_new_tuple,
    3242              :                 xmax_old_tuple;
    3243              :     uint16      infomask_old_tuple,
    3244              :                 infomask2_old_tuple,
    3245              :                 infomask_new_tuple,
    3246              :                 infomask2_new_tuple;
    3247              : 
    3248              :     Assert(ItemPointerIsValid(otid));
    3249              : 
    3250              :     /* Cheap, simplistic check that the tuple matches the rel's rowtype. */
    3251              :     Assert(HeapTupleHeaderGetNatts(newtup->t_data) <=
    3252              :            RelationGetNumberOfAttributes(relation));
    3253              : 
    3254      2394797 :     AssertHasSnapshotForToast(relation);
    3255              : 
    3256              :     /*
    3257              :      * Forbid this during a parallel operation, lest it allocate a combo CID.
    3258              :      * Other workers might need that combo CID for visibility checks, and we
    3259              :      * have no provision for broadcasting it to them.
    3260              :      */
    3261      2394797 :     if (IsInParallelMode())
    3262            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    3263              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_TRANSACTION_STATE),
    3264              :                  errmsg("cannot update tuples during a parallel operation")));
    3265              : 
    3266              : #ifdef USE_ASSERT_CHECKING
    3267              :     check_lock_if_inplace_updateable_rel(relation, otid, newtup);
    3268              : #endif
    3269              : 
    3270              :     /*
    3271              :      * Fetch the list of attributes to be checked for various operations.
    3272              :      *
    3273              :      * For HOT considerations, this is wasted effort if we fail to update or
    3274              :      * have to put the new tuple on a different page.  But we must compute the
    3275              :      * list before obtaining buffer lock --- in the worst case, if we are
    3276              :      * doing an update on one of the relevant system catalogs, we could
    3277              :      * deadlock if we try to fetch the list later.  In any case, the relcache
    3278              :      * caches the data so this is usually pretty cheap.
    3279              :      *
    3280              :      * We also need columns used by the replica identity and columns that are
    3281              :      * considered the "key" of rows in the table.
    3282              :      *
    3283              :      * Note that we get copies of each bitmap, so we need not worry about
    3284              :      * relcache flush happening midway through.
    3285              :      */
    3286      2394797 :     hot_attrs = RelationGetIndexAttrBitmap(relation,
    3287              :                                            INDEX_ATTR_BITMAP_HOT_BLOCKING);
    3288      2394797 :     sum_attrs = RelationGetIndexAttrBitmap(relation,
    3289              :                                            INDEX_ATTR_BITMAP_SUMMARIZED);
    3290      2394797 :     key_attrs = RelationGetIndexAttrBitmap(relation, INDEX_ATTR_BITMAP_KEY);
    3291      2394797 :     id_attrs = RelationGetIndexAttrBitmap(relation,
    3292              :                                           INDEX_ATTR_BITMAP_IDENTITY_KEY);
    3293      2394797 :     interesting_attrs = NULL;
    3294      2394797 :     interesting_attrs = bms_add_members(interesting_attrs, hot_attrs);
    3295      2394797 :     interesting_attrs = bms_add_members(interesting_attrs, sum_attrs);
    3296      2394797 :     interesting_attrs = bms_add_members(interesting_attrs, key_attrs);
    3297      2394797 :     interesting_attrs = bms_add_members(interesting_attrs, id_attrs);
    3298              : 
    3299      2394797 :     block = ItemPointerGetBlockNumber(otid);
    3300      2394797 :     INJECTION_POINT("heap_update-before-pin", NULL);
    3301      2394797 :     buffer = ReadBuffer(relation, block);
    3302      2394797 :     page = BufferGetPage(buffer);
    3303              : 
    3304              :     /*
    3305              :      * Before locking the buffer, pin the visibility map page if it appears to
    3306              :      * be necessary.  Since we haven't got the lock yet, someone else might be
    3307              :      * in the middle of changing this, so we'll need to recheck after we have
    3308              :      * the lock.
    3309              :      */
    3310      2394797 :     if (PageIsAllVisible(page))
    3311         2140 :         visibilitymap_pin(relation, block, &vmbuffer);
    3312              : 
    3313      2394797 :     LockBuffer(buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_EXCLUSIVE);
    3314              : 
    3315      2394797 :     lp = PageGetItemId(page, ItemPointerGetOffsetNumber(otid));
    3316              : 
    3317              :     /*
    3318              :      * Usually, a buffer pin and/or snapshot blocks pruning of otid, ensuring
    3319              :      * we see LP_NORMAL here.  When the otid origin is a syscache, we may have
    3320              :      * neither a pin nor a snapshot.  Hence, we may see other LP_ states, each
    3321              :      * of which indicates concurrent pruning.
    3322              :      *
    3323              :      * Failing with TM_Updated would be most accurate.  However, unlike other
    3324              :      * TM_Updated scenarios, we don't know the successor ctid in LP_UNUSED and
    3325              :      * LP_DEAD cases.  While the distinction between TM_Updated and TM_Deleted
    3326              :      * does matter to SQL statements UPDATE and MERGE, those SQL statements
    3327              :      * hold a snapshot that ensures LP_NORMAL.  Hence, the choice between
    3328              :      * TM_Updated and TM_Deleted affects only the wording of error messages.
    3329              :      * Settle on TM_Deleted, for two reasons.  First, it avoids complicating
    3330              :      * the specification of when tmfd->ctid is valid.  Second, it creates
    3331              :      * error log evidence that we took this branch.
    3332              :      *
    3333              :      * Since it's possible to see LP_UNUSED at otid, it's also possible to see
    3334              :      * LP_NORMAL for a tuple that replaced LP_UNUSED.  If it's a tuple for an
    3335              :      * unrelated row, we'll fail with "duplicate key value violates unique".
    3336              :      * XXX if otid is the live, newer version of the newtup row, we'll discard
    3337              :      * changes originating in versions of this catalog row after the version
    3338              :      * the caller got from syscache.  See syscache-update-pruned.spec.
    3339              :      */
    3340      2394797 :     if (!ItemIdIsNormal(lp))
    3341              :     {
    3342              :         Assert(RelationSupportsSysCache(RelationGetRelid(relation)));
    3343              : 
    3344            1 :         UnlockReleaseBuffer(buffer);
    3345              :         Assert(!have_tuple_lock);
    3346            1 :         if (vmbuffer != InvalidBuffer)
    3347            1 :             ReleaseBuffer(vmbuffer);
    3348            1 :         tmfd->ctid = *otid;
    3349            1 :         tmfd->xmax = InvalidTransactionId;
    3350            1 :         tmfd->cmax = InvalidCommandId;
    3351            1 :         *update_indexes = TU_None;
    3352              : 
    3353            1 :         bms_free(hot_attrs);
    3354            1 :         bms_free(sum_attrs);
    3355            1 :         bms_free(key_attrs);
    3356            1 :         bms_free(id_attrs);
    3357              :         /* modified_attrs not yet initialized */
    3358            1 :         bms_free(interesting_attrs);
    3359            1 :         return TM_Deleted;
    3360              :     }
    3361              : 
    3362              :     /*
    3363              :      * Fill in enough data in oldtup for HeapDetermineColumnsInfo to work
    3364              :      * properly.
    3365              :      */
    3366      2394796 :     oldtup.t_tableOid = RelationGetRelid(relation);
    3367      2394796 :     oldtup.t_data = (HeapTupleHeader) PageGetItem(page, lp);
    3368      2394796 :     oldtup.t_len = ItemIdGetLength(lp);
    3369      2394796 :     oldtup.t_self = *otid;
    3370              : 
    3371              :     /* the new tuple is ready, except for this: */
    3372      2394796 :     newtup->t_tableOid = RelationGetRelid(relation);
    3373              : 
    3374              :     /*
    3375              :      * Determine columns modified by the update.  Additionally, identify
    3376              :      * whether any of the unmodified replica identity key attributes in the
    3377              :      * old tuple is externally stored or not.  This is required because for
    3378              :      * such attributes the flattened value won't be WAL logged as part of the
    3379              :      * new tuple so we must include it as part of the old_key_tuple.  See
    3380              :      * ExtractReplicaIdentity.
    3381              :      */
    3382      2394796 :     modified_attrs = HeapDetermineColumnsInfo(relation, interesting_attrs,
    3383              :                                               id_attrs, &oldtup,
    3384              :                                               newtup, &id_has_external);
    3385              : 
    3386              :     /*
    3387              :      * If we're not updating any "key" column, we can grab a weaker lock type.
    3388              :      * This allows for more concurrency when we are running simultaneously
    3389              :      * with foreign key checks.
    3390              :      *
    3391              :      * Note that if a column gets detoasted while executing the update, but
    3392              :      * the value ends up being the same, this test will fail and we will use
    3393              :      * the stronger lock.  This is acceptable; the important case to optimize
    3394              :      * is updates that don't manipulate key columns, not those that
    3395              :      * serendipitously arrive at the same key values.
    3396              :      */
    3397      2394796 :     if (!bms_overlap(modified_attrs, key_attrs))
    3398              :     {
    3399      2388884 :         *lockmode = LockTupleNoKeyExclusive;
    3400      2388884 :         mxact_status = MultiXactStatusNoKeyUpdate;
    3401      2388884 :         key_intact = true;
    3402              : 
    3403              :         /*
    3404              :          * If this is the first possibly-multixact-able operation in the
    3405              :          * current transaction, set my per-backend OldestMemberMXactId
    3406              :          * setting. We can be certain that the transaction will never become a
    3407              :          * member of any older MultiXactIds than that.  (We have to do this
    3408              :          * even if we end up just using our own TransactionId below, since
    3409              :          * some other backend could incorporate our XID into a MultiXact
    3410              :          * immediately afterwards.)
    3411              :          */
    3412      2388884 :         MultiXactIdSetOldestMember();
    3413              :     }
    3414              :     else
    3415              :     {
    3416         5912 :         *lockmode = LockTupleExclusive;
    3417         5912 :         mxact_status = MultiXactStatusUpdate;
    3418         5912 :         key_intact = false;
    3419              :     }
    3420              : 
    3421              :     /*
    3422              :      * Note: beyond this point, use oldtup not otid to refer to old tuple.
    3423              :      * otid may very well point at newtup->t_self, which we will overwrite
    3424              :      * with the new tuple's location, so there's great risk of confusion if we
    3425              :      * use otid anymore.
    3426              :      */
    3427              : 
    3428            1 : l2:
    3429      2394797 :     checked_lockers = false;
    3430      2394797 :     locker_remains = false;
    3431      2394797 :     result = HeapTupleSatisfiesUpdate(&oldtup, cid, buffer);
    3432              : 
    3433              :     /* see below about the "no wait" case */
    3434              :     Assert(result != TM_BeingModified || wait);
    3435              : 
    3436      2394797 :     if (result == TM_Invisible)
    3437              :     {
    3438            0 :         UnlockReleaseBuffer(buffer);
    3439            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    3440              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    3441              :                  errmsg("attempted to update invisible tuple")));
    3442              :     }
    3443      2394797 :     else if (result == TM_BeingModified && wait)
    3444              :     {
    3445              :         TransactionId xwait;
    3446              :         uint16      infomask;
    3447        36540 :         bool        can_continue = false;
    3448              : 
    3449              :         /*
    3450              :          * XXX note that we don't consider the "no wait" case here.  This
    3451              :          * isn't a problem currently because no caller uses that case, but it
    3452              :          * should be fixed if such a caller is introduced.  It wasn't a
    3453              :          * problem previously because this code would always wait, but now
    3454              :          * that some tuple locks do not conflict with one of the lock modes we
    3455              :          * use, it is possible that this case is interesting to handle
    3456              :          * specially.
    3457              :          *
    3458              :          * This may cause failures with third-party code that calls
    3459              :          * heap_update directly.
    3460              :          */
    3461              : 
    3462              :         /* must copy state data before unlocking buffer */
    3463        36540 :         xwait = HeapTupleHeaderGetRawXmax(oldtup.t_data);
    3464        36540 :         infomask = oldtup.t_data->t_infomask;
    3465              : 
    3466              :         /*
    3467              :          * Now we have to do something about the existing locker.  If it's a
    3468              :          * multi, sleep on it; we might be awakened before it is completely
    3469              :          * gone (or even not sleep at all in some cases); we need to preserve
    3470              :          * it as locker, unless it is gone completely.
    3471              :          *
    3472              :          * If it's not a multi, we need to check for sleeping conditions
    3473              :          * before actually going to sleep.  If the update doesn't conflict
    3474              :          * with the locks, we just continue without sleeping (but making sure
    3475              :          * it is preserved).
    3476              :          *
    3477              :          * Before sleeping, we need to acquire tuple lock to establish our
    3478              :          * priority for the tuple (see heap_lock_tuple).  LockTuple will
    3479              :          * release us when we are next-in-line for the tuple.  Note we must
    3480              :          * not acquire the tuple lock until we're sure we're going to sleep;
    3481              :          * otherwise we're open for race conditions with other transactions
    3482              :          * holding the tuple lock which sleep on us.
    3483              :          *
    3484              :          * If we are forced to "start over" below, we keep the tuple lock;
    3485              :          * this arranges that we stay at the head of the line while rechecking
    3486              :          * tuple state.
    3487              :          */
    3488        36540 :         if (infomask & HEAP_XMAX_IS_MULTI)
    3489              :         {
    3490              :             TransactionId update_xact;
    3491              :             int         remain;
    3492          179 :             bool        current_is_member = false;
    3493              : 
    3494          179 :             if (DoesMultiXactIdConflict((MultiXactId) xwait, infomask,
    3495              :                                         *lockmode, &current_is_member))
    3496              :             {
    3497            8 :                 LockBuffer(buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_UNLOCK);
    3498              : 
    3499              :                 /*
    3500              :                  * Acquire the lock, if necessary (but skip it when we're
    3501              :                  * requesting a lock and already have one; avoids deadlock).
    3502              :                  */
    3503            8 :                 if (!current_is_member)
    3504            0 :                     heap_acquire_tuplock(relation, &(oldtup.t_self), *lockmode,
    3505              :                                          LockWaitBlock, &have_tuple_lock);
    3506              : 
    3507              :                 /* wait for multixact */
    3508            8 :                 MultiXactIdWait((MultiXactId) xwait, mxact_status, infomask,
    3509              :                                 relation, &oldtup.t_self, XLTW_Update,
    3510              :                                 &remain);
    3511            8 :                 checked_lockers = true;
    3512            8 :                 locker_remains = remain != 0;
    3513            8 :                 LockBuffer(buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_EXCLUSIVE);
    3514              : 
    3515              :                 /*
    3516              :                  * If xwait had just locked the tuple then some other xact
    3517              :                  * could update this tuple before we get to this point.  Check
    3518              :                  * for xmax change, and start over if so.
    3519              :                  */
    3520            8 :                 if (xmax_infomask_changed(oldtup.t_data->t_infomask,
    3521            8 :                                           infomask) ||
    3522            8 :                     !TransactionIdEquals(HeapTupleHeaderGetRawXmax(oldtup.t_data),
    3523              :                                          xwait))
    3524            0 :                     goto l2;
    3525              :             }
    3526              : 
    3527              :             /*
    3528              :              * Note that the multixact may not be done by now.  It could have
    3529              :              * surviving members; our own xact or other subxacts of this
    3530              :              * backend, and also any other concurrent transaction that locked
    3531              :              * the tuple with LockTupleKeyShare if we only got
    3532              :              * LockTupleNoKeyExclusive.  If this is the case, we have to be
    3533              :              * careful to mark the updated tuple with the surviving members in
    3534              :              * Xmax.
    3535              :              *
    3536              :              * Note that there could have been another update in the
    3537              :              * MultiXact. In that case, we need to check whether it committed
    3538              :              * or aborted. If it aborted we are safe to update it again;
    3539              :              * otherwise there is an update conflict, and we have to return
    3540              :              * TableTuple{Deleted, Updated} below.
    3541              :              *
    3542              :              * In the LockTupleExclusive case, we still need to preserve the
    3543              :              * surviving members: those would include the tuple locks we had
    3544              :              * before this one, which are important to keep in case this
    3545              :              * subxact aborts.
    3546              :              */
    3547          179 :             if (!HEAP_XMAX_IS_LOCKED_ONLY(oldtup.t_data->t_infomask))
    3548            8 :                 update_xact = HeapTupleGetUpdateXid(oldtup.t_data);
    3549              :             else
    3550          171 :                 update_xact = InvalidTransactionId;
    3551              : 
    3552              :             /*
    3553              :              * There was no UPDATE in the MultiXact; or it aborted. No
    3554              :              * TransactionIdIsInProgress() call needed here, since we called
    3555              :              * MultiXactIdWait() above.
    3556              :              */
    3557          187 :             if (!TransactionIdIsValid(update_xact) ||
    3558            8 :                 TransactionIdDidAbort(update_xact))
    3559          172 :                 can_continue = true;
    3560              :         }
    3561        36361 :         else if (TransactionIdIsCurrentTransactionId(xwait))
    3562              :         {
    3563              :             /*
    3564              :              * The only locker is ourselves; we can avoid grabbing the tuple
    3565              :              * lock here, but must preserve our locking information.
    3566              :              */
    3567        36233 :             checked_lockers = true;
    3568        36233 :             locker_remains = true;
    3569        36233 :             can_continue = true;
    3570              :         }
    3571          128 :         else if (HEAP_XMAX_IS_KEYSHR_LOCKED(infomask) && key_intact)
    3572              :         {
    3573              :             /*
    3574              :              * If it's just a key-share locker, and we're not changing the key
    3575              :              * columns, we don't need to wait for it to end; but we need to
    3576              :              * preserve it as locker.
    3577              :              */
    3578           29 :             checked_lockers = true;
    3579           29 :             locker_remains = true;
    3580           29 :             can_continue = true;
    3581              :         }
    3582              :         else
    3583              :         {
    3584              :             /*
    3585              :              * Wait for regular transaction to end; but first, acquire tuple
    3586              :              * lock.
    3587              :              */
    3588           99 :             LockBuffer(buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_UNLOCK);
    3589           99 :             heap_acquire_tuplock(relation, &(oldtup.t_self), *lockmode,
    3590              :                                  LockWaitBlock, &have_tuple_lock);
    3591           99 :             XactLockTableWait(xwait, relation, &oldtup.t_self,
    3592              :                               XLTW_Update);
    3593           99 :             checked_lockers = true;
    3594           99 :             LockBuffer(buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_EXCLUSIVE);
    3595              : 
    3596              :             /*
    3597              :              * xwait is done, but if xwait had just locked the tuple then some
    3598              :              * other xact could update this tuple before we get to this point.
    3599              :              * Check for xmax change, and start over if so.
    3600              :              */
    3601          197 :             if (xmax_infomask_changed(oldtup.t_data->t_infomask, infomask) ||
    3602           98 :                 !TransactionIdEquals(xwait,
    3603              :                                      HeapTupleHeaderGetRawXmax(oldtup.t_data)))
    3604            1 :                 goto l2;
    3605              : 
    3606              :             /* Otherwise check if it committed or aborted */
    3607           98 :             UpdateXmaxHintBits(oldtup.t_data, buffer, xwait);
    3608           98 :             if (oldtup.t_data->t_infomask & HEAP_XMAX_INVALID)
    3609           22 :                 can_continue = true;
    3610              :         }
    3611              : 
    3612        36539 :         if (can_continue)
    3613        36456 :             result = TM_Ok;
    3614           83 :         else if (!ItemPointerEquals(&oldtup.t_self, &oldtup.t_data->t_ctid))
    3615           69 :             result = TM_Updated;
    3616              :         else
    3617           14 :             result = TM_Deleted;
    3618              :     }
    3619              : 
    3620              :     /* Sanity check the result HeapTupleSatisfiesUpdate() and the logic above */
    3621              :     if (result != TM_Ok)
    3622              :     {
    3623              :         Assert(result == TM_SelfModified ||
    3624              :                result == TM_Updated ||
    3625              :                result == TM_Deleted ||
    3626              :                result == TM_BeingModified);
    3627              :         Assert(!(oldtup.t_data->t_infomask & HEAP_XMAX_INVALID));
    3628              :         Assert(result != TM_Updated ||
    3629              :                !ItemPointerEquals(&oldtup.t_self, &oldtup.t_data->t_ctid));
    3630              :     }
    3631              : 
    3632      2394796 :     if (crosscheck != InvalidSnapshot && result == TM_Ok)
    3633              :     {
    3634              :         /* Perform additional check for transaction-snapshot mode RI updates */
    3635            1 :         if (!HeapTupleSatisfiesVisibility(&oldtup, crosscheck, buffer))
    3636            1 :             result = TM_Updated;
    3637              :     }
    3638              : 
    3639      2394796 :     if (result != TM_Ok)
    3640              :     {
    3641          209 :         tmfd->ctid = oldtup.t_data->t_ctid;
    3642          209 :         tmfd->xmax = HeapTupleHeaderGetUpdateXid(oldtup.t_data);
    3643          209 :         if (result == TM_SelfModified)
    3644           73 :             tmfd->cmax = HeapTupleHeaderGetCmax(oldtup.t_data);
    3645              :         else
    3646          136 :             tmfd->cmax = InvalidCommandId;
    3647          209 :         UnlockReleaseBuffer(buffer);
    3648          209 :         if (have_tuple_lock)
    3649           76 :             UnlockTupleTuplock(relation, &(oldtup.t_self), *lockmode);
    3650          209 :         if (vmbuffer != InvalidBuffer)
    3651            0 :             ReleaseBuffer(vmbuffer);
    3652          209 :         *update_indexes = TU_None;
    3653              : 
    3654          209 :         bms_free(hot_attrs);
    3655          209 :         bms_free(sum_attrs);
    3656          209 :         bms_free(key_attrs);
    3657          209 :         bms_free(id_attrs);
    3658          209 :         bms_free(modified_attrs);
    3659          209 :         bms_free(interesting_attrs);
    3660          209 :         return result;
    3661              :     }
    3662              : 
    3663              :     /*
    3664              :      * If we didn't pin the visibility map page and the page has become all
    3665              :      * visible while we were busy locking the buffer, or during some
    3666              :      * subsequent window during which we had it unlocked, we'll have to unlock
    3667              :      * and re-lock, to avoid holding the buffer lock across an I/O.  That's a
    3668              :      * bit unfortunate, especially since we'll now have to recheck whether the
    3669              :      * tuple has been locked or updated under us, but hopefully it won't
    3670              :      * happen very often.
    3671              :      */
    3672      2394587 :     if (vmbuffer == InvalidBuffer && PageIsAllVisible(page))
    3673              :     {
    3674            0 :         LockBuffer(buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_UNLOCK);
    3675            0 :         visibilitymap_pin(relation, block, &vmbuffer);
    3676            0 :         LockBuffer(buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_EXCLUSIVE);
    3677            0 :         goto l2;
    3678              :     }
    3679              : 
    3680              :     /* Fill in transaction status data */
    3681              : 
    3682              :     /*
    3683              :      * If the tuple we're updating is locked, we need to preserve the locking
    3684              :      * info in the old tuple's Xmax.  Prepare a new Xmax value for this.
    3685              :      */
    3686      2394587 :     compute_new_xmax_infomask(HeapTupleHeaderGetRawXmax(oldtup.t_data),
    3687      2394587 :                               oldtup.t_data->t_infomask,
    3688      2394587 :                               oldtup.t_data->t_infomask2,
    3689              :                               xid, *lockmode, true,
    3690              :                               &xmax_old_tuple, &infomask_old_tuple,
    3691              :                               &infomask2_old_tuple);
    3692              : 
    3693              :     /*
    3694              :      * And also prepare an Xmax value for the new copy of the tuple.  If there
    3695              :      * was no xmax previously, or there was one but all lockers are now gone,
    3696              :      * then use InvalidTransactionId; otherwise, get the xmax from the old
    3697              :      * tuple.  (In rare cases that might also be InvalidTransactionId and yet
    3698              :      * not have the HEAP_XMAX_INVALID bit set; that's fine.)
    3699              :      */
    3700      2431021 :     if ((oldtup.t_data->t_infomask & HEAP_XMAX_INVALID) ||
    3701        72868 :         HEAP_LOCKED_UPGRADED(oldtup.t_data->t_infomask) ||
    3702        36263 :         (checked_lockers && !locker_remains))
    3703      2358153 :         xmax_new_tuple = InvalidTransactionId;
    3704              :     else
    3705        36434 :         xmax_new_tuple = HeapTupleHeaderGetRawXmax(oldtup.t_data);
    3706              : 
    3707      2394587 :     if (!TransactionIdIsValid(xmax_new_tuple))
    3708              :     {
    3709      2358153 :         infomask_new_tuple = HEAP_XMAX_INVALID;
    3710      2358153 :         infomask2_new_tuple = 0;
    3711              :     }
    3712              :     else
    3713              :     {
    3714              :         /*
    3715              :          * If we found a valid Xmax for the new tuple, then the infomask bits
    3716              :          * to use on the new tuple depend on what was there on the old one.
    3717              :          * Note that since we're doing an update, the only possibility is that
    3718              :          * the lockers had FOR KEY SHARE lock.
    3719              :          */
    3720        36434 :         if (oldtup.t_data->t_infomask & HEAP_XMAX_IS_MULTI)
    3721              :         {
    3722          172 :             GetMultiXactIdHintBits(xmax_new_tuple, &infomask_new_tuple,
    3723              :                                    &infomask2_new_tuple);
    3724              :         }
    3725              :         else
    3726              :         {
    3727        36262 :             infomask_new_tuple = HEAP_XMAX_KEYSHR_LOCK | HEAP_XMAX_LOCK_ONLY;
    3728        36262 :             infomask2_new_tuple = 0;
    3729              :         }
    3730              :     }
    3731              : 
    3732              :     /*
    3733              :      * Prepare the new tuple with the appropriate initial values of Xmin and
    3734              :      * Xmax, as well as initial infomask bits as computed above.
    3735              :      */
    3736      2394587 :     newtup->t_data->t_infomask &= ~(HEAP_XACT_MASK);
    3737      2394587 :     newtup->t_data->t_infomask2 &= ~(HEAP2_XACT_MASK);
    3738      2394587 :     HeapTupleHeaderSetXmin(newtup->t_data, xid);
    3739      2394587 :     HeapTupleHeaderSetCmin(newtup->t_data, cid);
    3740      2394587 :     newtup->t_data->t_infomask |= HEAP_UPDATED | infomask_new_tuple;
    3741      2394587 :     newtup->t_data->t_infomask2 |= infomask2_new_tuple;
    3742      2394587 :     HeapTupleHeaderSetXmax(newtup->t_data, xmax_new_tuple);
    3743              : 
    3744              :     /*
    3745              :      * Replace cid with a combo CID if necessary.  Note that we already put
    3746              :      * the plain cid into the new tuple.
    3747              :      */
    3748      2394587 :     HeapTupleHeaderAdjustCmax(oldtup.t_data, &cid, &iscombo);
    3749              : 
    3750              :     /*
    3751              :      * If the toaster needs to be activated, OR if the new tuple will not fit
    3752              :      * on the same page as the old, then we need to release the content lock
    3753              :      * (but not the pin!) on the old tuple's buffer while we are off doing
    3754              :      * TOAST and/or table-file-extension work.  We must mark the old tuple to
    3755              :      * show that it's locked, else other processes may try to update it
    3756              :      * themselves.
    3757              :      *
    3758              :      * We need to invoke the toaster if there are already any out-of-line
    3759              :      * toasted values present, or if the new tuple is over-threshold.
    3760              :      */
    3761      2394587 :     if (relation->rd_rel->relkind != RELKIND_RELATION &&
    3762            0 :         relation->rd_rel->relkind != RELKIND_MATVIEW)
    3763              :     {
    3764              :         /* toast table entries should never be recursively toasted */
    3765              :         Assert(!HeapTupleHasExternal(&oldtup));
    3766              :         Assert(!HeapTupleHasExternal(newtup));
    3767            0 :         need_toast = false;
    3768              :     }
    3769              :     else
    3770      7183244 :         need_toast = (HeapTupleHasExternal(&oldtup) ||
    3771      4788657 :                       HeapTupleHasExternal(newtup) ||
    3772      2394038 :                       newtup->t_len > TOAST_TUPLE_THRESHOLD);
    3773              : 
    3774      2394587 :     pagefree = PageGetHeapFreeSpace(page);
    3775              : 
    3776      2394587 :     newtupsize = MAXALIGN(newtup->t_len);
    3777              : 
    3778      2394587 :     if (need_toast || newtupsize > pagefree)
    3779      2207443 :     {
    3780              :         TransactionId xmax_lock_old_tuple;
    3781              :         uint16      infomask_lock_old_tuple,
    3782              :                     infomask2_lock_old_tuple;
    3783      2207443 :         bool        cleared_all_frozen = false;
    3784              : 
    3785              :         /*
    3786              :          * To prevent concurrent sessions from updating the tuple, we have to
    3787              :          * temporarily mark it locked, while we release the page-level lock.
    3788              :          *
    3789              :          * To satisfy the rule that any xid potentially appearing in a buffer
    3790              :          * written out to disk, we unfortunately have to WAL log this
    3791              :          * temporary modification.  We can reuse xl_heap_lock for this
    3792              :          * purpose.  If we crash/error before following through with the
    3793              :          * actual update, xmax will be of an aborted transaction, allowing
    3794              :          * other sessions to proceed.
    3795              :          */
    3796              : 
    3797              :         /*
    3798              :          * Compute xmax / infomask appropriate for locking the tuple. This has
    3799              :          * to be done separately from the combo that's going to be used for
    3800              :          * updating, because the potentially created multixact would otherwise
    3801              :          * be wrong.
    3802              :          */
    3803      2207443 :         compute_new_xmax_infomask(HeapTupleHeaderGetRawXmax(oldtup.t_data),
    3804      2207443 :                                   oldtup.t_data->t_infomask,
    3805      2207443 :                                   oldtup.t_data->t_infomask2,
    3806              :                                   xid, *lockmode, false,
    3807              :                                   &xmax_lock_old_tuple, &infomask_lock_old_tuple,
    3808              :                                   &infomask2_lock_old_tuple);
    3809              : 
    3810              :         Assert(HEAP_XMAX_IS_LOCKED_ONLY(infomask_lock_old_tuple));
    3811              : 
    3812      2207443 :         START_CRIT_SECTION();
    3813              : 
    3814              :         /* Clear obsolete visibility flags ... */
    3815      2207443 :         oldtup.t_data->t_infomask &= ~(HEAP_XMAX_BITS | HEAP_MOVED);
    3816      2207443 :         oldtup.t_data->t_infomask2 &= ~HEAP_KEYS_UPDATED;
    3817      2207443 :         HeapTupleClearHotUpdated(&oldtup);
    3818              :         /* ... and store info about transaction updating this tuple */
    3819              :         Assert(TransactionIdIsValid(xmax_lock_old_tuple));
    3820      2207443 :         HeapTupleHeaderSetXmax(oldtup.t_data, xmax_lock_old_tuple);
    3821      2207443 :         oldtup.t_data->t_infomask |= infomask_lock_old_tuple;
    3822      2207443 :         oldtup.t_data->t_infomask2 |= infomask2_lock_old_tuple;
    3823      2207443 :         HeapTupleHeaderSetCmax(oldtup.t_data, cid, iscombo);
    3824              : 
    3825              :         /* temporarily make it look not-updated, but locked */
    3826      2207443 :         oldtup.t_data->t_ctid = oldtup.t_self;
    3827              : 
    3828              :         /*
    3829              :          * Clear all-frozen bit on visibility map if needed. We could
    3830              :          * immediately reset ALL_VISIBLE, but given that the WAL logging
    3831              :          * overhead would be unchanged, that doesn't seem necessarily
    3832              :          * worthwhile.
    3833              :          */
    3834      2208735 :         if (PageIsAllVisible(page) &&
    3835         1292 :             visibilitymap_clear(relation, block, vmbuffer,
    3836              :                                 VISIBILITYMAP_ALL_FROZEN))
    3837          842 :             cleared_all_frozen = true;
    3838              : 
    3839      2207443 :         MarkBufferDirty(buffer);
    3840              : 
    3841      2207443 :         if (RelationNeedsWAL(relation))
    3842              :         {
    3843              :             xl_heap_lock xlrec;
    3844              :             XLogRecPtr  recptr;
    3845              : 
    3846      2197307 :             XLogBeginInsert();
    3847      2197307 :             XLogRegisterBuffer(0, buffer, REGBUF_STANDARD);
    3848              : 
    3849      2197307 :             xlrec.offnum = ItemPointerGetOffsetNumber(&oldtup.t_self);
    3850      2197307 :             xlrec.xmax = xmax_lock_old_tuple;
    3851      4394614 :             xlrec.infobits_set = compute_infobits(oldtup.t_data->t_infomask,
    3852      2197307 :                                                   oldtup.t_data->t_infomask2);
    3853      2197307 :             xlrec.flags =
    3854      2197307 :                 cleared_all_frozen ? XLH_LOCK_ALL_FROZEN_CLEARED : 0;
    3855      2197307 :             XLogRegisterData(&xlrec, SizeOfHeapLock);
    3856      2197307 :             recptr = XLogInsert(RM_HEAP_ID, XLOG_HEAP_LOCK);
    3857      2197307 :             PageSetLSN(page, recptr);
    3858              :         }
    3859              : 
    3860      2207443 :         END_CRIT_SECTION();
    3861              : 
    3862      2207443 :         LockBuffer(buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_UNLOCK);
    3863              : 
    3864              :         /*
    3865              :          * Let the toaster do its thing, if needed.
    3866              :          *
    3867              :          * Note: below this point, heaptup is the data we actually intend to
    3868              :          * store into the relation; newtup is the caller's original untoasted
    3869              :          * data.
    3870              :          */
    3871      2207443 :         if (need_toast)
    3872              :         {
    3873              :             /* Note we always use WAL and FSM during updates */
    3874         1914 :             heaptup = heap_toast_insert_or_update(relation, newtup, &oldtup, 0);
    3875         1914 :             newtupsize = MAXALIGN(heaptup->t_len);
    3876              :         }
    3877              :         else
    3878      2205529 :             heaptup = newtup;
    3879              : 
    3880              :         /*
    3881              :          * Now, do we need a new page for the tuple, or not?  This is a bit
    3882              :          * tricky since someone else could have added tuples to the page while
    3883              :          * we weren't looking.  We have to recheck the available space after
    3884              :          * reacquiring the buffer lock.  But don't bother to do that if the
    3885              :          * former amount of free space is still not enough; it's unlikely
    3886              :          * there's more free now than before.
    3887              :          *
    3888              :          * What's more, if we need to get a new page, we will need to acquire
    3889              :          * buffer locks on both old and new pages.  To avoid deadlock against
    3890              :          * some other backend trying to get the same two locks in the other
    3891              :          * order, we must be consistent about the order we get the locks in.
    3892              :          * We use the rule "lock the lower-numbered page of the relation
    3893              :          * first".  To implement this, we must do RelationGetBufferForTuple
    3894              :          * while not holding the lock on the old page, and we must rely on it
    3895              :          * to get the locks on both pages in the correct order.
    3896              :          *
    3897              :          * Another consideration is that we need visibility map page pin(s) if
    3898              :          * we will have to clear the all-visible flag on either page.  If we
    3899              :          * call RelationGetBufferForTuple, we rely on it to acquire any such
    3900              :          * pins; but if we don't, we have to handle that here.  Hence we need
    3901              :          * a loop.
    3902              :          */
    3903              :         for (;;)
    3904              :         {
    3905      2207443 :             if (newtupsize > pagefree)
    3906              :             {
    3907              :                 /* It doesn't fit, must use RelationGetBufferForTuple. */
    3908      2206712 :                 newbuf = RelationGetBufferForTuple(relation, heaptup->t_len,
    3909              :                                                    buffer, 0, NULL,
    3910              :                                                    &vmbuffer_new, &vmbuffer,
    3911              :                                                    0);
    3912              :                 /* We're all done. */
    3913      2206712 :                 break;
    3914              :             }
    3915              :             /* Acquire VM page pin if needed and we don't have it. */
    3916          731 :             if (vmbuffer == InvalidBuffer && PageIsAllVisible(page))
    3917            0 :                 visibilitymap_pin(relation, block, &vmbuffer);
    3918              :             /* Re-acquire the lock on the old tuple's page. */
    3919          731 :             LockBuffer(buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_EXCLUSIVE);
    3920              :             /* Re-check using the up-to-date free space */
    3921          731 :             pagefree = PageGetHeapFreeSpace(page);
    3922          731 :             if (newtupsize > pagefree ||
    3923          731 :                 (vmbuffer == InvalidBuffer && PageIsAllVisible(page)))
    3924              :             {
    3925              :                 /*
    3926              :                  * Rats, it doesn't fit anymore, or somebody just now set the
    3927              :                  * all-visible flag.  We must now unlock and loop to avoid
    3928              :                  * deadlock.  Fortunately, this path should seldom be taken.
    3929              :                  */
    3930            0 :                 LockBuffer(buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_UNLOCK);
    3931              :             }
    3932              :             else
    3933              :             {
    3934              :                 /* We're all done. */
    3935          731 :                 newbuf = buffer;
    3936          731 :                 break;
    3937              :             }
    3938              :         }
    3939              :     }
    3940              :     else
    3941              :     {
    3942              :         /* No TOAST work needed, and it'll fit on same page */
    3943       187144 :         newbuf = buffer;
    3944       187144 :         heaptup = newtup;
    3945              :     }
    3946              : 
    3947      2394587 :     newpage = BufferGetPage(newbuf);
    3948              : 
    3949              :     /*
    3950              :      * We're about to do the actual update -- check for conflict first, to
    3951              :      * avoid possibly having to roll back work we've just done.
    3952              :      *
    3953              :      * This is safe without a recheck as long as there is no possibility of
    3954              :      * another process scanning the pages between this check and the update
    3955              :      * being visible to the scan (i.e., exclusive buffer content lock(s) are
    3956              :      * continuously held from this point until the tuple update is visible).
    3957              :      *
    3958              :      * For the new tuple the only check needed is at the relation level, but
    3959              :      * since both tuples are in the same relation and the check for oldtup
    3960              :      * will include checking the relation level, there is no benefit to a
    3961              :      * separate check for the new tuple.
    3962              :      */
    3963      2394587 :     CheckForSerializableConflictIn(relation, &oldtup.t_self,
    3964              :                                    BufferGetBlockNumber(buffer));
    3965              : 
    3966              :     /*
    3967              :      * At this point newbuf and buffer are both pinned and locked, and newbuf
    3968              :      * has enough space for the new tuple.  If they are the same buffer, only
    3969              :      * one pin is held.
    3970              :      */
    3971              : 
    3972      2394575 :     if (newbuf == buffer)
    3973              :     {
    3974              :         /*
    3975              :          * Since the new tuple is going into the same page, we might be able
    3976              :          * to do a HOT update.  Check if any of the index columns have been
    3977              :          * changed.
    3978              :          */
    3979       187863 :         if (!bms_overlap(modified_attrs, hot_attrs))
    3980              :         {
    3981       171178 :             use_hot_update = true;
    3982              : 
    3983              :             /*
    3984              :              * If none of the columns that are used in hot-blocking indexes
    3985              :              * were updated, we can apply HOT, but we do still need to check
    3986              :              * if we need to update the summarizing indexes, and update those
    3987              :              * indexes if the columns were updated, or we may fail to detect
    3988              :              * e.g. value bound changes in BRIN minmax indexes.
    3989              :              */
    3990       171178 :             if (bms_overlap(modified_attrs, sum_attrs))
    3991         2188 :                 summarized_update = true;
    3992              :         }
    3993              :     }
    3994              :     else
    3995              :     {
    3996              :         /* Set a hint that the old page could use prune/defrag */
    3997      2206712 :         PageSetFull(page);
    3998              :     }
    3999              : 
    4000              :     /*
    4001              :      * Compute replica identity tuple before entering the critical section so
    4002              :      * we don't PANIC upon a memory allocation failure.
    4003              :      * ExtractReplicaIdentity() will return NULL if nothing needs to be
    4004              :      * logged.  Pass old key required as true only if the replica identity key
    4005              :      * columns are modified or it has external data.
    4006              :      */
    4007      2394575 :     old_key_tuple = ExtractReplicaIdentity(relation, &oldtup,
    4008      2394575 :                                            bms_overlap(modified_attrs, id_attrs) ||
    4009              :                                            id_has_external,
    4010      2394575 :                                            &old_key_copied);
    4011              : 
    4012              :     /* NO EREPORT(ERROR) from here till changes are logged */
    4013      2394575 :     START_CRIT_SECTION();
    4014              : 
    4015              :     /*
    4016              :      * If this transaction commits, the old tuple will become DEAD sooner or
    4017              :      * later.  Set flag that this page is a candidate for pruning once our xid
    4018              :      * falls below the OldestXmin horizon.  If the transaction finally aborts,
    4019              :      * the subsequent page pruning will be a no-op and the hint will be
    4020              :      * cleared.
    4021              :      *
    4022              :      * We set the new page prunable as well. See heap_insert() for more on why
    4023              :      * we do this when inserting tuples.
    4024              :      */
    4025      2394575 :     PageSetPrunable(page, xid);
    4026      2394575 :     if (newbuf != buffer)
    4027      2206712 :         PageSetPrunable(newpage, xid);
    4028              : 
    4029      2394575 :     if (use_hot_update)
    4030              :     {
    4031              :         /* Mark the old tuple as HOT-updated */
    4032       171178 :         HeapTupleSetHotUpdated(&oldtup);
    4033              :         /* And mark the new tuple as heap-only */
    4034       171178 :         HeapTupleSetHeapOnly(heaptup);
    4035              :         /* Mark the caller's copy too, in case different from heaptup */
    4036       171178 :         HeapTupleSetHeapOnly(newtup);
    4037              :     }
    4038              :     else
    4039              :     {
    4040              :         /* Make sure tuples are correctly marked as not-HOT */
    4041      2223397 :         HeapTupleClearHotUpdated(&oldtup);
    4042      2223397 :         HeapTupleClearHeapOnly(heaptup);
    4043      2223397 :         HeapTupleClearHeapOnly(newtup);
    4044              :     }
    4045              : 
    4046      2394575 :     RelationPutHeapTuple(relation, newbuf, heaptup, false); /* insert new tuple */
    4047              : 
    4048              : 
    4049              :     /* Clear obsolete visibility flags, possibly set by ourselves above... */
    4050      2394575 :     oldtup.t_data->t_infomask &= ~(HEAP_XMAX_BITS | HEAP_MOVED);
    4051      2394575 :     oldtup.t_data->t_infomask2 &= ~HEAP_KEYS_UPDATED;
    4052              :     /* ... and store info about transaction updating this tuple */
    4053              :     Assert(TransactionIdIsValid(xmax_old_tuple));
    4054      2394575 :     HeapTupleHeaderSetXmax(oldtup.t_data, xmax_old_tuple);
    4055      2394575 :     oldtup.t_data->t_infomask |= infomask_old_tuple;
    4056      2394575 :     oldtup.t_data->t_infomask2 |= infomask2_old_tuple;
    4057      2394575 :     HeapTupleHeaderSetCmax(oldtup.t_data, cid, iscombo);
    4058              : 
    4059              :     /* record address of new tuple in t_ctid of old one */
    4060      2394575 :     oldtup.t_data->t_ctid = heaptup->t_self;
    4061              : 
    4062              :     /* clear PD_ALL_VISIBLE flags, reset all visibilitymap bits */
    4063      2394575 :     if (PageIsAllVisible(page))
    4064              :     {
    4065         2139 :         all_visible_cleared = true;
    4066         2139 :         PageClearAllVisible(page);
    4067         2139 :         visibilitymap_clear(relation, BufferGetBlockNumber(buffer),
    4068              :                             vmbuffer, VISIBILITYMAP_VALID_BITS);
    4069              :     }
    4070      2394575 :     if (newbuf != buffer && PageIsAllVisible(newpage))
    4071              :     {
    4072          774 :         all_visible_cleared_new = true;
    4073          774 :         PageClearAllVisible(newpage);
    4074          774 :         visibilitymap_clear(relation, BufferGetBlockNumber(newbuf),
    4075              :                             vmbuffer_new, VISIBILITYMAP_VALID_BITS);
    4076              :     }
    4077              : 
    4078      2394575 :     if (newbuf != buffer)
    4079      2206712 :         MarkBufferDirty(newbuf);
    4080      2394575 :     MarkBufferDirty(buffer);
    4081              : 
    4082              :     /* XLOG stuff */
    4083      2394575 :     if (RelationNeedsWAL(relation))
    4084              :     {
    4085              :         XLogRecPtr  recptr;
    4086              : 
    4087              :         /*
    4088              :          * For logical decoding we need combo CIDs to properly decode the
    4089              :          * catalog.
    4090              :          */
    4091      2382791 :         if (RelationIsAccessibleInLogicalDecoding(relation))
    4092              :         {
    4093         2689 :             log_heap_new_cid(relation, &oldtup);
    4094         2689 :             log_heap_new_cid(relation, heaptup);
    4095              :         }
    4096              : 
    4097      2382791 :         recptr = log_heap_update(relation, buffer,
    4098              :                                  newbuf, &oldtup, heaptup,
    4099              :                                  old_key_tuple,
    4100              :                                  all_visible_cleared,
    4101              :                                  all_visible_cleared_new,
    4102              :                                  walLogical);
    4103      2382791 :         if (newbuf != buffer)
    4104              :         {
    4105      2196584 :             PageSetLSN(newpage, recptr);
    4106              :         }
    4107      2382791 :         PageSetLSN(page, recptr);
    4108              :     }
    4109              : 
    4110      2394575 :     END_CRIT_SECTION();
    4111              : 
    4112      2394575 :     if (newbuf != buffer)
    4113      2206712 :         LockBuffer(newbuf, BUFFER_LOCK_UNLOCK);
    4114      2394575 :     LockBuffer(buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_UNLOCK);
    4115              : 
    4116              :     /*
    4117              :      * Mark old tuple for invalidation from system caches at next command
    4118              :      * boundary, and mark the new tuple for invalidation in case we abort. We
    4119              :      * have to do this before releasing the buffer because oldtup is in the
    4120              :      * buffer.  (heaptup is all in local memory, but it's necessary to process
    4121              :      * both tuple versions in one call to inval.c so we can avoid redundant
    4122              :      * sinval messages.)
    4123              :      */
    4124      2394575 :     CacheInvalidateHeapTuple(relation, &oldtup, heaptup);
    4125              : 
    4126              :     /* Now we can release the buffer(s) */
    4127      2394575 :     if (newbuf != buffer)
    4128      2206712 :         ReleaseBuffer(newbuf);
    4129      2394575 :     ReleaseBuffer(buffer);
    4130      2394575 :     if (BufferIsValid(vmbuffer_new))
    4131          775 :         ReleaseBuffer(vmbuffer_new);
    4132      2394575 :     if (BufferIsValid(vmbuffer))
    4133         2139 :         ReleaseBuffer(vmbuffer);
    4134              : 
    4135              :     /*
    4136              :      * Release the lmgr tuple lock, if we had it.
    4137              :      */
    4138      2394575 :     if (have_tuple_lock)
    4139           22 :         UnlockTupleTuplock(relation, &(oldtup.t_self), *lockmode);
    4140              : 
    4141      2394575 :     pgstat_count_heap_update(relation, use_hot_update, newbuf != buffer);
    4142              : 
    4143              :     /*
    4144              :      * If heaptup is a private copy, release it.  Don't forget to copy t_self
    4145              :      * back to the caller's image, too.
    4146              :      */
    4147      2394575 :     if (heaptup != newtup)
    4148              :     {
    4149         1858 :         newtup->t_self = heaptup->t_self;
    4150         1858 :         heap_freetuple(heaptup);
    4151              :     }
    4152              : 
    4153              :     /*
    4154              :      * If it is a HOT update, the update may still need to update summarized
    4155              :      * indexes, lest we fail to update those summaries and get incorrect
    4156              :      * results (for example, minmax bounds of the block may change with this
    4157              :      * update).
    4158              :      */
    4159      2394575 :     if (use_hot_update)
    4160              :     {
    4161       171178 :         if (summarized_update)
    4162         2188 :             *update_indexes = TU_Summarizing;
    4163              :         else
    4164       168990 :             *update_indexes = TU_None;
    4165              :     }
    4166              :     else
    4167      2223397 :         *update_indexes = TU_All;
    4168              : 
    4169      2394575 :     if (old_key_tuple != NULL && old_key_copied)
    4170          100 :         heap_freetuple(old_key_tuple);
    4171              : 
    4172      2394575 :     bms_free(hot_attrs);
    4173      2394575 :     bms_free(sum_attrs);
    4174      2394575 :     bms_free(key_attrs);
    4175      2394575 :     bms_free(id_attrs);
    4176      2394575 :     bms_free(modified_attrs);
    4177      2394575 :     bms_free(interesting_attrs);
    4178              : 
    4179      2394575 :     return TM_Ok;
    4180              : }
    4181              : 
    4182              : #ifdef USE_ASSERT_CHECKING
    4183              : /*
    4184              :  * Confirm adequate lock held during heap_update(), per rules from
    4185              :  * README.tuplock section "Locking to write inplace-updated tables".
    4186              :  */
    4187              : static void
    4188              : check_lock_if_inplace_updateable_rel(Relation relation,
    4189              :                                      const ItemPointerData *otid,
    4190              :                                      HeapTuple newtup)
    4191              : {
    4192              :     /* LOCKTAG_TUPLE acceptable for any catalog */
    4193              :     switch (RelationGetRelid(relation))
    4194              :     {
    4195              :         case RelationRelationId:
    4196              :         case DatabaseRelationId:
    4197              :             {
    4198              :                 LOCKTAG     tuptag;
    4199              : 
    4200              :                 SET_LOCKTAG_TUPLE(tuptag,
    4201              :                                   relation->rd_lockInfo.lockRelId.dbId,
    4202              :                                   relation->rd_lockInfo.lockRelId.relId,
    4203              :                                   ItemPointerGetBlockNumber(otid),
    4204              :                                   ItemPointerGetOffsetNumber(otid));
    4205              :                 if (LockHeldByMe(&tuptag, InplaceUpdateTupleLock, false))
    4206              :                     return;
    4207              :             }
    4208              :             break;
    4209              :         default:
    4210              :             Assert(!IsInplaceUpdateRelation(relation));
    4211              :             return;
    4212              :     }
    4213              : 
    4214              :     switch (RelationGetRelid(relation))
    4215              :     {
    4216              :         case RelationRelationId:
    4217              :             {
    4218              :                 /* LOCKTAG_TUPLE or LOCKTAG_RELATION ok */
    4219              :                 Form_pg_class classForm = (Form_pg_class) GETSTRUCT(newtup);
    4220              :                 Oid         relid = classForm->oid;
    4221              :                 Oid         dbid;
    4222              :                 LOCKTAG     tag;
    4223              : 
    4224              :                 if (IsSharedRelation(relid))
    4225              :                     dbid = InvalidOid;
    4226              :                 else
    4227              :                     dbid = MyDatabaseId;
    4228              : 
    4229              :                 if (classForm->relkind == RELKIND_INDEX)
    4230              :                 {
    4231              :                     Relation    irel = index_open(relid, AccessShareLock);
    4232              : 
    4233              :                     SET_LOCKTAG_RELATION(tag, dbid, irel->rd_index->indrelid);
    4234              :                     index_close(irel, AccessShareLock);
    4235              :                 }
    4236              :                 else
    4237              :                     SET_LOCKTAG_RELATION(tag, dbid, relid);
    4238              : 
    4239              :                 if (!LockHeldByMe(&tag, ShareUpdateExclusiveLock, false) &&
    4240              :                     !LockHeldByMe(&tag, ShareRowExclusiveLock, true))
    4241              :                     elog(WARNING,
    4242              :                          "missing lock for relation \"%s\" (OID %u, relkind %c) @ TID (%u,%u)",
    4243              :                          NameStr(classForm->relname),
    4244              :                          relid,
    4245              :                          classForm->relkind,
    4246              :                          ItemPointerGetBlockNumber(otid),
    4247              :                          ItemPointerGetOffsetNumber(otid));
    4248              :             }
    4249              :             break;
    4250              :         case DatabaseRelationId:
    4251              :             {
    4252              :                 /* LOCKTAG_TUPLE required */
    4253              :                 Form_pg_database dbForm = (Form_pg_database) GETSTRUCT(newtup);
    4254              : 
    4255              :                 elog(WARNING,
    4256              :                      "missing lock on database \"%s\" (OID %u) @ TID (%u,%u)",
    4257              :                      NameStr(dbForm->datname),
    4258              :                      dbForm->oid,
    4259              :                      ItemPointerGetBlockNumber(otid),
    4260              :                      ItemPointerGetOffsetNumber(otid));
    4261              :             }
    4262              :             break;
    4263              :     }
    4264              : }
    4265              : 
    4266              : /*
    4267              :  * Confirm adequate relation lock held, per rules from README.tuplock section
    4268              :  * "Locking to write inplace-updated tables".
    4269              :  */
    4270              : static void
    4271              : check_inplace_rel_lock(HeapTuple oldtup)
    4272              : {
    4273              :     Form_pg_class classForm = (Form_pg_class) GETSTRUCT(oldtup);
    4274              :     Oid         relid = classForm->oid;
    4275              :     Oid         dbid;
    4276              :     LOCKTAG     tag;
    4277              : 
    4278              :     if (IsSharedRelation(relid))
    4279              :         dbid = InvalidOid;
    4280              :     else
    4281              :         dbid = MyDatabaseId;
    4282              : 
    4283              :     if (classForm->relkind == RELKIND_INDEX)
    4284              :     {
    4285              :         Relation    irel = index_open(relid, AccessShareLock);
    4286              : 
    4287              :         SET_LOCKTAG_RELATION(tag, dbid, irel->rd_index->indrelid);
    4288              :         index_close(irel, AccessShareLock);
    4289              :     }
    4290              :     else
    4291              :         SET_LOCKTAG_RELATION(tag, dbid, relid);
    4292              : 
    4293              :     if (!LockHeldByMe(&tag, ShareUpdateExclusiveLock, true))
    4294              :         elog(WARNING,
    4295              :              "missing lock for relation \"%s\" (OID %u, relkind %c) @ TID (%u,%u)",
    4296              :              NameStr(classForm->relname),
    4297              :              relid,
    4298              :              classForm->relkind,
    4299              :              ItemPointerGetBlockNumber(&oldtup->t_self),
    4300              :              ItemPointerGetOffsetNumber(&oldtup->t_self));
    4301              : }
    4302              : #endif
    4303              : 
    4304              : /*
    4305              :  * Check if the specified attribute's values are the same.  Subroutine for
    4306              :  * HeapDetermineColumnsInfo.
    4307              :  */
    4308              : static bool
    4309       989585 : heap_attr_equals(TupleDesc tupdesc, int attrnum, Datum value1, Datum value2,
    4310              :                  bool isnull1, bool isnull2)
    4311              : {
    4312              :     /*
    4313              :      * If one value is NULL and other is not, then they are certainly not
    4314              :      * equal
    4315              :      */
    4316       989585 :     if (isnull1 != isnull2)
    4317           60 :         return false;
    4318              : 
    4319              :     /*
    4320              :      * If both are NULL, they can be considered equal.
    4321              :      */
    4322       989525 :     if (isnull1)
    4323         6641 :         return true;
    4324              : 
    4325              :     /*
    4326              :      * We do simple binary comparison of the two datums.  This may be overly
    4327              :      * strict because there can be multiple binary representations for the
    4328              :      * same logical value.  But we should be OK as long as there are no false
    4329              :      * positives.  Using a type-specific equality operator is messy because
    4330              :      * there could be multiple notions of equality in different operator
    4331              :      * classes; furthermore, we cannot safely invoke user-defined functions
    4332              :      * while holding exclusive buffer lock.
    4333              :      */
    4334       982884 :     if (attrnum <= 0)
    4335              :     {
    4336              :         /* The only allowed system columns are OIDs, so do this */
    4337            0 :         return (DatumGetObjectId(value1) == DatumGetObjectId(value2));
    4338              :     }
    4339              :     else
    4340              :     {
    4341              :         CompactAttribute *att;
    4342              : 
    4343              :         Assert(attrnum <= tupdesc->natts);
    4344       982884 :         att = TupleDescCompactAttr(tupdesc, attrnum - 1);
    4345       982884 :         return datumIsEqual(value1, value2, att->attbyval, att->attlen);
    4346              :     }
    4347              : }
    4348              : 
    4349              : /*
    4350              :  * Check which columns are being updated.
    4351              :  *
    4352              :  * Given an updated tuple, determine (and return into the output bitmapset),
    4353              :  * from those listed as interesting, the set of columns that changed.
    4354              :  *
    4355              :  * has_external indicates if any of the unmodified attributes (from those
    4356              :  * listed as interesting) of the old tuple is a member of external_cols and is
    4357              :  * stored externally.
    4358              :  */
    4359              : static Bitmapset *
    4360      2394796 : HeapDetermineColumnsInfo(Relation relation,
    4361              :                          Bitmapset *interesting_cols,
    4362              :                          Bitmapset *external_cols,
    4363              :                          HeapTuple oldtup, HeapTuple newtup,
    4364              :                          bool *has_external)
    4365              : {
    4366              :     int         attidx;
    4367      2394796 :     Bitmapset  *modified = NULL;
    4368      2394796 :     TupleDesc   tupdesc = RelationGetDescr(relation);
    4369              : 
    4370      2394796 :     attidx = -1;
    4371      3384381 :     while ((attidx = bms_next_member(interesting_cols, attidx)) >= 0)
    4372              :     {
    4373              :         /* attidx is zero-based, attrnum is the normal attribute number */
    4374       989585 :         AttrNumber  attrnum = attidx + FirstLowInvalidHeapAttributeNumber;
    4375              :         Datum       value1,
    4376              :                     value2;
    4377              :         bool        isnull1,
    4378              :                     isnull2;
    4379              : 
    4380              :         /*
    4381              :          * If it's a whole-tuple reference, say "not equal".  It's not really
    4382              :          * worth supporting this case, since it could only succeed after a
    4383              :          * no-op update, which is hardly a case worth optimizing for.
    4384              :          */
    4385       989585 :         if (attrnum == 0)
    4386              :         {
    4387            0 :             modified = bms_add_member(modified, attidx);
    4388       957201 :             continue;
    4389              :         }
    4390              : 
    4391              :         /*
    4392              :          * Likewise, automatically say "not equal" for any system attribute
    4393              :          * other than tableOID; we cannot expect these to be consistent in a
    4394              :          * HOT chain, or even to be set correctly yet in the new tuple.
    4395              :          */
    4396       989585 :         if (attrnum < 0)
    4397              :         {
    4398            0 :             if (attrnum != TableOidAttributeNumber)
    4399              :             {
    4400            0 :                 modified = bms_add_member(modified, attidx);
    4401            0 :                 continue;
    4402              :             }
    4403              :         }
    4404              : 
    4405              :         /*
    4406              :          * Extract the corresponding values.  XXX this is pretty inefficient
    4407              :          * if there are many indexed columns.  Should we do a single
    4408              :          * heap_deform_tuple call on each tuple, instead?   But that doesn't
    4409              :          * work for system columns ...
    4410              :          */
    4411       989585 :         value1 = heap_getattr(oldtup, attrnum, tupdesc, &isnull1);
    4412       989585 :         value2 = heap_getattr(newtup, attrnum, tupdesc, &isnull2);
    4413              : 
    4414       989585 :         if (!heap_attr_equals(tupdesc, attrnum, value1,
    4415              :                               value2, isnull1, isnull2))
    4416              :         {
    4417        54610 :             modified = bms_add_member(modified, attidx);
    4418        54610 :             continue;
    4419              :         }
    4420              : 
    4421              :         /*
    4422              :          * No need to check attributes that can't be stored externally. Note
    4423              :          * that system attributes can't be stored externally.
    4424              :          */
    4425       934975 :         if (attrnum < 0 || isnull1 ||
    4426       928334 :             TupleDescCompactAttr(tupdesc, attrnum - 1)->attlen != -1)
    4427       902591 :             continue;
    4428              : 
    4429              :         /*
    4430              :          * Check if the old tuple's attribute is stored externally and is a
    4431              :          * member of external_cols.
    4432              :          */
    4433        32389 :         if (VARATT_IS_EXTERNAL((varlena *) DatumGetPointer(value1)) &&
    4434            5 :             bms_is_member(attidx, external_cols))
    4435            2 :             *has_external = true;
    4436              :     }
    4437              : 
    4438      2394796 :     return modified;
    4439              : }
    4440              : 
    4441              : /*
    4442              :  *  simple_heap_update - replace a tuple
    4443              :  *
    4444              :  * This routine may be used to update a tuple when concurrent updates of
    4445              :  * the target tuple are not expected (for example, because we have a lock
    4446              :  * on the relation associated with the tuple).  Any failure is reported
    4447              :  * via ereport().
    4448              :  */
    4449              : void
    4450       138399 : simple_heap_update(Relation relation, const ItemPointerData *otid, HeapTuple tup,
    4451              :                    TU_UpdateIndexes *update_indexes)
    4452              : {
    4453              :     TM_Result   result;
    4454              :     TM_FailureData tmfd;
    4455              :     LockTupleMode lockmode;
    4456              : 
    4457       138399 :     result = heap_update(relation, otid, tup,
    4458              :                          GetCurrentCommandId(true), 0,
    4459              :                          InvalidSnapshot,
    4460              :                          true /* wait for commit */ ,
    4461              :                          &tmfd, &lockmode, update_indexes);
    4462       138399 :     switch (result)
    4463              :     {
    4464            0 :         case TM_SelfModified:
    4465              :             /* Tuple was already updated in current command? */
    4466            0 :             elog(ERROR, "tuple already updated by self");
    4467              :             break;
    4468              : 
    4469       138398 :         case TM_Ok:
    4470              :             /* done successfully */
    4471       138398 :             break;
    4472              : 
    4473            0 :         case TM_Updated:
    4474            0 :             elog(ERROR, "tuple concurrently updated");
    4475              :             break;
    4476              : 
    4477            1 :         case TM_Deleted:
    4478            1 :             elog(ERROR, "tuple concurrently deleted");
    4479              :             break;
    4480              : 
    4481            0 :         default:
    4482            0 :             elog(ERROR, "unrecognized heap_update status: %u", result);
    4483              :             break;
    4484              :     }
    4485       138398 : }
    4486              : 
    4487              : 
    4488              : /*
    4489              :  * Return the MultiXactStatus corresponding to the given tuple lock mode.
    4490              :  */
    4491              : static MultiXactStatus
    4492       115534 : get_mxact_status_for_lock(LockTupleMode mode, bool is_update)
    4493              : {
    4494              :     int         retval;
    4495              : 
    4496       115534 :     if (is_update)
    4497          216 :         retval = tupleLockExtraInfo[mode].updstatus;
    4498              :     else
    4499       115318 :         retval = tupleLockExtraInfo[mode].lockstatus;
    4500              : 
    4501       115534 :     if (retval == -1)
    4502            0 :         elog(ERROR, "invalid lock tuple mode %d/%s", mode,
    4503              :              is_update ? "true" : "false");
    4504              : 
    4505       115534 :     return (MultiXactStatus) retval;
    4506              : }
    4507              : 
    4508              : /*
    4509              :  *  heap_lock_tuple - lock a tuple in shared or exclusive mode
    4510              :  *
    4511              :  * Note that this acquires a buffer pin, which the caller must release.
    4512              :  *
    4513              :  * Input parameters:
    4514              :  *  relation: relation containing tuple (caller must hold suitable lock)
    4515              :  *  cid: current command ID (used for visibility test, and stored into
    4516              :  *      tuple's cmax if lock is successful)
    4517              :  *  mode: indicates if shared or exclusive tuple lock is desired
    4518              :  *  wait_policy: what to do if tuple lock is not available
    4519              :  *  follow_updates: if true, follow the update chain to also lock descendant
    4520              :  *      tuples.
    4521              :  *
    4522              :  * Output parameters:
    4523              :  *  *tuple: all fields filled in
    4524              :  *  *buffer: set to buffer holding tuple (pinned but not locked at exit)
    4525              :  *  *tmfd: filled in failure cases (see below)
    4526              :  *
    4527              :  * Function results are the same as the ones for table_tuple_lock().
    4528              :  *
    4529              :  * In the failure cases other than TM_Invisible, the routine fills
    4530              :  * *tmfd with the tuple's t_ctid, t_xmax (resolving a possible MultiXact,
    4531              :  * if necessary), and t_cmax (the last only for TM_SelfModified,
    4532              :  * since we cannot obtain cmax from a combo CID generated by another
    4533              :  * transaction).
    4534              :  * See comments for struct TM_FailureData for additional info.
    4535              :  *
    4536              :  * See README.tuplock for a thorough explanation of this mechanism.
    4537              :  */
    4538              : TM_Result
    4539       570496 : heap_lock_tuple(Relation relation, HeapTuple tuple,
    4540              :                 CommandId cid, LockTupleMode mode, LockWaitPolicy wait_policy,
    4541              :                 bool follow_updates,
    4542              :                 Buffer *buffer, TM_FailureData *tmfd)
    4543              : {
    4544              :     TM_Result   result;
    4545       570496 :     ItemPointer tid = &(tuple->t_self);
    4546              :     ItemId      lp;
    4547              :     Page        page;
    4548       570496 :     Buffer      vmbuffer = InvalidBuffer;
    4549              :     BlockNumber block;
    4550              :     TransactionId xid,
    4551              :                 xmax;
    4552              :     uint16      old_infomask,
    4553              :                 new_infomask,
    4554              :                 new_infomask2;
    4555       570496 :     bool        first_time = true;
    4556       570496 :     bool        skip_tuple_lock = false;
    4557       570496 :     bool        have_tuple_lock = false;
    4558       570496 :     bool        cleared_all_frozen = false;
    4559              : 
    4560       570496 :     *buffer = ReadBuffer(relation, ItemPointerGetBlockNumber(tid));
    4561       570496 :     block = ItemPointerGetBlockNumber(tid);
    4562              : 
    4563              :     /*
    4564              :      * Before locking the buffer, pin the visibility map page if it appears to
    4565              :      * be necessary.  Since we haven't got the lock yet, someone else might be
    4566              :      * in the middle of changing this, so we'll need to recheck after we have
    4567              :      * the lock.
    4568              :      */
    4569       570496 :     if (PageIsAllVisible(BufferGetPage(*buffer)))
    4570       413520 :         visibilitymap_pin(relation, block, &vmbuffer);
    4571              : 
    4572       570496 :     LockBuffer(*buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_EXCLUSIVE);
    4573              : 
    4574       570496 :     page = BufferGetPage(*buffer);
    4575       570496 :     lp = PageGetItemId(page, ItemPointerGetOffsetNumber(tid));
    4576              :     Assert(ItemIdIsNormal(lp));
    4577              : 
    4578       570496 :     tuple->t_data = (HeapTupleHeader) PageGetItem(page, lp);
    4579       570496 :     tuple->t_len = ItemIdGetLength(lp);
    4580       570496 :     tuple->t_tableOid = RelationGetRelid(relation);
    4581              : 
    4582           18 : l3:
    4583       570514 :     result = HeapTupleSatisfiesUpdate(tuple, cid, *buffer);
    4584              : 
    4585       570514 :     if (result == TM_Invisible)
    4586              :     {
    4587              :         /*
    4588              :          * This is possible, but only when locking a tuple for ON CONFLICT DO
    4589              :          * SELECT/UPDATE.  We return this value here rather than throwing an
    4590              :          * error in order to give that case the opportunity to throw a more
    4591              :          * specific error.
    4592              :          */
    4593           28 :         result = TM_Invisible;
    4594           28 :         goto out_locked;
    4595              :     }
    4596       570486 :     else if (result == TM_BeingModified ||
    4597        80208 :              result == TM_Updated ||
    4598              :              result == TM_Deleted)
    4599              :     {
    4600              :         TransactionId xwait;
    4601              :         uint16      infomask;
    4602              :         uint16      infomask2;
    4603              :         bool        require_sleep;
    4604              :         ItemPointerData t_ctid;
    4605              : 
    4606              :         /* must copy state data before unlocking buffer */
    4607       490280 :         xwait = HeapTupleHeaderGetRawXmax(tuple->t_data);
    4608       490280 :         infomask = tuple->t_data->t_infomask;
    4609       490280 :         infomask2 = tuple->t_data->t_infomask2;
    4610       490280 :         ItemPointerCopy(&tuple->t_data->t_ctid, &t_ctid);
    4611              : 
    4612       490280 :         LockBuffer(*buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_UNLOCK);
    4613              : 
    4614              :         /*
    4615              :          * If any subtransaction of the current top transaction already holds
    4616              :          * a lock as strong as or stronger than what we're requesting, we
    4617              :          * effectively hold the desired lock already.  We *must* succeed
    4618              :          * without trying to take the tuple lock, else we will deadlock
    4619              :          * against anyone wanting to acquire a stronger lock.
    4620              :          *
    4621              :          * Note we only do this the first time we loop on the HTSU result;
    4622              :          * there is no point in testing in subsequent passes, because
    4623              :          * evidently our own transaction cannot have acquired a new lock after
    4624              :          * the first time we checked.
    4625              :          */
    4626       490280 :         if (first_time)
    4627              :         {
    4628       490268 :             first_time = false;
    4629              : 
    4630       490268 :             if (infomask & HEAP_XMAX_IS_MULTI)
    4631              :             {
    4632              :                 int         i;
    4633              :                 int         nmembers;
    4634              :                 MultiXactMember *members;
    4635              : 
    4636              :                 /*
    4637              :                  * We don't need to allow old multixacts here; if that had
    4638              :                  * been the case, HeapTupleSatisfiesUpdate would have returned
    4639              :                  * MayBeUpdated and we wouldn't be here.
    4640              :                  */
    4641              :                 nmembers =
    4642        73308 :                     GetMultiXactIdMembers(xwait, &members, false,
    4643        73308 :                                           HEAP_XMAX_IS_LOCKED_ONLY(infomask));
    4644              : 
    4645      1422697 :                 for (i = 0; i < nmembers; i++)
    4646              :                 {
    4647              :                     /* only consider members of our own transaction */
    4648      1349403 :                     if (!TransactionIdIsCurrentTransactionId(members[i].xid))
    4649      1349353 :                         continue;
    4650              : 
    4651           50 :                     if (TUPLOCK_from_mxstatus(members[i].status) >= mode)
    4652              :                     {
    4653           14 :                         pfree(members);
    4654           14 :                         result = TM_Ok;
    4655           14 :                         goto out_unlocked;
    4656              :                     }
    4657              :                     else
    4658              :                     {
    4659              :                         /*
    4660              :                          * Disable acquisition of the heavyweight tuple lock.
    4661              :                          * Otherwise, when promoting a weaker lock, we might
    4662              :                          * deadlock with another locker that has acquired the
    4663              :                          * heavyweight tuple lock and is waiting for our
    4664              :                          * transaction to finish.
    4665              :                          *
    4666              :                          * Note that in this case we still need to wait for
    4667              :                          * the multixact if required, to avoid acquiring
    4668              :                          * conflicting locks.
    4669              :                          */
    4670           36 :                         skip_tuple_lock = true;
    4671              :                     }
    4672              :                 }
    4673              : 
    4674        73294 :                 if (members)
    4675        73294 :                     pfree(members);
    4676              :             }
    4677       416960 :             else if (TransactionIdIsCurrentTransactionId(xwait))
    4678              :             {
    4679       415536 :                 switch (mode)
    4680              :                 {
    4681       409097 :                     case LockTupleKeyShare:
    4682              :                         Assert(HEAP_XMAX_IS_KEYSHR_LOCKED(infomask) ||
    4683              :                                HEAP_XMAX_IS_SHR_LOCKED(infomask) ||
    4684              :                                HEAP_XMAX_IS_EXCL_LOCKED(infomask));
    4685       409097 :                         result = TM_Ok;
    4686       409097 :                         goto out_unlocked;
    4687           36 :                     case LockTupleShare:
    4688           42 :                         if (HEAP_XMAX_IS_SHR_LOCKED(infomask) ||
    4689            6 :                             HEAP_XMAX_IS_EXCL_LOCKED(infomask))
    4690              :                         {
    4691           30 :                             result = TM_Ok;
    4692           30 :                             goto out_unlocked;
    4693              :                         }
    4694            6 :                         break;
    4695           82 :                     case LockTupleNoKeyExclusive:
    4696           82 :                         if (HEAP_XMAX_IS_EXCL_LOCKED(infomask))
    4697              :                         {
    4698           70 :                             result = TM_Ok;
    4699           70 :                             goto out_unlocked;
    4700              :                         }
    4701           12 :                         break;
    4702         6321 :                     case LockTupleExclusive:
    4703         6321 :                         if (HEAP_XMAX_IS_EXCL_LOCKED(infomask) &&
    4704         1279 :                             infomask2 & HEAP_KEYS_UPDATED)
    4705              :                         {
    4706         1251 :                             result = TM_Ok;
    4707         1251 :                             goto out_unlocked;
    4708              :                         }
    4709         5070 :                         break;
    4710              :                 }
    4711              :             }
    4712              :         }
    4713              : 
    4714              :         /*
    4715              :          * Initially assume that we will have to wait for the locking
    4716              :          * transaction(s) to finish.  We check various cases below in which
    4717              :          * this can be turned off.
    4718              :          */
    4719        79818 :         require_sleep = true;
    4720        79818 :         if (mode == LockTupleKeyShare)
    4721              :         {
    4722              :             /*
    4723              :              * If we're requesting KeyShare, and there's no update present, we
    4724              :              * don't need to wait.  Even if there is an update, we can still
    4725              :              * continue if the key hasn't been modified.
    4726              :              *
    4727              :              * However, if there are updates, we need to walk the update chain
    4728              :              * to mark future versions of the row as locked, too.  That way,
    4729              :              * if somebody deletes that future version, we're protected
    4730              :              * against the key going away.  This locking of future versions
    4731              :              * could block momentarily, if a concurrent transaction is
    4732              :              * deleting a key; or it could return a value to the effect that
    4733              :              * the transaction deleting the key has already committed.  So we
    4734              :              * do this before re-locking the buffer; otherwise this would be
    4735              :              * prone to deadlocks.
    4736              :              *
    4737              :              * Note that the TID we're locking was grabbed before we unlocked
    4738              :              * the buffer.  For it to change while we're not looking, the
    4739              :              * other properties we're testing for below after re-locking the
    4740              :              * buffer would also change, in which case we would restart this
    4741              :              * loop above.
    4742              :              */
    4743        73910 :             if (!(infomask2 & HEAP_KEYS_UPDATED))
    4744              :             {
    4745              :                 bool        updated;
    4746              : 
    4747        73863 :                 updated = !HEAP_XMAX_IS_LOCKED_ONLY(infomask);
    4748              : 
    4749              :                 /*
    4750              :                  * If there are updates, follow the update chain; bail out if
    4751              :                  * that cannot be done.
    4752              :                  */
    4753        73863 :                 if (follow_updates && updated &&
    4754         2171 :                     !ItemPointerEquals(&tuple->t_self, &t_ctid))
    4755              :                 {
    4756              :                     TM_Result   res;
    4757              : 
    4758         2171 :                     res = heap_lock_updated_tuple(relation,
    4759              :                                                   infomask, xwait, &t_ctid,
    4760              :                                                   GetCurrentTransactionId(),
    4761              :                                                   mode);
    4762         2171 :                     if (res != TM_Ok)
    4763              :                     {
    4764            6 :                         result = res;
    4765              :                         /* recovery code expects to have buffer lock held */
    4766            6 :                         LockBuffer(*buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_EXCLUSIVE);
    4767          207 :                         goto failed;
    4768              :                     }
    4769              :                 }
    4770              : 
    4771        73857 :                 LockBuffer(*buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_EXCLUSIVE);
    4772              : 
    4773              :                 /*
    4774              :                  * Make sure it's still an appropriate lock, else start over.
    4775              :                  * Also, if it wasn't updated before we released the lock, but
    4776              :                  * is updated now, we start over too; the reason is that we
    4777              :                  * now need to follow the update chain to lock the new
    4778              :                  * versions.
    4779              :                  */
    4780        73857 :                 if (!HeapTupleHeaderIsOnlyLocked(tuple->t_data) &&
    4781         2153 :                     ((tuple->t_data->t_infomask2 & HEAP_KEYS_UPDATED) ||
    4782         2153 :                      !updated))
    4783           18 :                     goto l3;
    4784              : 
    4785              :                 /* Things look okay, so we can skip sleeping */
    4786        73857 :                 require_sleep = false;
    4787              : 
    4788              :                 /*
    4789              :                  * Note we allow Xmax to change here; other updaters/lockers
    4790              :                  * could have modified it before we grabbed the buffer lock.
    4791              :                  * However, this is not a problem, because with the recheck we
    4792              :                  * just did we ensure that they still don't conflict with the
    4793              :                  * lock we want.
    4794              :                  */
    4795              :             }
    4796              :         }
    4797         5908 :         else if (mode == LockTupleShare)
    4798              :         {
    4799              :             /*
    4800              :              * If we're requesting Share, we can similarly avoid sleeping if
    4801              :              * there's no update and no exclusive lock present.
    4802              :              */
    4803          480 :             if (HEAP_XMAX_IS_LOCKED_ONLY(infomask) &&
    4804          480 :                 !HEAP_XMAX_IS_EXCL_LOCKED(infomask))
    4805              :             {
    4806          474 :                 LockBuffer(*buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_EXCLUSIVE);
    4807              : 
    4808              :                 /*
    4809              :                  * Make sure it's still an appropriate lock, else start over.
    4810              :                  * See above about allowing xmax to change.
    4811              :                  */
    4812          948 :                 if (!HEAP_XMAX_IS_LOCKED_ONLY(tuple->t_data->t_infomask) ||
    4813          474 :                     HEAP_XMAX_IS_EXCL_LOCKED(tuple->t_data->t_infomask))
    4814            0 :                     goto l3;
    4815          474 :                 require_sleep = false;
    4816              :             }
    4817              :         }
    4818         5428 :         else if (mode == LockTupleNoKeyExclusive)
    4819              :         {
    4820              :             /*
    4821              :              * If we're requesting NoKeyExclusive, we might also be able to
    4822              :              * avoid sleeping; just ensure that there no conflicting lock
    4823              :              * already acquired.
    4824              :              */
    4825          173 :             if (infomask & HEAP_XMAX_IS_MULTI)
    4826              :             {
    4827           26 :                 if (!DoesMultiXactIdConflict((MultiXactId) xwait, infomask,
    4828              :                                              mode, NULL))
    4829              :                 {
    4830              :                     /*
    4831              :                      * No conflict, but if the xmax changed under us in the
    4832              :                      * meantime, start over.
    4833              :                      */
    4834           13 :                     LockBuffer(*buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_EXCLUSIVE);
    4835           26 :                     if (xmax_infomask_changed(tuple->t_data->t_infomask, infomask) ||
    4836           13 :                         !TransactionIdEquals(HeapTupleHeaderGetRawXmax(tuple->t_data),
    4837              :                                              xwait))
    4838            0 :                         goto l3;
    4839              : 
    4840              :                     /* otherwise, we're good */
    4841           13 :                     require_sleep = false;
    4842              :                 }
    4843              :             }
    4844          147 :             else if (HEAP_XMAX_IS_KEYSHR_LOCKED(infomask))
    4845              :             {
    4846           18 :                 LockBuffer(*buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_EXCLUSIVE);
    4847              : 
    4848              :                 /* if the xmax changed in the meantime, start over */
    4849           36 :                 if (xmax_infomask_changed(tuple->t_data->t_infomask, infomask) ||
    4850           18 :                     !TransactionIdEquals(HeapTupleHeaderGetRawXmax(tuple->t_data),
    4851              :                                          xwait))
    4852            0 :                     goto l3;
    4853              :                 /* otherwise, we're good */
    4854           18 :                 require_sleep = false;
    4855              :             }
    4856              :         }
    4857              : 
    4858              :         /*
    4859              :          * As a check independent from those above, we can also avoid sleeping
    4860              :          * if the current transaction is the sole locker of the tuple.  Note
    4861              :          * that the strength of the lock already held is irrelevant; this is
    4862              :          * not about recording the lock in Xmax (which will be done regardless
    4863              :          * of this optimization, below).  Also, note that the cases where we
    4864              :          * hold a lock stronger than we are requesting are already handled
    4865              :          * above by not doing anything.
    4866              :          *
    4867              :          * Note we only deal with the non-multixact case here; MultiXactIdWait
    4868              :          * is well equipped to deal with this situation on its own.
    4869              :          */
    4870        85218 :         if (require_sleep && !(infomask & HEAP_XMAX_IS_MULTI) &&
    4871         5406 :             TransactionIdIsCurrentTransactionId(xwait))
    4872              :         {
    4873              :             /* ... but if the xmax changed in the meantime, start over */
    4874         5070 :             LockBuffer(*buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_EXCLUSIVE);
    4875        10140 :             if (xmax_infomask_changed(tuple->t_data->t_infomask, infomask) ||
    4876         5070 :                 !TransactionIdEquals(HeapTupleHeaderGetRawXmax(tuple->t_data),
    4877              :                                      xwait))
    4878            0 :                 goto l3;
    4879              :             Assert(HEAP_XMAX_IS_LOCKED_ONLY(tuple->t_data->t_infomask));
    4880         5070 :             require_sleep = false;
    4881              :         }
    4882              : 
    4883              :         /*
    4884              :          * Time to sleep on the other transaction/multixact, if necessary.
    4885              :          *
    4886              :          * If the other transaction is an update/delete that's already
    4887              :          * committed, then sleeping cannot possibly do any good: if we're
    4888              :          * required to sleep, get out to raise an error instead.
    4889              :          *
    4890              :          * By here, we either have already acquired the buffer exclusive lock,
    4891              :          * or we must wait for the locking transaction or multixact; so below
    4892              :          * we ensure that we grab buffer lock after the sleep.
    4893              :          */
    4894        79812 :         if (require_sleep && (result == TM_Updated || result == TM_Deleted))
    4895              :         {
    4896          162 :             LockBuffer(*buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_EXCLUSIVE);
    4897          162 :             goto failed;
    4898              :         }
    4899        79650 :         else if (require_sleep)
    4900              :         {
    4901              :             /*
    4902              :              * Acquire tuple lock to establish our priority for the tuple, or
    4903              :              * die trying.  LockTuple will release us when we are next-in-line
    4904              :              * for the tuple.  We must do this even if we are share-locking,
    4905              :              * but not if we already have a weaker lock on the tuple.
    4906              :              *
    4907              :              * If we are forced to "start over" below, we keep the tuple lock;
    4908              :              * this arranges that we stay at the head of the line while
    4909              :              * rechecking tuple state.
    4910              :              */
    4911          218 :             if (!skip_tuple_lock &&
    4912          201 :                 !heap_acquire_tuplock(relation, tid, mode, wait_policy,
    4913              :                                       &have_tuple_lock))
    4914              :             {
    4915              :                 /*
    4916              :                  * This can only happen if wait_policy is Skip and the lock
    4917              :                  * couldn't be obtained.
    4918              :                  */
    4919            1 :                 result = TM_WouldBlock;
    4920              :                 /* recovery code expects to have buffer lock held */
    4921            1 :                 LockBuffer(*buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_EXCLUSIVE);
    4922            1 :                 goto failed;
    4923              :             }
    4924              : 
    4925          216 :             if (infomask & HEAP_XMAX_IS_MULTI)
    4926              :             {
    4927           43 :                 MultiXactStatus status = get_mxact_status_for_lock(mode, false);
    4928              : 
    4929              :                 /* We only ever lock tuples, never update them */
    4930           43 :                 if (status >= MultiXactStatusNoKeyUpdate)
    4931            0 :                     elog(ERROR, "invalid lock mode in heap_lock_tuple");
    4932              : 
    4933              :                 /* wait for multixact to end, or die trying  */
    4934           43 :                 switch (wait_policy)
    4935              :                 {
    4936           37 :                     case LockWaitBlock:
    4937           37 :                         MultiXactIdWait((MultiXactId) xwait, status, infomask,
    4938           37 :                                         relation, &tuple->t_self, XLTW_Lock, NULL);
    4939           37 :                         break;
    4940            2 :                     case LockWaitSkip:
    4941            2 :                         if (!ConditionalMultiXactIdWait((MultiXactId) xwait,
    4942              :                                                         status, infomask, relation,
    4943              :                                                         NULL, false))
    4944              :                         {
    4945            2 :                             result = TM_WouldBlock;
    4946              :                             /* recovery code expects to have buffer lock held */
    4947            2 :                             LockBuffer(*buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_EXCLUSIVE);
    4948            2 :                             goto failed;
    4949              :                         }
    4950            0 :                         break;
    4951            4 :                     case LockWaitError:
    4952            4 :                         if (!ConditionalMultiXactIdWait((MultiXactId) xwait,
    4953              :                                                         status, infomask, relation,
    4954              :                                                         NULL, log_lock_failures))
    4955            4 :                             ereport(ERROR,
    4956              :                                     (errcode(ERRCODE_LOCK_NOT_AVAILABLE),
    4957              :                                      errmsg("could not obtain lock on row in relation \"%s\"",
    4958              :                                             RelationGetRelationName(relation))));
    4959              : 
    4960            0 :                         break;
    4961              :                 }
    4962              : 
    4963              :                 /*
    4964              :                  * Of course, the multixact might not be done here: if we're
    4965              :                  * requesting a light lock mode, other transactions with light
    4966              :                  * locks could still be alive, as well as locks owned by our
    4967              :                  * own xact or other subxacts of this backend.  We need to
    4968              :                  * preserve the surviving MultiXact members.  Note that it
    4969              :                  * isn't absolutely necessary in the latter case, but doing so
    4970              :                  * is simpler.
    4971              :                  */
    4972              :             }
    4973              :             else
    4974              :             {
    4975              :                 /* wait for regular transaction to end, or die trying */
    4976          173 :                 switch (wait_policy)
    4977              :                 {
    4978          132 :                     case LockWaitBlock:
    4979          132 :                         XactLockTableWait(xwait, relation, &tuple->t_self,
    4980              :                                           XLTW_Lock);
    4981          132 :                         break;
    4982           33 :                     case LockWaitSkip:
    4983           33 :                         if (!ConditionalXactLockTableWait(xwait, false))
    4984              :                         {
    4985           33 :                             result = TM_WouldBlock;
    4986              :                             /* recovery code expects to have buffer lock held */
    4987           33 :                             LockBuffer(*buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_EXCLUSIVE);
    4988           33 :                             goto failed;
    4989              :                         }
    4990            0 :                         break;
    4991            8 :                     case LockWaitError:
    4992            8 :                         if (!ConditionalXactLockTableWait(xwait, log_lock_failures))
    4993            8 :                             ereport(ERROR,
    4994              :                                     (errcode(ERRCODE_LOCK_NOT_AVAILABLE),
    4995              :                                      errmsg("could not obtain lock on row in relation \"%s\"",
    4996              :                                             RelationGetRelationName(relation))));
    4997            0 :                         break;
    4998              :                 }
    4999              :             }
    5000              : 
    5001              :             /* if there are updates, follow the update chain */
    5002          169 :             if (follow_updates && !HEAP_XMAX_IS_LOCKED_ONLY(infomask) &&
    5003           75 :                 !ItemPointerEquals(&tuple->t_self, &t_ctid))
    5004              :             {
    5005              :                 TM_Result   res;
    5006              : 
    5007           55 :                 res = heap_lock_updated_tuple(relation,
    5008              :                                               infomask, xwait, &t_ctid,
    5009              :                                               GetCurrentTransactionId(),
    5010              :                                               mode);
    5011           55 :                 if (res != TM_Ok)
    5012              :                 {
    5013            3 :                     result = res;
    5014              :                     /* recovery code expects to have buffer lock held */
    5015            3 :                     LockBuffer(*buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_EXCLUSIVE);
    5016            3 :                     goto failed;
    5017              :                 }
    5018              :             }
    5019              : 
    5020          166 :             LockBuffer(*buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_EXCLUSIVE);
    5021              : 
    5022              :             /*
    5023              :              * xwait is done, but if xwait had just locked the tuple then some
    5024              :              * other xact could update this tuple before we get to this point.
    5025              :              * Check for xmax change, and start over if so.
    5026              :              */
    5027          316 :             if (xmax_infomask_changed(tuple->t_data->t_infomask, infomask) ||
    5028          150 :                 !TransactionIdEquals(HeapTupleHeaderGetRawXmax(tuple->t_data),
    5029              :                                      xwait))
    5030           18 :                 goto l3;
    5031              : 
    5032          148 :             if (!(infomask & HEAP_XMAX_IS_MULTI))
    5033              :             {
    5034              :                 /*
    5035              :                  * Otherwise check if it committed or aborted.  Note we cannot
    5036              :                  * be here if the tuple was only locked by somebody who didn't
    5037              :                  * conflict with us; that would have been handled above.  So
    5038              :                  * that transaction must necessarily be gone by now.  But
    5039              :                  * don't check for this in the multixact case, because some
    5040              :                  * locker transactions might still be running.
    5041              :                  */
    5042          116 :                 UpdateXmaxHintBits(tuple->t_data, *buffer, xwait);
    5043              :             }
    5044              :         }
    5045              : 
    5046              :         /* By here, we're certain that we hold buffer exclusive lock again */
    5047              : 
    5048              :         /*
    5049              :          * We may lock if previous xmax aborted, or if it committed but only
    5050              :          * locked the tuple without updating it; or if we didn't have to wait
    5051              :          * at all for whatever reason.
    5052              :          */
    5053        79580 :         if (!require_sleep ||
    5054          260 :             (tuple->t_data->t_infomask & HEAP_XMAX_INVALID) ||
    5055          209 :             HEAP_XMAX_IS_LOCKED_ONLY(tuple->t_data->t_infomask) ||
    5056           97 :             HeapTupleHeaderIsOnlyLocked(tuple->t_data))
    5057        79490 :             result = TM_Ok;
    5058           90 :         else if (!ItemPointerEquals(&tuple->t_self, &tuple->t_data->t_ctid))
    5059           65 :             result = TM_Updated;
    5060              :         else
    5061           25 :             result = TM_Deleted;
    5062              :     }
    5063              : 
    5064        80206 : failed:
    5065       159993 :     if (result != TM_Ok)
    5066              :     {
    5067              :         Assert(result == TM_SelfModified || result == TM_Updated ||
    5068              :                result == TM_Deleted || result == TM_WouldBlock);
    5069              : 
    5070              :         /*
    5071              :          * When locking a tuple under LockWaitSkip semantics and we fail with
    5072              :          * TM_WouldBlock above, it's possible for concurrent transactions to
    5073              :          * release the lock and set HEAP_XMAX_INVALID in the meantime.  So
    5074              :          * this assert is slightly different from the equivalent one in
    5075              :          * heap_delete and heap_update.
    5076              :          */
    5077              :         Assert((result == TM_WouldBlock) ||
    5078              :                !(tuple->t_data->t_infomask & HEAP_XMAX_INVALID));
    5079              :         Assert(result != TM_Updated ||
    5080              :                !ItemPointerEquals(&tuple->t_self, &tuple->t_data->t_ctid));
    5081          305 :         tmfd->ctid = tuple->t_data->t_ctid;
    5082          305 :         tmfd->xmax = HeapTupleHeaderGetUpdateXid(tuple->t_data);
    5083          305 :         if (result == TM_SelfModified)
    5084            8 :             tmfd->cmax = HeapTupleHeaderGetCmax(tuple->t_data);
    5085              :         else
    5086          297 :             tmfd->cmax = InvalidCommandId;
    5087          305 :         goto out_locked;
    5088              :     }
    5089              : 
    5090              :     /*
    5091              :      * If we didn't pin the visibility map page and the page has become all
    5092              :      * visible while we were busy locking the buffer, or during some
    5093              :      * subsequent window during which we had it unlocked, we'll have to unlock
    5094              :      * and re-lock, to avoid holding the buffer lock across I/O.  That's a bit
    5095              :      * unfortunate, especially since we'll now have to recheck whether the
    5096              :      * tuple has been locked or updated under us, but hopefully it won't
    5097              :      * happen very often.
    5098              :      */
    5099       159688 :     if (vmbuffer == InvalidBuffer && PageIsAllVisible(page))
    5100              :     {
    5101            0 :         LockBuffer(*buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_UNLOCK);
    5102            0 :         visibilitymap_pin(relation, block, &vmbuffer);
    5103            0 :         LockBuffer(*buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_EXCLUSIVE);
    5104            0 :         goto l3;
    5105              :     }
    5106              : 
    5107       159688 :     xmax = HeapTupleHeaderGetRawXmax(tuple->t_data);
    5108       159688 :     old_infomask = tuple->t_data->t_infomask;
    5109              : 
    5110              :     /*
    5111              :      * If this is the first possibly-multixact-able operation in the current
    5112              :      * transaction, set my per-backend OldestMemberMXactId setting. We can be
    5113              :      * certain that the transaction will never become a member of any older
    5114              :      * MultiXactIds than that.  (We have to do this even if we end up just
    5115              :      * using our own TransactionId below, since some other backend could
    5116              :      * incorporate our XID into a MultiXact immediately afterwards.)
    5117              :      */
    5118       159688 :     MultiXactIdSetOldestMember();
    5119              : 
    5120              :     /*
    5121              :      * Compute the new xmax and infomask to store into the tuple.  Note we do
    5122              :      * not modify the tuple just yet, because that would leave it in the wrong
    5123              :      * state if multixact.c elogs.
    5124              :      */
    5125       159688 :     compute_new_xmax_infomask(xmax, old_infomask, tuple->t_data->t_infomask2,
    5126              :                               GetCurrentTransactionId(), mode, false,
    5127              :                               &xid, &new_infomask, &new_infomask2);
    5128              : 
    5129       159688 :     START_CRIT_SECTION();
    5130              : 
    5131              :     /*
    5132              :      * Store transaction information of xact locking the tuple.
    5133              :      *
    5134              :      * Note: Cmax is meaningless in this context, so don't set it; this avoids
    5135              :      * possibly generating a useless combo CID.  Moreover, if we're locking a
    5136              :      * previously updated tuple, it's important to preserve the Cmax.
    5137              :      *
    5138              :      * Also reset the HOT UPDATE bit, but only if there's no update; otherwise
    5139              :      * we would break the HOT chain.
    5140              :      */
    5141       159688 :     tuple->t_data->t_infomask &= ~HEAP_XMAX_BITS;
    5142       159688 :     tuple->t_data->t_infomask2 &= ~HEAP_KEYS_UPDATED;
    5143       159688 :     tuple->t_data->t_infomask |= new_infomask;
    5144       159688 :     tuple->t_data->t_infomask2 |= new_infomask2;
    5145       159688 :     if (HEAP_XMAX_IS_LOCKED_ONLY(new_infomask))
    5146       157539 :         HeapTupleHeaderClearHotUpdated(tuple->t_data);
    5147       159688 :     HeapTupleHeaderSetXmax(tuple->t_data, xid);
    5148              : 
    5149              :     /*
    5150              :      * Make sure there is no forward chain link in t_ctid.  Note that in the
    5151              :      * cases where the tuple has been updated, we must not overwrite t_ctid,
    5152              :      * because it was set by the updater.  Moreover, if the tuple has been
    5153              :      * updated, we need to follow the update chain to lock the new versions of
    5154              :      * the tuple as well.
    5155              :      */
    5156       159688 :     if (HEAP_XMAX_IS_LOCKED_ONLY(new_infomask))
    5157       157539 :         tuple->t_data->t_ctid = *tid;
    5158              : 
    5159              :     /* Clear only the all-frozen bit on visibility map if needed */
    5160       163311 :     if (PageIsAllVisible(page) &&
    5161         3623 :         visibilitymap_clear(relation, block, vmbuffer,
    5162              :                             VISIBILITYMAP_ALL_FROZEN))
    5163           15 :         cleared_all_frozen = true;
    5164              : 
    5165              : 
    5166       159688 :     MarkBufferDirty(*buffer);
    5167              : 
    5168              :     /*
    5169              :      * XLOG stuff.  You might think that we don't need an XLOG record because
    5170              :      * there is no state change worth restoring after a crash.  You would be
    5171              :      * wrong however: we have just written either a TransactionId or a
    5172              :      * MultiXactId that may never have been seen on disk before, and we need
    5173              :      * to make sure that there are XLOG entries covering those ID numbers.
    5174              :      * Else the same IDs might be re-used after a crash, which would be
    5175              :      * disastrous if this page made it to disk before the crash.  Essentially
    5176              :      * we have to enforce the WAL log-before-data rule even in this case.
    5177              :      * (Also, in a PITR log-shipping or 2PC environment, we have to have XLOG
    5178              :      * entries for everything anyway.)
    5179              :      */
    5180       159688 :     if (RelationNeedsWAL(relation))
    5181              :     {
    5182              :         xl_heap_lock xlrec;
    5183              :         XLogRecPtr  recptr;
    5184              : 
    5185       159259 :         XLogBeginInsert();
    5186       159259 :         XLogRegisterBuffer(0, *buffer, REGBUF_STANDARD);
    5187              : 
    5188       159259 :         xlrec.offnum = ItemPointerGetOffsetNumber(&tuple->t_self);
    5189       159259 :         xlrec.xmax = xid;
    5190       318518 :         xlrec.infobits_set = compute_infobits(new_infomask,
    5191       159259 :                                               tuple->t_data->t_infomask2);
    5192       159259 :         xlrec.flags = cleared_all_frozen ? XLH_LOCK_ALL_FROZEN_CLEARED : 0;
    5193       159259 :         XLogRegisterData(&xlrec, SizeOfHeapLock);
    5194              : 
    5195              :         /* we don't decode row locks atm, so no need to log the origin */
    5196              : 
    5197       159259 :         recptr = XLogInsert(RM_HEAP_ID, XLOG_HEAP_LOCK);
    5198              : 
    5199       159259 :         PageSetLSN(page, recptr);
    5200              :     }
    5201              : 
    5202       159688 :     END_CRIT_SECTION();
    5203              : 
    5204       159688 :     result = TM_Ok;
    5205              : 
    5206       160021 : out_locked:
    5207       160021 :     LockBuffer(*buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_UNLOCK);
    5208              : 
    5209       570483 : out_unlocked:
    5210       570483 :     if (BufferIsValid(vmbuffer))
    5211       413520 :         ReleaseBuffer(vmbuffer);
    5212              : 
    5213              :     /*
    5214              :      * Don't update the visibility map here. Locking a tuple doesn't change
    5215              :      * visibility info.
    5216              :      */
    5217              : 
    5218              :     /*
    5219              :      * Now that we have successfully marked the tuple as locked, we can
    5220              :      * release the lmgr tuple lock, if we had it.
    5221              :      */
    5222       570483 :     if (have_tuple_lock)
    5223          182 :         UnlockTupleTuplock(relation, tid, mode);
    5224              : 
    5225       570483 :     return result;
    5226              : }
    5227              : 
    5228              : /*
    5229              :  * Acquire heavyweight lock on the given tuple, in preparation for acquiring
    5230              :  * its normal, Xmax-based tuple lock.
    5231              :  *
    5232              :  * have_tuple_lock is an input and output parameter: on input, it indicates
    5233              :  * whether the lock has previously been acquired (and this function does
    5234              :  * nothing in that case).  If this function returns success, have_tuple_lock
    5235              :  * has been flipped to true.
    5236              :  *
    5237              :  * Returns false if it was unable to obtain the lock; this can only happen if
    5238              :  * wait_policy is Skip.
    5239              :  */
    5240              : static bool
    5241          376 : heap_acquire_tuplock(Relation relation, const ItemPointerData *tid, LockTupleMode mode,
    5242              :                      LockWaitPolicy wait_policy, bool *have_tuple_lock)
    5243              : {
    5244          376 :     if (*have_tuple_lock)
    5245            9 :         return true;
    5246              : 
    5247          367 :     switch (wait_policy)
    5248              :     {
    5249          322 :         case LockWaitBlock:
    5250          322 :             LockTupleTuplock(relation, tid, mode);
    5251          322 :             break;
    5252              : 
    5253           34 :         case LockWaitSkip:
    5254           34 :             if (!ConditionalLockTupleTuplock(relation, tid, mode, false))
    5255            1 :                 return false;
    5256           33 :             break;
    5257              : 
    5258           11 :         case LockWaitError:
    5259           11 :             if (!ConditionalLockTupleTuplock(relation, tid, mode, log_lock_failures))
    5260            1 :                 ereport(ERROR,
    5261              :                         (errcode(ERRCODE_LOCK_NOT_AVAILABLE),
    5262              :                          errmsg("could not obtain lock on row in relation \"%s\"",
    5263              :                                 RelationGetRelationName(relation))));
    5264           10 :             break;
    5265              :     }
    5266          365 :     *have_tuple_lock = true;
    5267              : 
    5268          365 :     return true;
    5269              : }
    5270              : 
    5271              : /*
    5272              :  * Given an original set of Xmax and infomask, and a transaction (identified by
    5273              :  * add_to_xmax) acquiring a new lock of some mode, compute the new Xmax and
    5274              :  * corresponding infomasks to use on the tuple.
    5275              :  *
    5276              :  * Note that this might have side effects such as creating a new MultiXactId.
    5277              :  *
    5278              :  * Most callers will have called HeapTupleSatisfiesUpdate before this function;
    5279              :  * that will have set the HEAP_XMAX_INVALID bit if the xmax was a MultiXactId
    5280              :  * but it was not running anymore. There is a race condition, which is that the
    5281              :  * MultiXactId may have finished since then, but that uncommon case is handled
    5282              :  * either here, or within MultiXactIdExpand.
    5283              :  *
    5284              :  * There is a similar race condition possible when the old xmax was a regular
    5285              :  * TransactionId.  We test TransactionIdIsInProgress again just to narrow the
    5286              :  * window, but it's still possible to end up creating an unnecessary
    5287              :  * MultiXactId.  Fortunately this is harmless.
    5288              :  */
    5289              : static void
    5290      6659304 : compute_new_xmax_infomask(TransactionId xmax, uint16 old_infomask,
    5291              :                           uint16 old_infomask2, TransactionId add_to_xmax,
    5292              :                           LockTupleMode mode, bool is_update,
    5293              :                           TransactionId *result_xmax, uint16 *result_infomask,
    5294              :                           uint16 *result_infomask2)
    5295              : {
    5296              :     TransactionId new_xmax;
    5297              :     uint16      new_infomask,
    5298              :                 new_infomask2;
    5299              : 
    5300              :     Assert(TransactionIdIsCurrentTransactionId(add_to_xmax));
    5301              : 
    5302       104501 : l5:
    5303      6763805 :     new_infomask = 0;
    5304      6763805 :     new_infomask2 = 0;
    5305      6763805 :     if (old_infomask & HEAP_XMAX_INVALID)
    5306              :     {
    5307              :         /*
    5308              :          * No previous locker; we just insert our own TransactionId.
    5309              :          *
    5310              :          * Note that it's critical that this case be the first one checked,
    5311              :          * because there are several blocks below that come back to this one
    5312              :          * to implement certain optimizations; old_infomask might contain
    5313              :          * other dirty bits in those cases, but we don't really care.
    5314              :          */
    5315      6582594 :         if (is_update)
    5316              :         {
    5317      4289766 :             new_xmax = add_to_xmax;
    5318      4289766 :             if (mode == LockTupleExclusive)
    5319      1933363 :                 new_infomask2 |= HEAP_KEYS_UPDATED;
    5320              :         }
    5321              :         else
    5322              :         {
    5323      2292828 :             new_infomask |= HEAP_XMAX_LOCK_ONLY;
    5324      2292828 :             switch (mode)
    5325              :             {
    5326         4978 :                 case LockTupleKeyShare:
    5327         4978 :                     new_xmax = add_to_xmax;
    5328         4978 :                     new_infomask |= HEAP_XMAX_KEYSHR_LOCK;
    5329         4978 :                     break;
    5330          809 :                 case LockTupleShare:
    5331          809 :                     new_xmax = add_to_xmax;
    5332          809 :                     new_infomask |= HEAP_XMAX_SHR_LOCK;
    5333          809 :                     break;
    5334      2191084 :                 case LockTupleNoKeyExclusive:
    5335      2191084 :                     new_xmax = add_to_xmax;
    5336      2191084 :                     new_infomask |= HEAP_XMAX_EXCL_LOCK;
    5337      2191084 :                     break;
    5338        95957 :                 case LockTupleExclusive:
    5339        95957 :                     new_xmax = add_to_xmax;
    5340        95957 :                     new_infomask |= HEAP_XMAX_EXCL_LOCK;
    5341        95957 :                     new_infomask2 |= HEAP_KEYS_UPDATED;
    5342        95957 :                     break;
    5343            0 :                 default:
    5344            0 :                     new_xmax = InvalidTransactionId;    /* silence compiler */
    5345            0 :                     elog(ERROR, "invalid lock mode");
    5346              :             }
    5347              :         }
    5348              :     }
    5349       181211 :     else if (old_infomask & HEAP_XMAX_IS_MULTI)
    5350              :     {
    5351              :         MultiXactStatus new_status;
    5352              : 
    5353              :         /*
    5354              :          * Currently we don't allow XMAX_COMMITTED to be set for multis, so
    5355              :          * cross-check.
    5356              :          */
    5357              :         Assert(!(old_infomask & HEAP_XMAX_COMMITTED));
    5358              : 
    5359              :         /*
    5360              :          * A multixact together with LOCK_ONLY set but neither lock bit set
    5361              :          * (i.e. a pg_upgraded share locked tuple) cannot possibly be running
    5362              :          * anymore.  This check is critical for databases upgraded by
    5363              :          * pg_upgrade; both MultiXactIdIsRunning and MultiXactIdExpand assume
    5364              :          * that such multis are never passed.
    5365              :          */
    5366        75569 :         if (HEAP_LOCKED_UPGRADED(old_infomask))
    5367              :         {
    5368            0 :             old_infomask &= ~HEAP_XMAX_IS_MULTI;
    5369            0 :             old_infomask |= HEAP_XMAX_INVALID;
    5370            0 :             goto l5;
    5371              :         }
    5372              : 
    5373              :         /*
    5374              :          * If the XMAX is already a MultiXactId, then we need to expand it to
    5375              :          * include add_to_xmax; but if all the members were lockers and are
    5376              :          * all gone, we can do away with the IS_MULTI bit and just set
    5377              :          * add_to_xmax as the only locker/updater.  If all lockers are gone
    5378              :          * and we have an updater that aborted, we can also do without a
    5379              :          * multi.
    5380              :          *
    5381              :          * The cost of doing GetMultiXactIdMembers would be paid by
    5382              :          * MultiXactIdExpand if we weren't to do this, so this check is not
    5383              :          * incurring extra work anyhow.
    5384              :          */
    5385        75569 :         if (!MultiXactIdIsRunning(xmax, HEAP_XMAX_IS_LOCKED_ONLY(old_infomask)))
    5386              :         {
    5387           23 :             if (HEAP_XMAX_IS_LOCKED_ONLY(old_infomask) ||
    5388            8 :                 !TransactionIdDidCommit(MultiXactIdGetUpdateXid(xmax,
    5389              :                                                                 old_infomask)))
    5390              :             {
    5391              :                 /*
    5392              :                  * Reset these bits and restart; otherwise fall through to
    5393              :                  * create a new multi below.
    5394              :                  */
    5395           23 :                 old_infomask &= ~HEAP_XMAX_IS_MULTI;
    5396           23 :                 old_infomask |= HEAP_XMAX_INVALID;
    5397           23 :                 goto l5;
    5398              :             }
    5399              :         }
    5400              : 
    5401        75546 :         new_status = get_mxact_status_for_lock(mode, is_update);
    5402              : 
    5403        75546 :         new_xmax = MultiXactIdExpand((MultiXactId) xmax, add_to_xmax,
    5404              :                                      new_status);
    5405        75546 :         GetMultiXactIdHintBits(new_xmax, &new_infomask, &new_infomask2);
    5406              :     }
    5407       105642 :     else if (old_infomask & HEAP_XMAX_COMMITTED)
    5408              :     {
    5409              :         /*
    5410              :          * It's a committed update, so we need to preserve him as updater of
    5411              :          * the tuple.
    5412              :          */
    5413              :         MultiXactStatus status;
    5414              :         MultiXactStatus new_status;
    5415              : 
    5416           13 :         if (old_infomask2 & HEAP_KEYS_UPDATED)
    5417            0 :             status = MultiXactStatusUpdate;
    5418              :         else
    5419           13 :             status = MultiXactStatusNoKeyUpdate;
    5420              : 
    5421           13 :         new_status = get_mxact_status_for_lock(mode, is_update);
    5422              : 
    5423              :         /*
    5424              :          * since it's not running, it's obviously impossible for the old
    5425              :          * updater to be identical to the current one, so we need not check
    5426              :          * for that case as we do in the block above.
    5427              :          */
    5428           13 :         new_xmax = MultiXactIdCreate(xmax, status, add_to_xmax, new_status);
    5429           13 :         GetMultiXactIdHintBits(new_xmax, &new_infomask, &new_infomask2);
    5430              :     }
    5431       105629 :     else if (TransactionIdIsInProgress(xmax))
    5432              :     {
    5433              :         /*
    5434              :          * If the XMAX is a valid, in-progress TransactionId, then we need to
    5435              :          * create a new MultiXactId that includes both the old locker or
    5436              :          * updater and our own TransactionId.
    5437              :          */
    5438              :         MultiXactStatus new_status;
    5439              :         MultiXactStatus old_status;
    5440              :         LockTupleMode old_mode;
    5441              : 
    5442       105614 :         if (HEAP_XMAX_IS_LOCKED_ONLY(old_infomask))
    5443              :         {
    5444       105586 :             if (HEAP_XMAX_IS_KEYSHR_LOCKED(old_infomask))
    5445         5725 :                 old_status = MultiXactStatusForKeyShare;
    5446        99861 :             else if (HEAP_XMAX_IS_SHR_LOCKED(old_infomask))
    5447          471 :                 old_status = MultiXactStatusForShare;
    5448        99390 :             else if (HEAP_XMAX_IS_EXCL_LOCKED(old_infomask))
    5449              :             {
    5450        99390 :                 if (old_infomask2 & HEAP_KEYS_UPDATED)
    5451        92885 :                     old_status = MultiXactStatusForUpdate;
    5452              :                 else
    5453         6505 :                     old_status = MultiXactStatusForNoKeyUpdate;
    5454              :             }
    5455              :             else
    5456              :             {
    5457              :                 /*
    5458              :                  * LOCK_ONLY can be present alone only when a page has been
    5459              :                  * upgraded by pg_upgrade.  But in that case,
    5460              :                  * TransactionIdIsInProgress() should have returned false.  We
    5461              :                  * assume it's no longer locked in this case.
    5462              :                  */
    5463            0 :                 elog(WARNING, "LOCK_ONLY found for Xid in progress %u", xmax);
    5464            0 :                 old_infomask |= HEAP_XMAX_INVALID;
    5465            0 :                 old_infomask &= ~HEAP_XMAX_LOCK_ONLY;
    5466            0 :                 goto l5;
    5467              :             }
    5468              :         }
    5469              :         else
    5470              :         {
    5471              :             /* it's an update, but which kind? */
    5472           28 :             if (old_infomask2 & HEAP_KEYS_UPDATED)
    5473            0 :                 old_status = MultiXactStatusUpdate;
    5474              :             else
    5475           28 :                 old_status = MultiXactStatusNoKeyUpdate;
    5476              :         }
    5477              : 
    5478       105614 :         old_mode = TUPLOCK_from_mxstatus(old_status);
    5479              : 
    5480              :         /*
    5481              :          * If the lock to be acquired is for the same TransactionId as the
    5482              :          * existing lock, there's an optimization possible: consider only the
    5483              :          * strongest of both locks as the only one present, and restart.
    5484              :          */
    5485       105614 :         if (xmax == add_to_xmax)
    5486              :         {
    5487              :             /*
    5488              :              * Note that it's not possible for the original tuple to be
    5489              :              * updated: we wouldn't be here because the tuple would have been
    5490              :              * invisible and we wouldn't try to update it.  As a subtlety,
    5491              :              * this code can also run when traversing an update chain to lock
    5492              :              * future versions of a tuple.  But we wouldn't be here either,
    5493              :              * because the add_to_xmax would be different from the original
    5494              :              * updater.
    5495              :              */
    5496              :             Assert(HEAP_XMAX_IS_LOCKED_ONLY(old_infomask));
    5497              : 
    5498              :             /* acquire the strongest of both */
    5499       104464 :             if (mode < old_mode)
    5500        52191 :                 mode = old_mode;
    5501              :             /* mustn't touch is_update */
    5502              : 
    5503       104464 :             old_infomask |= HEAP_XMAX_INVALID;
    5504       104464 :             goto l5;
    5505              :         }
    5506              : 
    5507              :         /* otherwise, just fall back to creating a new multixact */
    5508         1150 :         new_status = get_mxact_status_for_lock(mode, is_update);
    5509         1150 :         new_xmax = MultiXactIdCreate(xmax, old_status,
    5510              :                                      add_to_xmax, new_status);
    5511         1150 :         GetMultiXactIdHintBits(new_xmax, &new_infomask, &new_infomask2);
    5512              :     }
    5513           20 :     else if (!HEAP_XMAX_IS_LOCKED_ONLY(old_infomask) &&
    5514            5 :              TransactionIdDidCommit(xmax))
    5515            1 :     {
    5516              :         /*
    5517              :          * It's a committed update, so we gotta preserve him as updater of the
    5518              :          * tuple.
    5519              :          */
    5520              :         MultiXactStatus status;
    5521              :         MultiXactStatus new_status;
    5522              : 
    5523            1 :         if (old_infomask2 & HEAP_KEYS_UPDATED)
    5524            0 :             status = MultiXactStatusUpdate;
    5525              :         else
    5526            1 :             status = MultiXactStatusNoKeyUpdate;
    5527              : 
    5528            1 :         new_status = get_mxact_status_for_lock(mode, is_update);
    5529              : 
    5530              :         /*
    5531              :          * since it's not running, it's obviously impossible for the old
    5532              :          * updater to be identical to the current one, so we need not check
    5533              :          * for that case as we do in the block above.
    5534              :          */
    5535            1 :         new_xmax = MultiXactIdCreate(xmax, status, add_to_xmax, new_status);
    5536            1 :         GetMultiXactIdHintBits(new_xmax, &new_infomask, &new_infomask2);
    5537              :     }
    5538              :     else
    5539              :     {
    5540              :         /*
    5541              :          * Can get here iff the locking/updating transaction was running when
    5542              :          * the infomask was extracted from the tuple, but finished before
    5543              :          * TransactionIdIsInProgress got to run.  Deal with it as if there was
    5544              :          * no locker at all in the first place.
    5545              :          */
    5546           14 :         old_infomask |= HEAP_XMAX_INVALID;
    5547           14 :         goto l5;
    5548              :     }
    5549              : 
    5550      6659304 :     *result_infomask = new_infomask;
    5551      6659304 :     *result_infomask2 = new_infomask2;
    5552      6659304 :     *result_xmax = new_xmax;
    5553      6659304 : }
    5554              : 
    5555              : /*
    5556              :  * Subroutine for heap_lock_updated_tuple_rec.
    5557              :  *
    5558              :  * Given a hypothetical multixact status held by the transaction identified
    5559              :  * with the given xid, does the current transaction need to wait, fail, or can
    5560              :  * it continue if it wanted to acquire a lock of the given mode?  "needwait"
    5561              :  * is set to true if waiting is necessary; if it can continue, then TM_Ok is
    5562              :  * returned.  If the lock is already held by the current transaction, return
    5563              :  * TM_SelfModified.  In case of a conflict with another transaction, a
    5564              :  * different HeapTupleSatisfiesUpdate return code is returned.
    5565              :  *
    5566              :  * The held status is said to be hypothetical because it might correspond to a
    5567              :  * lock held by a single Xid, i.e. not a real MultiXactId; we express it this
    5568              :  * way for simplicity of API.
    5569              :  */
    5570              : static TM_Result
    5571        38781 : test_lockmode_for_conflict(MultiXactStatus status, TransactionId xid,
    5572              :                            LockTupleMode mode, HeapTuple tup,
    5573              :                            bool *needwait)
    5574              : {
    5575              :     MultiXactStatus wantedstatus;
    5576              : 
    5577        38781 :     *needwait = false;
    5578        38781 :     wantedstatus = get_mxact_status_for_lock(mode, false);
    5579              : 
    5580              :     /*
    5581              :      * Note: we *must* check TransactionIdIsInProgress before
    5582              :      * TransactionIdDidAbort/Commit; see comment at top of heapam_visibility.c
    5583              :      * for an explanation.
    5584              :      */
    5585        38781 :     if (TransactionIdIsCurrentTransactionId(xid))
    5586              :     {
    5587              :         /*
    5588              :          * The tuple has already been locked by our own transaction.  This is
    5589              :          * very rare but can happen if multiple transactions are trying to
    5590              :          * lock an ancient version of the same tuple.
    5591              :          */
    5592            0 :         return TM_SelfModified;
    5593              :     }
    5594        38781 :     else if (TransactionIdIsInProgress(xid))
    5595              :     {
    5596              :         /*
    5597              :          * If the locking transaction is running, what we do depends on
    5598              :          * whether the lock modes conflict: if they do, then we must wait for
    5599              :          * it to finish; otherwise we can fall through to lock this tuple
    5600              :          * version without waiting.
    5601              :          */
    5602        36539 :         if (DoLockModesConflict(LOCKMODE_from_mxstatus(status),
    5603        36539 :                                 LOCKMODE_from_mxstatus(wantedstatus)))
    5604              :         {
    5605            8 :             *needwait = true;
    5606              :         }
    5607              : 
    5608              :         /*
    5609              :          * If we set needwait above, then this value doesn't matter;
    5610              :          * otherwise, this value signals to caller that it's okay to proceed.
    5611              :          */
    5612        36539 :         return TM_Ok;
    5613              :     }
    5614         2242 :     else if (TransactionIdDidAbort(xid))
    5615          206 :         return TM_Ok;
    5616         2036 :     else if (TransactionIdDidCommit(xid))
    5617              :     {
    5618              :         /*
    5619              :          * The other transaction committed.  If it was only a locker, then the
    5620              :          * lock is completely gone now and we can return success; but if it
    5621              :          * was an update, then what we do depends on whether the two lock
    5622              :          * modes conflict.  If they conflict, then we must report error to
    5623              :          * caller. But if they don't, we can fall through to allow the current
    5624              :          * transaction to lock the tuple.
    5625              :          *
    5626              :          * Note: the reason we worry about ISUPDATE here is because as soon as
    5627              :          * a transaction ends, all its locks are gone and meaningless, and
    5628              :          * thus we can ignore them; whereas its updates persist.  In the
    5629              :          * TransactionIdIsInProgress case, above, we don't need to check
    5630              :          * because we know the lock is still "alive" and thus a conflict needs
    5631              :          * always be checked.
    5632              :          */
    5633         2036 :         if (!ISUPDATE_from_mxstatus(status))
    5634         2026 :             return TM_Ok;
    5635              : 
    5636           10 :         if (DoLockModesConflict(LOCKMODE_from_mxstatus(status),
    5637           10 :                                 LOCKMODE_from_mxstatus(wantedstatus)))
    5638              :         {
    5639              :             /* bummer */
    5640            9 :             if (!ItemPointerEquals(&tup->t_self, &tup->t_data->t_ctid))
    5641            7 :                 return TM_Updated;
    5642              :             else
    5643            2 :                 return TM_Deleted;
    5644              :         }
    5645              : 
    5646            1 :         return TM_Ok;
    5647              :     }
    5648              : 
    5649              :     /* Not in progress, not aborted, not committed -- must have crashed */
    5650            0 :     return TM_Ok;
    5651              : }
    5652              : 
    5653              : 
    5654              : /*
    5655              :  * Recursive part of heap_lock_updated_tuple
    5656              :  *
    5657              :  * Fetch the tuple pointed to by tid in rel, and mark it as locked by the given
    5658              :  * xid with the given mode; if this tuple is updated, recurse to lock the new
    5659              :  * version as well.
    5660              :  */
    5661              : static TM_Result
    5662         2224 : heap_lock_updated_tuple_rec(Relation rel, TransactionId priorXmax,
    5663              :                             const ItemPointerData *tid, TransactionId xid,
    5664              :                             LockTupleMode mode)
    5665              : {
    5666              :     TM_Result   result;
    5667              :     ItemPointerData tupid;
    5668              :     HeapTupleData mytup;
    5669              :     Buffer      buf;
    5670              :     uint16      new_infomask,
    5671              :                 new_infomask2,
    5672              :                 old_infomask,
    5673              :                 old_infomask2;
    5674              :     TransactionId xmax,
    5675              :                 new_xmax;
    5676         2224 :     bool        cleared_all_frozen = false;
    5677              :     bool        pinned_desired_page;
    5678         2224 :     Buffer      vmbuffer = InvalidBuffer;
    5679              :     BlockNumber block;
    5680              : 
    5681         2224 :     ItemPointerCopy(tid, &tupid);
    5682              : 
    5683              :     for (;;)
    5684              :     {
    5685         2227 :         new_infomask = 0;
    5686         2227 :         new_xmax = InvalidTransactionId;
    5687         2227 :         block = ItemPointerGetBlockNumber(&tupid);
    5688         2227 :         ItemPointerCopy(&tupid, &(mytup.t_self));
    5689              : 
    5690         2227 :         if (!heap_fetch(rel, SnapshotAny, &mytup, &buf, false))
    5691              :         {
    5692              :             /*
    5693              :              * if we fail to find the updated version of the tuple, it's
    5694              :              * because it was vacuumed/pruned away after its creator
    5695              :              * transaction aborted.  So behave as if we got to the end of the
    5696              :              * chain, and there's no further tuple to lock: return success to
    5697              :              * caller.
    5698              :              */
    5699            0 :             result = TM_Ok;
    5700            0 :             goto out_unlocked;
    5701              :         }
    5702              : 
    5703         2227 : l4:
    5704         2235 :         CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS();
    5705              : 
    5706              :         /*
    5707              :          * Before locking the buffer, pin the visibility map page if it
    5708              :          * appears to be necessary.  Since we haven't got the lock yet,
    5709              :          * someone else might be in the middle of changing this, so we'll need
    5710              :          * to recheck after we have the lock.
    5711              :          */
    5712         2235 :         if (PageIsAllVisible(BufferGetPage(buf)))
    5713              :         {
    5714            0 :             visibilitymap_pin(rel, block, &vmbuffer);
    5715            0 :             pinned_desired_page = true;
    5716              :         }
    5717              :         else
    5718         2235 :             pinned_desired_page = false;
    5719              : 
    5720         2235 :         LockBuffer(buf, BUFFER_LOCK_EXCLUSIVE);
    5721              : 
    5722              :         /*
    5723              :          * If we didn't pin the visibility map page and the page has become
    5724              :          * all visible while we were busy locking the buffer, we'll have to
    5725              :          * unlock and re-lock, to avoid holding the buffer lock across I/O.
    5726              :          * That's a bit unfortunate, but hopefully shouldn't happen often.
    5727              :          *
    5728              :          * Note: in some paths through this function, we will reach here
    5729              :          * holding a pin on a vm page that may or may not be the one matching
    5730              :          * this page.  If this page isn't all-visible, we won't use the vm
    5731              :          * page, but we hold onto such a pin till the end of the function.
    5732              :          */
    5733         2235 :         if (!pinned_desired_page && PageIsAllVisible(BufferGetPage(buf)))
    5734              :         {
    5735            0 :             LockBuffer(buf, BUFFER_LOCK_UNLOCK);
    5736            0 :             visibilitymap_pin(rel, block, &vmbuffer);
    5737            0 :             LockBuffer(buf, BUFFER_LOCK_EXCLUSIVE);
    5738              :         }
    5739              : 
    5740              :         /*
    5741              :          * Check the tuple XMIN against prior XMAX, if any.  If we reached the
    5742              :          * end of the chain, we're done, so return success.
    5743              :          */
    5744         4470 :         if (TransactionIdIsValid(priorXmax) &&
    5745         2235 :             !TransactionIdEquals(HeapTupleHeaderGetXmin(mytup.t_data),
    5746              :                                  priorXmax))
    5747              :         {
    5748            2 :             result = TM_Ok;
    5749            2 :             goto out_locked;
    5750              :         }
    5751              : 
    5752              :         /*
    5753              :          * Also check Xmin: if this tuple was created by an aborted
    5754              :          * (sub)transaction, then we already locked the last live one in the
    5755              :          * chain, thus we're done, so return success.
    5756              :          */
    5757         2233 :         if (TransactionIdDidAbort(HeapTupleHeaderGetXmin(mytup.t_data)))
    5758              :         {
    5759           25 :             result = TM_Ok;
    5760           25 :             goto out_locked;
    5761              :         }
    5762              : 
    5763         2208 :         old_infomask = mytup.t_data->t_infomask;
    5764         2208 :         old_infomask2 = mytup.t_data->t_infomask2;
    5765         2208 :         xmax = HeapTupleHeaderGetRawXmax(mytup.t_data);
    5766              : 
    5767              :         /*
    5768              :          * If this tuple version has been updated or locked by some concurrent
    5769              :          * transaction(s), what we do depends on whether our lock mode
    5770              :          * conflicts with what those other transactions hold, and also on the
    5771              :          * status of them.
    5772              :          */
    5773         2208 :         if (!(old_infomask & HEAP_XMAX_INVALID))
    5774              :         {
    5775              :             TransactionId rawxmax;
    5776              :             bool        needwait;
    5777              : 
    5778         2145 :             rawxmax = HeapTupleHeaderGetRawXmax(mytup.t_data);
    5779         2145 :             if (old_infomask & HEAP_XMAX_IS_MULTI)
    5780              :             {
    5781              :                 int         nmembers;
    5782              :                 int         i;
    5783              :                 MultiXactMember *members;
    5784              : 
    5785              :                 /*
    5786              :                  * We don't need a test for pg_upgrade'd tuples: this is only
    5787              :                  * applied to tuples after the first in an update chain.  Said
    5788              :                  * first tuple in the chain may well be locked-in-9.2-and-
    5789              :                  * pg_upgraded, but that one was already locked by our caller,
    5790              :                  * not us; and any subsequent ones cannot be because our
    5791              :                  * caller must necessarily have obtained a snapshot later than
    5792              :                  * the pg_upgrade itself.
    5793              :                  */
    5794              :                 Assert(!HEAP_LOCKED_UPGRADED(mytup.t_data->t_infomask));
    5795              : 
    5796         2109 :                 nmembers = GetMultiXactIdMembers(rawxmax, &members, false,
    5797         2109 :                                                  HEAP_XMAX_IS_LOCKED_ONLY(old_infomask));
    5798        40854 :                 for (i = 0; i < nmembers; i++)
    5799              :                 {
    5800        38745 :                     result = test_lockmode_for_conflict(members[i].status,
    5801        38745 :                                                         members[i].xid,
    5802              :                                                         mode,
    5803              :                                                         &mytup,
    5804              :                                                         &needwait);
    5805              : 
    5806              :                     /*
    5807              :                      * If the tuple was already locked by ourselves in a
    5808              :                      * previous iteration of this (say heap_lock_tuple was
    5809              :                      * forced to restart the locking loop because of a change
    5810              :                      * in xmax), then we hold the lock already on this tuple
    5811              :                      * version and we don't need to do anything; and this is
    5812              :                      * not an error condition either.  We just need to skip
    5813              :                      * this tuple and continue locking the next version in the
    5814              :                      * update chain.
    5815              :                      */
    5816        38745 :                     if (result == TM_SelfModified)
    5817              :                     {
    5818            0 :                         pfree(members);
    5819            0 :                         goto next;
    5820              :                     }
    5821              : 
    5822        38745 :                     if (needwait)
    5823              :                     {
    5824            0 :                         LockBuffer(buf, BUFFER_LOCK_UNLOCK);
    5825            0 :                         XactLockTableWait(members[i].xid, rel,
    5826              :                                           &mytup.t_self,
    5827              :                                           XLTW_LockUpdated);
    5828            0 :                         pfree(members);
    5829            0 :                         goto l4;
    5830              :                     }
    5831        38745 :                     if (result != TM_Ok)
    5832              :                     {
    5833            0 :                         pfree(members);
    5834            0 :                         goto out_locked;
    5835              :                     }
    5836              :                 }
    5837         2109 :                 if (members)
    5838         2109 :                     pfree(members);
    5839              :             }
    5840              :             else
    5841              :             {
    5842              :                 MultiXactStatus status;
    5843              : 
    5844              :                 /*
    5845              :                  * For a non-multi Xmax, we first need to compute the
    5846              :                  * corresponding MultiXactStatus by using the infomask bits.
    5847              :                  */
    5848           36 :                 if (HEAP_XMAX_IS_LOCKED_ONLY(old_infomask))
    5849              :                 {
    5850           16 :                     if (HEAP_XMAX_IS_KEYSHR_LOCKED(old_infomask))
    5851           16 :                         status = MultiXactStatusForKeyShare;
    5852            0 :                     else if (HEAP_XMAX_IS_SHR_LOCKED(old_infomask))
    5853            0 :                         status = MultiXactStatusForShare;
    5854            0 :                     else if (HEAP_XMAX_IS_EXCL_LOCKED(old_infomask))
    5855              :                     {
    5856            0 :                         if (old_infomask2 & HEAP_KEYS_UPDATED)
    5857            0 :                             status = MultiXactStatusForUpdate;
    5858              :                         else
    5859            0 :                             status = MultiXactStatusForNoKeyUpdate;
    5860              :                     }
    5861              :                     else
    5862              :                     {
    5863              :                         /*
    5864              :                          * LOCK_ONLY present alone (a pg_upgraded tuple marked
    5865              :                          * as share-locked in the old cluster) shouldn't be
    5866              :                          * seen in the middle of an update chain.
    5867              :                          */
    5868            0 :                         elog(ERROR, "invalid lock status in tuple");
    5869              :                     }
    5870              :                 }
    5871              :                 else
    5872              :                 {
    5873              :                     /* it's an update, but which kind? */
    5874           20 :                     if (old_infomask2 & HEAP_KEYS_UPDATED)
    5875           15 :                         status = MultiXactStatusUpdate;
    5876              :                     else
    5877            5 :                         status = MultiXactStatusNoKeyUpdate;
    5878              :                 }
    5879              : 
    5880           36 :                 result = test_lockmode_for_conflict(status, rawxmax, mode,
    5881              :                                                     &mytup, &needwait);
    5882              : 
    5883              :                 /*
    5884              :                  * If the tuple was already locked by ourselves in a previous
    5885              :                  * iteration of this (say heap_lock_tuple was forced to
    5886              :                  * restart the locking loop because of a change in xmax), then
    5887              :                  * we hold the lock already on this tuple version and we don't
    5888              :                  * need to do anything; and this is not an error condition
    5889              :                  * either.  We just need to skip this tuple and continue
    5890              :                  * locking the next version in the update chain.
    5891              :                  */
    5892           36 :                 if (result == TM_SelfModified)
    5893            0 :                     goto next;
    5894              : 
    5895           36 :                 if (needwait)
    5896              :                 {
    5897            8 :                     LockBuffer(buf, BUFFER_LOCK_UNLOCK);
    5898            8 :                     XactLockTableWait(rawxmax, rel, &mytup.t_self,
    5899              :                                       XLTW_LockUpdated);
    5900            8 :                     goto l4;
    5901              :                 }
    5902           28 :                 if (result != TM_Ok)
    5903              :                 {
    5904            9 :                     goto out_locked;
    5905              :                 }
    5906              :             }
    5907              :         }
    5908              : 
    5909              :         /* compute the new Xmax and infomask values for the tuple ... */
    5910         2191 :         compute_new_xmax_infomask(xmax, old_infomask, mytup.t_data->t_infomask2,
    5911              :                                   xid, mode, false,
    5912              :                                   &new_xmax, &new_infomask, &new_infomask2);
    5913              : 
    5914         2191 :         if (PageIsAllVisible(BufferGetPage(buf)) &&
    5915            0 :             visibilitymap_clear(rel, block, vmbuffer,
    5916              :                                 VISIBILITYMAP_ALL_FROZEN))
    5917            0 :             cleared_all_frozen = true;
    5918              : 
    5919         2191 :         START_CRIT_SECTION();
    5920              : 
    5921              :         /* ... and set them */
    5922         2191 :         HeapTupleHeaderSetXmax(mytup.t_data, new_xmax);
    5923         2191 :         mytup.t_data->t_infomask &= ~HEAP_XMAX_BITS;
    5924         2191 :         mytup.t_data->t_infomask2 &= ~HEAP_KEYS_UPDATED;
    5925         2191 :         mytup.t_data->t_infomask |= new_infomask;
    5926         2191 :         mytup.t_data->t_infomask2 |= new_infomask2;
    5927              : 
    5928         2191 :         MarkBufferDirty(buf);
    5929              : 
    5930              :         /* XLOG stuff */
    5931         2191 :         if (RelationNeedsWAL(rel))
    5932              :         {
    5933              :             xl_heap_lock_updated xlrec;
    5934              :             XLogRecPtr  recptr;
    5935         2191 :             Page        page = BufferGetPage(buf);
    5936              : 
    5937         2191 :             XLogBeginInsert();
    5938         2191 :             XLogRegisterBuffer(0, buf, REGBUF_STANDARD);
    5939              : 
    5940         2191 :             xlrec.offnum = ItemPointerGetOffsetNumber(&mytup.t_self);
    5941         2191 :             xlrec.xmax = new_xmax;
    5942         2191 :             xlrec.infobits_set = compute_infobits(new_infomask, new_infomask2);
    5943         2191 :             xlrec.flags =
    5944         2191 :                 cleared_all_frozen ? XLH_LOCK_ALL_FROZEN_CLEARED : 0;
    5945              : 
    5946         2191 :             XLogRegisterData(&xlrec, SizeOfHeapLockUpdated);
    5947              : 
    5948         2191 :             recptr = XLogInsert(RM_HEAP2_ID, XLOG_HEAP2_LOCK_UPDATED);
    5949              : 
    5950         2191 :             PageSetLSN(page, recptr);
    5951              :         }
    5952              : 
    5953         2191 :         END_CRIT_SECTION();
    5954              : 
    5955         2191 : next:
    5956              :         /* if we find the end of update chain, we're done. */
    5957         4382 :         if (mytup.t_data->t_infomask & HEAP_XMAX_INVALID ||
    5958         4382 :             HeapTupleHeaderIndicatesMovedPartitions(mytup.t_data) ||
    5959         2195 :             ItemPointerEquals(&mytup.t_self, &mytup.t_data->t_ctid) ||
    5960            4 :             HeapTupleHeaderIsOnlyLocked(mytup.t_data))
    5961              :         {
    5962         2188 :             result = TM_Ok;
    5963         2188 :             goto out_locked;
    5964              :         }
    5965              : 
    5966              :         /* tail recursion */
    5967            3 :         priorXmax = HeapTupleHeaderGetUpdateXid(mytup.t_data);
    5968            3 :         ItemPointerCopy(&(mytup.t_data->t_ctid), &tupid);
    5969            3 :         UnlockReleaseBuffer(buf);
    5970              :     }
    5971              : 
    5972              :     result = TM_Ok;
    5973              : 
    5974         2224 : out_locked:
    5975         2224 :     UnlockReleaseBuffer(buf);
    5976              : 
    5977         2224 : out_unlocked:
    5978         2224 :     if (vmbuffer != InvalidBuffer)
    5979            0 :         ReleaseBuffer(vmbuffer);
    5980              : 
    5981         2224 :     return result;
    5982              : }
    5983              : 
    5984              : /*
    5985              :  * heap_lock_updated_tuple
    5986              :  *      Follow update chain when locking an updated tuple, acquiring locks (row
    5987              :  *      marks) on the updated versions.
    5988              :  *
    5989              :  * 'prior_infomask', 'prior_raw_xmax' and 'prior_ctid' are the corresponding
    5990              :  * fields from the initial tuple.  We will lock the tuples starting from the
    5991              :  * one that 'prior_ctid' points to.  Note: This function does not lock the
    5992              :  * initial tuple itself.
    5993              :  *
    5994              :  * This function doesn't check visibility, it just unconditionally marks the
    5995              :  * tuple(s) as locked.  If any tuple in the updated chain is being deleted
    5996              :  * concurrently (or updated with the key being modified), sleep until the
    5997              :  * transaction doing it is finished.
    5998              :  *
    5999              :  * Note that we don't acquire heavyweight tuple locks on the tuples we walk
    6000              :  * when we have to wait for other transactions to release them, as opposed to
    6001              :  * what heap_lock_tuple does.  The reason is that having more than one
    6002              :  * transaction walking the chain is probably uncommon enough that risk of
    6003              :  * starvation is not likely: one of the preconditions for being here is that
    6004              :  * the snapshot in use predates the update that created this tuple (because we
    6005              :  * started at an earlier version of the tuple), but at the same time such a
    6006              :  * transaction cannot be using repeatable read or serializable isolation
    6007              :  * levels, because that would lead to a serializability failure.
    6008              :  */
    6009              : static TM_Result
    6010         2226 : heap_lock_updated_tuple(Relation rel,
    6011              :                         uint16 prior_infomask,
    6012              :                         TransactionId prior_raw_xmax,
    6013              :                         const ItemPointerData *prior_ctid,
    6014              :                         TransactionId xid, LockTupleMode mode)
    6015              : {
    6016         2226 :     INJECTION_POINT("heap_lock_updated_tuple", NULL);
    6017              : 
    6018              :     /*
    6019              :      * If the tuple has moved into another partition (effectively a delete)
    6020              :      * stop here.
    6021              :      */
    6022         2226 :     if (!ItemPointerIndicatesMovedPartitions(prior_ctid))
    6023              :     {
    6024              :         TransactionId prior_xmax;
    6025              : 
    6026              :         /*
    6027              :          * If this is the first possibly-multixact-able operation in the
    6028              :          * current transaction, set my per-backend OldestMemberMXactId
    6029              :          * setting. We can be certain that the transaction will never become a
    6030              :          * member of any older MultiXactIds than that.  (We have to do this
    6031              :          * even if we end up just using our own TransactionId below, since
    6032              :          * some other backend could incorporate our XID into a MultiXact
    6033              :          * immediately afterwards.)
    6034              :          */
    6035         2224 :         MultiXactIdSetOldestMember();
    6036              : 
    6037         4448 :         prior_xmax = (prior_infomask & HEAP_XMAX_IS_MULTI) ?
    6038         2224 :             MultiXactIdGetUpdateXid(prior_raw_xmax, prior_infomask) : prior_raw_xmax;
    6039         2224 :         return heap_lock_updated_tuple_rec(rel, prior_xmax, prior_ctid, xid, mode);
    6040              :     }
    6041              : 
    6042              :     /* nothing to lock */
    6043            2 :     return TM_Ok;
    6044              : }
    6045              : 
    6046              : /*
    6047              :  *  heap_finish_speculative - mark speculative insertion as successful
    6048              :  *
    6049              :  * To successfully finish a speculative insertion we have to clear speculative
    6050              :  * token from tuple.  To do so the t_ctid field, which will contain a
    6051              :  * speculative token value, is modified in place to point to the tuple itself,
    6052              :  * which is characteristic of a newly inserted ordinary tuple.
    6053              :  *
    6054              :  * NB: It is not ok to commit without either finishing or aborting a
    6055              :  * speculative insertion.  We could treat speculative tuples of committed
    6056              :  * transactions implicitly as completed, but then we would have to be prepared
    6057              :  * to deal with speculative tokens on committed tuples.  That wouldn't be
    6058              :  * difficult - no-one looks at the ctid field of a tuple with invalid xmax -
    6059              :  * but clearing the token at completion isn't very expensive either.
    6060              :  * An explicit confirmation WAL record also makes logical decoding simpler.
    6061              :  */
    6062              : void
    6063         2215 : heap_finish_speculative(Relation relation, const ItemPointerData *tid)
    6064              : {
    6065              :     Buffer      buffer;
    6066              :     Page        page;
    6067              :     OffsetNumber offnum;
    6068              :     ItemId      lp;
    6069              :     HeapTupleHeader htup;
    6070              : 
    6071         2215 :     buffer = ReadBuffer(relation, ItemPointerGetBlockNumber(tid));
    6072         2215 :     LockBuffer(buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_EXCLUSIVE);
    6073         2215 :     page = BufferGetPage(buffer);
    6074              : 
    6075         2215 :     offnum = ItemPointerGetOffsetNumber(tid);
    6076         2215 :     if (offnum < 1 || offnum > PageGetMaxOffsetNumber(page))
    6077            0 :         elog(ERROR, "offnum out of range");
    6078         2215 :     lp = PageGetItemId(page, offnum);
    6079         2215 :     if (!ItemIdIsNormal(lp))
    6080            0 :         elog(ERROR, "invalid lp");
    6081              : 
    6082         2215 :     htup = (HeapTupleHeader) PageGetItem(page, lp);
    6083              : 
    6084              :     /* NO EREPORT(ERROR) from here till changes are logged */
    6085         2215 :     START_CRIT_SECTION();
    6086              : 
    6087              :     Assert(HeapTupleHeaderIsSpeculative(htup));
    6088              : 
    6089         2215 :     MarkBufferDirty(buffer);
    6090              : 
    6091              :     /*
    6092              :      * Replace the speculative insertion token with a real t_ctid, pointing to
    6093              :      * itself like it does on regular tuples.
    6094              :      */
    6095         2215 :     htup->t_ctid = *tid;
    6096              : 
    6097              :     /* XLOG stuff */
    6098         2215 :     if (RelationNeedsWAL(relation))
    6099              :     {
    6100              :         xl_heap_confirm xlrec;
    6101              :         XLogRecPtr  recptr;
    6102              : 
    6103         2195 :         xlrec.offnum = ItemPointerGetOffsetNumber(tid);
    6104              : 
    6105         2195 :         XLogBeginInsert();
    6106              : 
    6107              :         /* We want the same filtering on this as on a plain insert */
    6108         2195 :         XLogSetRecordFlags(XLOG_INCLUDE_ORIGIN);
    6109              : 
    6110         2195 :         XLogRegisterData(&xlrec, SizeOfHeapConfirm);
    6111         2195 :         XLogRegisterBuffer(0, buffer, REGBUF_STANDARD);
    6112              : 
    6113         2195 :         recptr = XLogInsert(RM_HEAP_ID, XLOG_HEAP_CONFIRM);
    6114              : 
    6115         2195 :         PageSetLSN(page, recptr);
    6116              :     }
    6117              : 
    6118         2215 :     END_CRIT_SECTION();
    6119              : 
    6120         2215 :     UnlockReleaseBuffer(buffer);
    6121         2215 : }
    6122              : 
    6123              : /*
    6124              :  *  heap_abort_speculative - kill a speculatively inserted tuple
    6125              :  *
    6126              :  * Marks a tuple that was speculatively inserted in the same command as dead,
    6127              :  * by setting its xmin as invalid.  That makes it immediately appear as dead
    6128              :  * to all transactions, including our own.  In particular, it makes
    6129              :  * HeapTupleSatisfiesDirty() regard the tuple as dead, so that another backend
    6130              :  * inserting a duplicate key value won't unnecessarily wait for our whole
    6131              :  * transaction to finish (it'll just wait for our speculative insertion to
    6132              :  * finish).
    6133              :  *
    6134              :  * Killing the tuple prevents "unprincipled deadlocks", which are deadlocks
    6135              :  * that arise due to a mutual dependency that is not user visible.  By
    6136              :  * definition, unprincipled deadlocks cannot be prevented by the user
    6137              :  * reordering lock acquisition in client code, because the implementation level
    6138              :  * lock acquisitions are not under the user's direct control.  If speculative
    6139              :  * inserters did not take this precaution, then under high concurrency they
    6140              :  * could deadlock with each other, which would not be acceptable.
    6141              :  *
    6142              :  * This is somewhat redundant with heap_delete, but we prefer to have a
    6143              :  * dedicated routine with stripped down requirements.  Note that this is also
    6144              :  * used to delete the TOAST tuples created during speculative insertion.
    6145              :  *
    6146              :  * This routine does not affect logical decoding as it only looks at
    6147              :  * confirmation records.
    6148              :  */
    6149              : void
    6150           16 : heap_abort_speculative(Relation relation, const ItemPointerData *tid)
    6151              : {
    6152           16 :     TransactionId xid = GetCurrentTransactionId();
    6153              :     ItemId      lp;
    6154              :     HeapTupleData tp;
    6155              :     Page        page;
    6156              :     BlockNumber block;
    6157              :     Buffer      buffer;
    6158              : 
    6159              :     Assert(ItemPointerIsValid(tid));
    6160              : 
    6161           16 :     block = ItemPointerGetBlockNumber(tid);
    6162           16 :     buffer = ReadBuffer(relation, block);
    6163           16 :     page = BufferGetPage(buffer);
    6164              : 
    6165           16 :     LockBuffer(buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_EXCLUSIVE);
    6166              : 
    6167              :     /*
    6168              :      * Page can't be all visible, we just inserted into it, and are still
    6169              :      * running.
    6170              :      */
    6171              :     Assert(!PageIsAllVisible(page));
    6172              : 
    6173           16 :     lp = PageGetItemId(page, ItemPointerGetOffsetNumber(tid));
    6174              :     Assert(ItemIdIsNormal(lp));
    6175              : 
    6176           16 :     tp.t_tableOid = RelationGetRelid(relation);
    6177           16 :     tp.t_data = (HeapTupleHeader) PageGetItem(page, lp);
    6178           16 :     tp.t_len = ItemIdGetLength(lp);
    6179           16 :     tp.t_self = *tid;
    6180              : 
    6181              :     /*
    6182              :      * Sanity check that the tuple really is a speculatively inserted tuple,
    6183              :      * inserted by us.
    6184              :      */
    6185           16 :     if (tp.t_data->t_choice.t_heap.t_xmin != xid)
    6186            0 :         elog(ERROR, "attempted to kill a tuple inserted by another transaction");
    6187           16 :     if (!(IsToastRelation(relation) || HeapTupleHeaderIsSpeculative(tp.t_data)))
    6188            0 :         elog(ERROR, "attempted to kill a non-speculative tuple");
    6189              :     Assert(!HeapTupleHeaderIsHeapOnly(tp.t_data));
    6190              : 
    6191              :     /*
    6192              :      * No need to check for serializable conflicts here.  There is never a
    6193              :      * need for a combo CID, either.  No need to extract replica identity, or
    6194              :      * do anything special with infomask bits.
    6195              :      */
    6196              : 
    6197           16 :     START_CRIT_SECTION();
    6198              : 
    6199              :     /*
    6200              :      * The tuple will become DEAD immediately.  Flag that this page is a
    6201              :      * candidate for pruning by setting xmin to TransactionXmin. While not
    6202              :      * immediately prunable, it is the oldest xid we can cheaply determine
    6203              :      * that's safe against wraparound / being older than the table's
    6204              :      * relfrozenxid.  To defend against the unlikely case of a new relation
    6205              :      * having a newer relfrozenxid than our TransactionXmin, use relfrozenxid
    6206              :      * if so (vacuum can't subsequently move relfrozenxid to beyond
    6207              :      * TransactionXmin, so there's no race here).
    6208              :      */
    6209              :     Assert(TransactionIdIsValid(TransactionXmin));
    6210              :     {
    6211           16 :         TransactionId relfrozenxid = relation->rd_rel->relfrozenxid;
    6212              :         TransactionId prune_xid;
    6213              : 
    6214           16 :         if (TransactionIdPrecedes(TransactionXmin, relfrozenxid))
    6215            0 :             prune_xid = relfrozenxid;
    6216              :         else
    6217           16 :             prune_xid = TransactionXmin;
    6218           16 :         PageSetPrunable(page, prune_xid);
    6219              :     }
    6220              : 
    6221              :     /* store transaction information of xact deleting the tuple */
    6222           16 :     tp.t_data->t_infomask &= ~(HEAP_XMAX_BITS | HEAP_MOVED);
    6223           16 :     tp.t_data->t_infomask2 &= ~HEAP_KEYS_UPDATED;
    6224              : 
    6225              :     /*
    6226              :      * Set the tuple header xmin to InvalidTransactionId.  This makes the
    6227              :      * tuple immediately invisible everyone.  (In particular, to any
    6228              :      * transactions waiting on the speculative token, woken up later.)
    6229              :      */
    6230           16 :     HeapTupleHeaderSetXmin(tp.t_data, InvalidTransactionId);
    6231              : 
    6232              :     /* Clear the speculative insertion token too */
    6233           16 :     tp.t_data->t_ctid = tp.t_self;
    6234              : 
    6235           16 :     MarkBufferDirty(buffer);
    6236              : 
    6237              :     /*
    6238              :      * XLOG stuff
    6239              :      *
    6240              :      * The WAL records generated here match heap_delete().  The same recovery
    6241              :      * routines are used.
    6242              :      */
    6243           16 :     if (RelationNeedsWAL(relation))
    6244              :     {
    6245              :         xl_heap_delete xlrec;
    6246              :         XLogRecPtr  recptr;
    6247              : 
    6248           12 :         xlrec.flags = XLH_DELETE_IS_SUPER;
    6249           24 :         xlrec.infobits_set = compute_infobits(tp.t_data->t_infomask,
    6250           12 :                                               tp.t_data->t_infomask2);
    6251           12 :         xlrec.offnum = ItemPointerGetOffsetNumber(&tp.t_self);
    6252           12 :         xlrec.xmax = xid;
    6253              : 
    6254           12 :         XLogBeginInsert();
    6255           12 :         XLogRegisterData(&xlrec, SizeOfHeapDelete);
    6256           12 :         XLogRegisterBuffer(0, buffer, REGBUF_STANDARD);
    6257              : 
    6258              :         /* No replica identity & replication origin logged */
    6259              : 
    6260           12 :         recptr = XLogInsert(RM_HEAP_ID, XLOG_HEAP_DELETE);
    6261              : 
    6262           12 :         PageSetLSN(page, recptr);
    6263              :     }
    6264              : 
    6265           16 :     END_CRIT_SECTION();
    6266              : 
    6267           16 :     LockBuffer(buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_UNLOCK);
    6268              : 
    6269           16 :     if (HeapTupleHasExternal(&tp))
    6270              :     {
    6271              :         Assert(!IsToastRelation(relation));
    6272            1 :         heap_toast_delete(relation, &tp, true);
    6273              :     }
    6274              : 
    6275              :     /*
    6276              :      * Never need to mark tuple for invalidation, since catalogs don't support
    6277              :      * speculative insertion
    6278              :      */
    6279              : 
    6280              :     /* Now we can release the buffer */
    6281           16 :     ReleaseBuffer(buffer);
    6282              : 
    6283              :     /* count deletion, as we counted the insertion too */
    6284           16 :     pgstat_count_heap_delete(relation);
    6285           16 : }
    6286              : 
    6287              : /*
    6288              :  * heap_inplace_lock - protect inplace update from concurrent heap_update()
    6289              :  *
    6290              :  * Evaluate whether the tuple's state is compatible with a no-key update.
    6291              :  * Current transaction rowmarks are fine, as is KEY SHARE from any
    6292              :  * transaction.  If compatible, return true with the buffer exclusive-locked,
    6293              :  * and the caller must release that by calling
    6294              :  * heap_inplace_update_and_unlock(), calling heap_inplace_unlock(), or raising
    6295              :  * an error.  Otherwise, call release_callback(arg), wait for blocking
    6296              :  * transactions to end, and return false.
    6297              :  *
    6298              :  * Since this is intended for system catalogs and SERIALIZABLE doesn't cover
    6299              :  * DDL, this doesn't guarantee any particular predicate locking.
    6300              :  *
    6301              :  * heap_delete() is a rarer source of blocking transactions (xwait).  We'll
    6302              :  * wait for such a transaction just like for the normal heap_update() case.
    6303              :  * Normal concurrent DROP commands won't cause that, because all inplace
    6304              :  * updaters take some lock that conflicts with DROP.  An explicit SQL "DELETE
    6305              :  * FROM pg_class" can cause it.  By waiting, if the concurrent transaction
    6306              :  * executed both "DELETE FROM pg_class" and "INSERT INTO pg_class", our caller
    6307              :  * can find the successor tuple.
    6308              :  *
    6309              :  * Readers of inplace-updated fields expect changes to those fields are
    6310              :  * durable.  For example, vac_truncate_clog() reads datfrozenxid from
    6311              :  * pg_database tuples via catalog snapshots.  A future snapshot must not
    6312              :  * return a lower datfrozenxid for the same database OID (lower in the
    6313              :  * FullTransactionIdPrecedes() sense).  We achieve that since no update of a
    6314              :  * tuple can start while we hold a lock on its buffer.  In cases like
    6315              :  * BEGIN;GRANT;CREATE INDEX;COMMIT we're inplace-updating a tuple visible only
    6316              :  * to this transaction.  ROLLBACK then is one case where it's okay to lose
    6317              :  * inplace updates.  (Restoring relhasindex=false on ROLLBACK is fine, since
    6318              :  * any concurrent CREATE INDEX would have blocked, then inplace-updated the
    6319              :  * committed tuple.)
    6320              :  *
    6321              :  * In principle, we could avoid waiting by overwriting every tuple in the
    6322              :  * updated tuple chain.  Reader expectations permit updating a tuple only if
    6323              :  * it's aborted, is the tail of the chain, or we already updated the tuple
    6324              :  * referenced in its t_ctid.  Hence, we would need to overwrite the tuples in
    6325              :  * order from tail to head.  That would imply either (a) mutating all tuples
    6326              :  * in one critical section or (b) accepting a chance of partial completion.
    6327              :  * Partial completion of a relfrozenxid update would have the weird
    6328              :  * consequence that the table's next VACUUM could see the table's relfrozenxid
    6329              :  * move forward between vacuum_get_cutoffs() and finishing.
    6330              :  */
    6331              : bool
    6332       228804 : heap_inplace_lock(Relation relation,
    6333              :                   HeapTuple oldtup_ptr, Buffer buffer,
    6334              :                   void (*release_callback) (void *), void *arg)
    6335              : {
    6336       228804 :     HeapTupleData oldtup = *oldtup_ptr; /* minimize diff vs. heap_update() */
    6337              :     TM_Result   result;
    6338              :     bool        ret;
    6339              : 
    6340              : #ifdef USE_ASSERT_CHECKING
    6341              :     if (RelationGetRelid(relation) == RelationRelationId)
    6342              :         check_inplace_rel_lock(oldtup_ptr);
    6343              : #endif
    6344              : 
    6345              :     Assert(BufferIsValid(buffer));
    6346              : 
    6347              :     /*
    6348              :      * Register shared cache invals if necessary.  Other sessions may finish
    6349              :      * inplace updates of this tuple between this step and LockTuple().  Since
    6350              :      * inplace updates don't change cache keys, that's harmless.
    6351              :      *
    6352              :      * While it's tempting to register invals only after confirming we can
    6353              :      * return true, the following obstacle precludes reordering steps that
    6354              :      * way.  Registering invals might reach a CatalogCacheInitializeCache()
    6355              :      * that locks "buffer".  That would hang indefinitely if running after our
    6356              :      * own LockBuffer().  Hence, we must register invals before LockBuffer().
    6357              :      */
    6358       228804 :     CacheInvalidateHeapTupleInplace(relation, oldtup_ptr);
    6359              : 
    6360       228804 :     LockTuple(relation, &oldtup.t_self, InplaceUpdateTupleLock);
    6361       228804 :     LockBuffer(buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_EXCLUSIVE);
    6362              : 
    6363              :     /*----------
    6364              :      * Interpret HeapTupleSatisfiesUpdate() like heap_update() does, except:
    6365              :      *
    6366              :      * - wait unconditionally
    6367              :      * - already locked tuple above, since inplace needs that unconditionally
    6368              :      * - don't recheck header after wait: simpler to defer to next iteration
    6369              :      * - don't try to continue even if the updater aborts: likewise
    6370              :      * - no crosscheck
    6371              :      */
    6372       228804 :     result = HeapTupleSatisfiesUpdate(&oldtup, GetCurrentCommandId(false),
    6373              :                                       buffer);
    6374              : 
    6375       228804 :     if (result == TM_Invisible)
    6376              :     {
    6377              :         /* no known way this can happen */
    6378            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    6379              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    6380              :                  errmsg_internal("attempted to overwrite invisible tuple")));
    6381              :     }
    6382       228804 :     else if (result == TM_SelfModified)
    6383              :     {
    6384              :         /*
    6385              :          * CREATE INDEX might reach this if an expression is silly enough to
    6386              :          * call e.g. SELECT ... FROM pg_class FOR SHARE.  C code of other SQL
    6387              :          * statements might get here after a heap_update() of the same row, in
    6388              :          * the absence of an intervening CommandCounterIncrement().
    6389              :          */
    6390            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    6391              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    6392              :                  errmsg("tuple to be updated was already modified by an operation triggered by the current command")));
    6393              :     }
    6394       228804 :     else if (result == TM_BeingModified)
    6395              :     {
    6396              :         TransactionId xwait;
    6397              :         uint16      infomask;
    6398              : 
    6399           27 :         xwait = HeapTupleHeaderGetRawXmax(oldtup.t_data);
    6400           27 :         infomask = oldtup.t_data->t_infomask;
    6401              : 
    6402           27 :         if (infomask & HEAP_XMAX_IS_MULTI)
    6403              :         {
    6404            5 :             LockTupleMode lockmode = LockTupleNoKeyExclusive;
    6405            5 :             MultiXactStatus mxact_status = MultiXactStatusNoKeyUpdate;
    6406              :             int         remain;
    6407              : 
    6408            5 :             if (DoesMultiXactIdConflict((MultiXactId) xwait, infomask,
    6409              :                                         lockmode, NULL))
    6410              :             {
    6411            2 :                 LockBuffer(buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_UNLOCK);
    6412            2 :                 release_callback(arg);
    6413            2 :                 ret = false;
    6414            2 :                 MultiXactIdWait((MultiXactId) xwait, mxact_status, infomask,
    6415              :                                 relation, &oldtup.t_self, XLTW_Update,
    6416              :                                 &remain);
    6417              :             }
    6418              :             else
    6419            3 :                 ret = true;
    6420              :         }
    6421           22 :         else if (TransactionIdIsCurrentTransactionId(xwait))
    6422            1 :             ret = true;
    6423           21 :         else if (HEAP_XMAX_IS_KEYSHR_LOCKED(infomask))
    6424            1 :             ret = true;
    6425              :         else
    6426              :         {
    6427           20 :             LockBuffer(buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_UNLOCK);
    6428           20 :             release_callback(arg);
    6429           20 :             ret = false;
    6430           20 :             XactLockTableWait(xwait, relation, &oldtup.t_self,
    6431              :                               XLTW_Update);
    6432              :         }
    6433              :     }
    6434              :     else
    6435              :     {
    6436       228777 :         ret = (result == TM_Ok);
    6437       228777 :         if (!ret)
    6438              :         {
    6439            0 :             LockBuffer(buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_UNLOCK);
    6440            0 :             release_callback(arg);
    6441              :         }
    6442              :     }
    6443              : 
    6444              :     /*
    6445              :      * GetCatalogSnapshot() relies on invalidation messages to know when to
    6446              :      * take a new snapshot.  COMMIT of xwait is responsible for sending the
    6447              :      * invalidation.  We're not acquiring heavyweight locks sufficient to
    6448              :      * block if not yet sent, so we must take a new snapshot to ensure a later
    6449              :      * attempt has a fair chance.  While we don't need this if xwait aborted,
    6450              :      * don't bother optimizing that.
    6451              :      */
    6452       228804 :     if (!ret)
    6453              :     {
    6454           22 :         UnlockTuple(relation, &oldtup.t_self, InplaceUpdateTupleLock);
    6455           22 :         ForgetInplace_Inval();
    6456           22 :         InvalidateCatalogSnapshot();
    6457              :     }
    6458       228804 :     return ret;
    6459              : }
    6460              : 
    6461              : /*
    6462              :  * heap_inplace_update_and_unlock - core of systable_inplace_update_finish
    6463              :  *
    6464              :  * The tuple cannot change size, and therefore its header fields and null
    6465              :  * bitmap (if any) don't change either.
    6466              :  *
    6467              :  * Since we hold LOCKTAG_TUPLE, no updater has a local copy of this tuple.
    6468              :  */
    6469              : void
    6470       100325 : heap_inplace_update_and_unlock(Relation relation,
    6471              :                                HeapTuple oldtup, HeapTuple tuple,
    6472              :                                Buffer buffer)
    6473              : {
    6474       100325 :     HeapTupleHeader htup = oldtup->t_data;
    6475              :     uint32      oldlen;
    6476              :     uint32      newlen;
    6477              :     char       *dst;
    6478              :     char       *src;
    6479       100325 :     int         nmsgs = 0;
    6480       100325 :     SharedInvalidationMessage *invalMessages = NULL;
    6481       100325 :     bool        RelcacheInitFileInval = false;
    6482              : 
    6483              :     Assert(ItemPointerEquals(&oldtup->t_self, &tuple->t_self));
    6484       100325 :     oldlen = oldtup->t_len - htup->t_hoff;
    6485       100325 :     newlen = tuple->t_len - tuple->t_data->t_hoff;
    6486       100325 :     if (oldlen != newlen || htup->t_hoff != tuple->t_data->t_hoff)
    6487            0 :         elog(ERROR, "wrong tuple length");
    6488              : 
    6489       100325 :     dst = (char *) htup + htup->t_hoff;
    6490       100325 :     src = (char *) tuple->t_data + tuple->t_data->t_hoff;
    6491              : 
    6492              :     /* Like RecordTransactionCommit(), log only if needed */
    6493       100325 :     if (XLogStandbyInfoActive())
    6494        72938 :         nmsgs = inplaceGetInvalidationMessages(&invalMessages,
    6495              :                                                &RelcacheInitFileInval);
    6496              : 
    6497              :     /*
    6498              :      * Unlink relcache init files as needed.  If unlinking, acquire
    6499              :      * RelCacheInitLock until after associated invalidations.  By doing this
    6500              :      * in advance, if we checkpoint and then crash between inplace
    6501              :      * XLogInsert() and inval, we don't rely on StartupXLOG() ->
    6502              :      * RelationCacheInitFileRemove().  That uses elevel==LOG, so replay would
    6503              :      * neglect to PANIC on EIO.
    6504              :      */
    6505       100325 :     PreInplace_Inval();
    6506              : 
    6507              :     /*----------
    6508              :      * NO EREPORT(ERROR) from here till changes are complete
    6509              :      *
    6510              :      * Our exclusive buffer lock won't stop a reader having already pinned and
    6511              :      * checked visibility for this tuple. With the usual order of changes
    6512              :      * (i.e. updating the buffer contents before WAL logging), a reader could
    6513              :      * observe our not-yet-persistent update to relfrozenxid and update
    6514              :      * datfrozenxid based on that. A crash in that moment could allow
    6515              :      * datfrozenxid to overtake relfrozenxid:
    6516              :      *
    6517              :      * ["D" is a VACUUM (ONLY_DATABASE_STATS)]
    6518              :      * ["R" is a VACUUM tbl]
    6519              :      * D: vac_update_datfrozenxid() -> systable_beginscan(pg_class)
    6520              :      * D: systable_getnext() returns pg_class tuple of tbl
    6521              :      * R: memcpy() into pg_class tuple of tbl
    6522              :      * D: raise pg_database.datfrozenxid, XLogInsert(), finish
    6523              :      * [crash]
    6524              :      * [recovery restores datfrozenxid w/o relfrozenxid]
    6525              :      *
    6526              :      * We avoid that by using a temporary copy of the buffer to hide our
    6527              :      * change from other backends until the change has been WAL-logged. We
    6528              :      * apply our change to the temporary copy and WAL-log it, before modifying
    6529              :      * the real page. That way any action a reader of the in-place-updated
    6530              :      * value takes will be WAL logged after this change.
    6531              :      */
    6532       100325 :     START_CRIT_SECTION();
    6533              : 
    6534       100325 :     MarkBufferDirty(buffer);
    6535              : 
    6536              :     /* XLOG stuff */
    6537       100325 :     if (RelationNeedsWAL(relation))
    6538              :     {
    6539              :         xl_heap_inplace xlrec;
    6540              :         PGAlignedBlock copied_buffer;
    6541       100321 :         char       *origdata = (char *) BufferGetBlock(buffer);
    6542       100321 :         Page        page = BufferGetPage(buffer);
    6543       100321 :         uint16      lower = ((PageHeader) page)->pd_lower;
    6544       100321 :         uint16      upper = ((PageHeader) page)->pd_upper;
    6545              :         uintptr_t   dst_offset_in_block;
    6546              :         RelFileLocator rlocator;
    6547              :         ForkNumber  forkno;
    6548              :         BlockNumber blkno;
    6549              :         XLogRecPtr  recptr;
    6550              : 
    6551       100321 :         xlrec.offnum = ItemPointerGetOffsetNumber(&tuple->t_self);
    6552       100321 :         xlrec.dbId = MyDatabaseId;
    6553       100321 :         xlrec.tsId = MyDatabaseTableSpace;
    6554       100321 :         xlrec.relcacheInitFileInval = RelcacheInitFileInval;
    6555       100321 :         xlrec.nmsgs = nmsgs;
    6556              : 
    6557       100321 :         XLogBeginInsert();
    6558       100321 :         XLogRegisterData(&xlrec, MinSizeOfHeapInplace);
    6559       100321 :         if (nmsgs != 0)
    6560        54983 :             XLogRegisterData(invalMessages,
    6561              :                              nmsgs * sizeof(SharedInvalidationMessage));
    6562              : 
    6563              :         /* register block matching what buffer will look like after changes */
    6564       100321 :         memcpy(copied_buffer.data, origdata, lower);
    6565       100321 :         memcpy(copied_buffer.data + upper, origdata + upper, BLCKSZ - upper);
    6566       100321 :         dst_offset_in_block = dst - origdata;
    6567       100321 :         memcpy(copied_buffer.data + dst_offset_in_block, src, newlen);
    6568       100321 :         BufferGetTag(buffer, &rlocator, &forkno, &blkno);
    6569              :         Assert(forkno == MAIN_FORKNUM);
    6570       100321 :         XLogRegisterBlock(0, &rlocator, forkno, blkno, copied_buffer.data,
    6571              :                           REGBUF_STANDARD);
    6572       100321 :         XLogRegisterBufData(0, src, newlen);
    6573              : 
    6574              :         /* inplace updates aren't decoded atm, don't log the origin */
    6575              : 
    6576       100321 :         recptr = XLogInsert(RM_HEAP_ID, XLOG_HEAP_INPLACE);
    6577              : 
    6578       100321 :         PageSetLSN(page, recptr);
    6579              :     }
    6580              : 
    6581       100325 :     memcpy(dst, src, newlen);
    6582              : 
    6583       100325 :     LockBuffer(buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_UNLOCK);
    6584              : 
    6585              :     /*
    6586              :      * Send invalidations to shared queue.  SearchSysCacheLocked1() assumes we
    6587              :      * do this before UnlockTuple().
    6588              :      */
    6589       100325 :     AtInplace_Inval();
    6590              : 
    6591       100325 :     END_CRIT_SECTION();
    6592       100325 :     UnlockTuple(relation, &tuple->t_self, InplaceUpdateTupleLock);
    6593              : 
    6594       100325 :     AcceptInvalidationMessages();   /* local processing of just-sent inval */
    6595              : 
    6596              :     /*
    6597              :      * Queue a transactional inval, for logical decoding and for third-party
    6598              :      * code that might have been relying on it since long before inplace
    6599              :      * update adopted immediate invalidation.  See README.tuplock section
    6600              :      * "Reading inplace-updated columns" for logical decoding details.
    6601              :      */
    6602       100325 :     if (!IsBootstrapProcessingMode())
    6603        82370 :         CacheInvalidateHeapTuple(relation, tuple, NULL);
    6604       100325 : }
    6605              : 
    6606              : /*
    6607              :  * heap_inplace_unlock - reverse of heap_inplace_lock
    6608              :  */
    6609              : void
    6610       128457 : heap_inplace_unlock(Relation relation,
    6611              :                     HeapTuple oldtup, Buffer buffer)
    6612              : {
    6613       128457 :     LockBuffer(buffer, BUFFER_LOCK_UNLOCK);
    6614       128457 :     UnlockTuple(relation, &oldtup->t_self, InplaceUpdateTupleLock);
    6615       128457 :     ForgetInplace_Inval();
    6616       128457 : }
    6617              : 
    6618              : #define     FRM_NOOP                0x0001
    6619              : #define     FRM_INVALIDATE_XMAX     0x0002
    6620              : #define     FRM_RETURN_IS_XID       0x0004
    6621              : #define     FRM_RETURN_IS_MULTI     0x0008
    6622              : #define     FRM_MARK_COMMITTED      0x0010
    6623              : 
    6624              : /*
    6625              :  * FreezeMultiXactId
    6626              :  *      Determine what to do during freezing when a tuple is marked by a
    6627              :  *      MultiXactId.
    6628              :  *
    6629              :  * "flags" is an output value; it's used to tell caller what to do on return.
    6630              :  * "pagefrz" is an input/output value, used to manage page level freezing.
    6631              :  *
    6632              :  * Possible values that we can set in "flags":
    6633              :  * FRM_NOOP
    6634              :  *      don't do anything -- keep existing Xmax
    6635              :  * FRM_INVALIDATE_XMAX
    6636              :  *      mark Xmax as InvalidTransactionId and set XMAX_INVALID flag.
    6637              :  * FRM_RETURN_IS_XID
    6638              :  *      The Xid return value is a single update Xid to set as xmax.
    6639              :  * FRM_MARK_COMMITTED
    6640              :  *      Xmax can be marked as HEAP_XMAX_COMMITTED
    6641              :  * FRM_RETURN_IS_MULTI
    6642              :  *      The return value is a new MultiXactId to set as new Xmax.
    6643              :  *      (caller must obtain proper infomask bits using GetMultiXactIdHintBits)
    6644              :  *
    6645              :  * Caller delegates control of page freezing to us.  In practice we always
    6646              :  * force freezing of caller's page unless FRM_NOOP processing is indicated.
    6647              :  * We help caller ensure that XIDs < FreezeLimit and MXIDs < MultiXactCutoff
    6648              :  * can never be left behind.  We freely choose when and how to process each
    6649              :  * Multi, without ever violating the cutoff postconditions for freezing.
    6650              :  *
    6651              :  * It's useful to remove Multis on a proactive timeline (relative to freezing
    6652              :  * XIDs) to keep MultiXact member SLRU buffer misses to a minimum.  It can also
    6653              :  * be cheaper in the short run, for us, since we too can avoid SLRU buffer
    6654              :  * misses through eager processing.
    6655              :  *
    6656              :  * NB: Creates a _new_ MultiXactId when FRM_RETURN_IS_MULTI is set, though only
    6657              :  * when FreezeLimit and/or MultiXactCutoff cutoffs leave us with no choice.
    6658              :  * This can usually be put off, which is usually enough to avoid it altogether.
    6659              :  * Allocating new multis during VACUUM should be avoided on general principle;
    6660              :  * only VACUUM can advance relminmxid, so allocating new Multis here comes with
    6661              :  * its own special risks.
    6662              :  *
    6663              :  * NB: Caller must maintain "no freeze" NewRelfrozenXid/NewRelminMxid trackers
    6664              :  * using heap_tuple_should_freeze when we haven't forced page-level freezing.
    6665              :  *
    6666              :  * NB: Caller should avoid needlessly calling heap_tuple_should_freeze when we
    6667              :  * have already forced page-level freezing, since that might incur the same
    6668              :  * SLRU buffer misses that we specifically intended to avoid by freezing.
    6669              :  */
    6670              : static TransactionId
    6671            7 : FreezeMultiXactId(MultiXactId multi, uint16 t_infomask,
    6672              :                   const struct VacuumCutoffs *cutoffs, uint16 *flags,
    6673              :                   HeapPageFreeze *pagefrz)
    6674              : {
    6675              :     TransactionId newxmax;
    6676              :     MultiXactMember *members;
    6677              :     int         nmembers;
    6678              :     bool        need_replace;
    6679              :     int         nnewmembers;
    6680              :     MultiXactMember *newmembers;
    6681              :     bool        has_lockers;
    6682              :     TransactionId update_xid;
    6683              :     bool        update_committed;
    6684              :     TransactionId FreezePageRelfrozenXid;
    6685              : 
    6686            7 :     *flags = 0;
    6687              : 
    6688              :     /* We should only be called in Multis */
    6689              :     Assert(t_infomask & HEAP_XMAX_IS_MULTI);
    6690              : 
    6691           14 :     if (!MultiXactIdIsValid(multi) ||
    6692            7 :         HEAP_LOCKED_UPGRADED(t_infomask))
    6693              :     {
    6694            0 :         *flags |= FRM_INVALIDATE_XMAX;
    6695            0 :         pagefrz->freeze_required = true;
    6696            0 :         return InvalidTransactionId;
    6697              :     }
    6698            7 :     else if (MultiXactIdPrecedes(multi, cutoffs->relminmxid))
    6699            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    6700              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED),
    6701              :                  errmsg_internal("found multixact %u from before relminmxid %u",
    6702              :                                  multi, cutoffs->relminmxid)));
    6703            7 :     else if (MultiXactIdPrecedes(multi, cutoffs->OldestMxact))
    6704              :     {
    6705              :         TransactionId update_xact;
    6706              : 
    6707              :         /*
    6708              :          * This old multi cannot possibly have members still running, but
    6709              :          * verify just in case.  If it was a locker only, it can be removed
    6710              :          * without any further consideration; but if it contained an update,
    6711              :          * we might need to preserve it.
    6712              :          */
    6713            5 :         if (MultiXactIdIsRunning(multi,
    6714            5 :                                  HEAP_XMAX_IS_LOCKED_ONLY(t_infomask)))
    6715            0 :             ereport(ERROR,
    6716              :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED),
    6717              :                      errmsg_internal("multixact %u from before multi freeze cutoff %u found to be still running",
    6718              :                                      multi, cutoffs->OldestMxact)));
    6719              : 
    6720            5 :         if (HEAP_XMAX_IS_LOCKED_ONLY(t_infomask))
    6721              :         {
    6722            5 :             *flags |= FRM_INVALIDATE_XMAX;
    6723            5 :             pagefrz->freeze_required = true;
    6724            5 :             return InvalidTransactionId;
    6725              :         }
    6726              : 
    6727              :         /* replace multi with single XID for its updater? */
    6728            0 :         update_xact = MultiXactIdGetUpdateXid(multi, t_infomask);
    6729            0 :         if (TransactionIdPrecedes(update_xact, cutoffs->relfrozenxid))
    6730            0 :             ereport(ERROR,
    6731              :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED),
    6732              :                      errmsg_internal("multixact %u contains update XID %u from before relfrozenxid %u",
    6733              :                                      multi, update_xact,
    6734              :                                      cutoffs->relfrozenxid)));
    6735            0 :         else if (TransactionIdPrecedes(update_xact, cutoffs->OldestXmin))
    6736              :         {
    6737              :             /*
    6738              :              * Updater XID has to have aborted (otherwise the tuple would have
    6739              :              * been pruned away instead, since updater XID is < OldestXmin).
    6740              :              * Just remove xmax.
    6741              :              */
    6742            0 :             if (TransactionIdDidCommit(update_xact))
    6743            0 :                 ereport(ERROR,
    6744              :                         (errcode(ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED),
    6745              :                          errmsg_internal("multixact %u contains committed update XID %u from before removable cutoff %u",
    6746              :                                          multi, update_xact,
    6747              :                                          cutoffs->OldestXmin)));
    6748            0 :             *flags |= FRM_INVALIDATE_XMAX;
    6749            0 :             pagefrz->freeze_required = true;
    6750            0 :             return InvalidTransactionId;
    6751              :         }
    6752              : 
    6753              :         /* Have to keep updater XID as new xmax */
    6754            0 :         *flags |= FRM_RETURN_IS_XID;
    6755            0 :         pagefrz->freeze_required = true;
    6756            0 :         return update_xact;
    6757              :     }
    6758              : 
    6759              :     /*
    6760              :      * Some member(s) of this Multi may be below FreezeLimit xid cutoff, so we
    6761              :      * need to walk the whole members array to figure out what to do, if
    6762              :      * anything.
    6763              :      */
    6764              :     nmembers =
    6765            2 :         GetMultiXactIdMembers(multi, &members, false,
    6766            2 :                               HEAP_XMAX_IS_LOCKED_ONLY(t_infomask));
    6767            2 :     if (nmembers <= 0)
    6768              :     {
    6769              :         /* Nothing worth keeping */
    6770            0 :         *flags |= FRM_INVALIDATE_XMAX;
    6771            0 :         pagefrz->freeze_required = true;
    6772            0 :         return InvalidTransactionId;
    6773              :     }
    6774              : 
    6775              :     /*
    6776              :      * The FRM_NOOP case is the only case where we might need to ratchet back
    6777              :      * FreezePageRelfrozenXid or FreezePageRelminMxid.  It is also the only
    6778              :      * case where our caller might ratchet back its NoFreezePageRelfrozenXid
    6779              :      * or NoFreezePageRelminMxid "no freeze" trackers to deal with a multi.
    6780              :      * FRM_NOOP handling should result in the NewRelfrozenXid/NewRelminMxid
    6781              :      * trackers managed by VACUUM being ratcheting back by xmax to the degree
    6782              :      * required to make it safe to leave xmax undisturbed, independent of
    6783              :      * whether or not page freezing is triggered somewhere else.
    6784              :      *
    6785              :      * Our policy is to force freezing in every case other than FRM_NOOP,
    6786              :      * which obviates the need to maintain either set of trackers, anywhere.
    6787              :      * Every other case will reliably execute a freeze plan for xmax that
    6788              :      * either replaces xmax with an XID/MXID >= OldestXmin/OldestMxact, or
    6789              :      * sets xmax to an InvalidTransactionId XID, rendering xmax fully frozen.
    6790              :      * (VACUUM's NewRelfrozenXid/NewRelminMxid trackers are initialized with
    6791              :      * OldestXmin/OldestMxact, so later values never need to be tracked here.)
    6792              :      */
    6793            2 :     need_replace = false;
    6794            2 :     FreezePageRelfrozenXid = pagefrz->FreezePageRelfrozenXid;
    6795            4 :     for (int i = 0; i < nmembers; i++)
    6796              :     {
    6797            3 :         TransactionId xid = members[i].xid;
    6798              : 
    6799              :         Assert(!TransactionIdPrecedes(xid, cutoffs->relfrozenxid));
    6800              : 
    6801            3 :         if (TransactionIdPrecedes(xid, cutoffs->FreezeLimit))
    6802              :         {
    6803              :             /* Can't violate the FreezeLimit postcondition */
    6804            1 :             need_replace = true;
    6805            1 :             break;
    6806              :         }
    6807            2 :         if (TransactionIdPrecedes(xid, FreezePageRelfrozenXid))
    6808            0 :             FreezePageRelfrozenXid = xid;
    6809              :     }
    6810              : 
    6811              :     /* Can't violate the MultiXactCutoff postcondition, either */
    6812            2 :     if (!need_replace)
    6813            1 :         need_replace = MultiXactIdPrecedes(multi, cutoffs->MultiXactCutoff);
    6814              : 
    6815            2 :     if (!need_replace)
    6816              :     {
    6817              :         /*
    6818              :          * vacuumlazy.c might ratchet back NewRelminMxid, NewRelfrozenXid, or
    6819              :          * both together to make it safe to retain this particular multi after
    6820              :          * freezing its page
    6821              :          */
    6822            1 :         *flags |= FRM_NOOP;
    6823            1 :         pagefrz->FreezePageRelfrozenXid = FreezePageRelfrozenXid;
    6824            1 :         if (MultiXactIdPrecedes(multi, pagefrz->FreezePageRelminMxid))
    6825            0 :             pagefrz->FreezePageRelminMxid = multi;
    6826            1 :         pfree(members);
    6827            1 :         return multi;
    6828              :     }
    6829              : 
    6830              :     /*
    6831              :      * Do a more thorough second pass over the multi to figure out which
    6832              :      * member XIDs actually need to be kept.  Checking the precise status of
    6833              :      * individual members might even show that we don't need to keep anything.
    6834              :      * That is quite possible even though the Multi must be >= OldestMxact,
    6835              :      * since our second pass only keeps member XIDs when it's truly necessary;
    6836              :      * even member XIDs >= OldestXmin often won't be kept by second pass.
    6837              :      */
    6838            1 :     nnewmembers = 0;
    6839            1 :     newmembers = palloc_array(MultiXactMember, nmembers);
    6840            1 :     has_lockers = false;
    6841            1 :     update_xid = InvalidTransactionId;
    6842            1 :     update_committed = false;
    6843              : 
    6844              :     /*
    6845              :      * Determine whether to keep each member xid, or to ignore it instead
    6846              :      */
    6847            3 :     for (int i = 0; i < nmembers; i++)
    6848              :     {
    6849            2 :         TransactionId xid = members[i].xid;
    6850            2 :         MultiXactStatus mstatus = members[i].status;
    6851              : 
    6852              :         Assert(!TransactionIdPrecedes(xid, cutoffs->relfrozenxid));
    6853              : 
    6854            2 :         if (!ISUPDATE_from_mxstatus(mstatus))
    6855              :         {
    6856              :             /*
    6857              :              * Locker XID (not updater XID).  We only keep lockers that are
    6858              :              * still running.
    6859              :              */
    6860            4 :             if (TransactionIdIsCurrentTransactionId(xid) ||
    6861            2 :                 TransactionIdIsInProgress(xid))
    6862              :             {
    6863            1 :                 if (TransactionIdPrecedes(xid, cutoffs->OldestXmin))
    6864            0 :                     ereport(ERROR,
    6865              :                             (errcode(ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED),
    6866              :                              errmsg_internal("multixact %u contains running locker XID %u from before removable cutoff %u",
    6867              :                                              multi, xid,
    6868              :                                              cutoffs->OldestXmin)));
    6869            1 :                 newmembers[nnewmembers++] = members[i];
    6870            1 :                 has_lockers = true;
    6871              :             }
    6872              : 
    6873            2 :             continue;
    6874              :         }
    6875              : 
    6876              :         /*
    6877              :          * Updater XID (not locker XID).  Should we keep it?
    6878              :          *
    6879              :          * Since the tuple wasn't totally removed when vacuum pruned, the
    6880              :          * update Xid cannot possibly be older than OldestXmin cutoff unless
    6881              :          * the updater XID aborted.  If the updater transaction is known
    6882              :          * aborted or crashed then it's okay to ignore it, otherwise not.
    6883              :          *
    6884              :          * In any case the Multi should never contain two updaters, whatever
    6885              :          * their individual commit status.  Check for that first, in passing.
    6886              :          */
    6887            0 :         if (TransactionIdIsValid(update_xid))
    6888            0 :             ereport(ERROR,
    6889              :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED),
    6890              :                      errmsg_internal("multixact %u has two or more updating members",
    6891              :                                      multi),
    6892              :                      errdetail_internal("First updater XID=%u second updater XID=%u.",
    6893              :                                         update_xid, xid)));
    6894              : 
    6895              :         /*
    6896              :          * As with all tuple visibility routines, it's critical to test
    6897              :          * TransactionIdIsInProgress before TransactionIdDidCommit, because of
    6898              :          * race conditions explained in detail in heapam_visibility.c.
    6899              :          */
    6900            0 :         if (TransactionIdIsCurrentTransactionId(xid) ||
    6901            0 :             TransactionIdIsInProgress(xid))
    6902            0 :             update_xid = xid;
    6903            0 :         else if (TransactionIdDidCommit(xid))
    6904              :         {
    6905              :             /*
    6906              :              * The transaction committed, so we can tell caller to set
    6907              :              * HEAP_XMAX_COMMITTED.  (We can only do this because we know the
    6908              :              * transaction is not running.)
    6909              :              */
    6910            0 :             update_committed = true;
    6911            0 :             update_xid = xid;
    6912              :         }
    6913              :         else
    6914              :         {
    6915              :             /*
    6916              :              * Not in progress, not committed -- must be aborted or crashed;
    6917              :              * we can ignore it.
    6918              :              */
    6919            0 :             continue;
    6920              :         }
    6921              : 
    6922              :         /*
    6923              :          * We determined that updater must be kept -- add it to pending new
    6924              :          * members list
    6925              :          */
    6926            0 :         if (TransactionIdPrecedes(xid, cutoffs->OldestXmin))
    6927            0 :             ereport(ERROR,
    6928              :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED),
    6929              :                      errmsg_internal("multixact %u contains committed update XID %u from before removable cutoff %u",
    6930              :                                      multi, xid, cutoffs->OldestXmin)));
    6931            0 :         newmembers[nnewmembers++] = members[i];
    6932              :     }
    6933              : 
    6934            1 :     pfree(members);
    6935              : 
    6936              :     /*
    6937              :      * Determine what to do with caller's multi based on information gathered
    6938              :      * during our second pass
    6939              :      */
    6940            1 :     if (nnewmembers == 0)
    6941              :     {
    6942              :         /* Nothing worth keeping */
    6943            0 :         *flags |= FRM_INVALIDATE_XMAX;
    6944            0 :         newxmax = InvalidTransactionId;
    6945              :     }
    6946            1 :     else if (TransactionIdIsValid(update_xid) && !has_lockers)
    6947              :     {
    6948              :         /*
    6949              :          * If there's a single member and it's an update, pass it back alone
    6950              :          * without creating a new Multi.  (XXX we could do this when there's a
    6951              :          * single remaining locker, too, but that would complicate the API too
    6952              :          * much; moreover, the case with the single updater is more
    6953              :          * interesting, because those are longer-lived.)
    6954              :          */
    6955              :         Assert(nnewmembers == 1);
    6956            0 :         *flags |= FRM_RETURN_IS_XID;
    6957            0 :         if (update_committed)
    6958            0 :             *flags |= FRM_MARK_COMMITTED;
    6959            0 :         newxmax = update_xid;
    6960              :     }
    6961              :     else
    6962              :     {
    6963              :         /*
    6964              :          * Create a new multixact with the surviving members of the previous
    6965              :          * one, to set as new Xmax in the tuple
    6966              :          */
    6967            1 :         newxmax = MultiXactIdCreateFromMembers(nnewmembers, newmembers);
    6968            1 :         *flags |= FRM_RETURN_IS_MULTI;
    6969              :     }
    6970              : 
    6971            1 :     pfree(newmembers);
    6972              : 
    6973            1 :     pagefrz->freeze_required = true;
    6974            1 :     return newxmax;
    6975              : }
    6976              : 
    6977              : /*
    6978              :  * heap_prepare_freeze_tuple
    6979              :  *
    6980              :  * Check to see whether any of the XID fields of a tuple (xmin, xmax, xvac)
    6981              :  * are older than the OldestXmin and/or OldestMxact freeze cutoffs.  If so,
    6982              :  * setup enough state (in the *frz output argument) to enable caller to
    6983              :  * process this tuple as part of freezing its page, and return true.  Return
    6984              :  * false if nothing can be changed about the tuple right now.
    6985              :  *
    6986              :  * FreezePageConflictXid is advanced only for xmin/xvac freezing, not for xmax
    6987              :  * changes. We only remove xmax state here when it is lock-only, or when the
    6988              :  * updater XID (including an updater member of a MultiXact) must be aborted;
    6989              :  * otherwise, the tuple would already be removable. Neither case affects
    6990              :  * visibility on a standby.
    6991              :  *
    6992              :  * Also sets *totally_frozen to true if the tuple will be totally frozen once
    6993              :  * caller executes returned freeze plan (or if the tuple was already totally
    6994              :  * frozen by an earlier VACUUM).  This indicates that there are no remaining
    6995              :  * XIDs or MultiXactIds that will need to be processed by a future VACUUM.
    6996              :  *
    6997              :  * VACUUM caller must assemble HeapTupleFreeze freeze plan entries for every
    6998              :  * tuple that we returned true for, and then execute freezing.  Caller must
    6999              :  * initialize pagefrz fields for page as a whole before first call here for
    7000              :  * each heap page.
    7001              :  *
    7002              :  * VACUUM caller decides on whether or not to freeze the page as a whole.
    7003              :  * We'll often prepare freeze plans for a page that caller just discards.
    7004              :  * However, VACUUM doesn't always get to make a choice; it must freeze when
    7005              :  * pagefrz.freeze_required is set, to ensure that any XIDs < FreezeLimit (and
    7006              :  * MXIDs < MultiXactCutoff) can never be left behind.  We help to make sure
    7007              :  * that VACUUM always follows that rule.
    7008              :  *
    7009              :  * We sometimes force freezing of xmax MultiXactId values long before it is
    7010              :  * strictly necessary to do so just to ensure the FreezeLimit postcondition.
    7011              :  * It's worth processing MultiXactIds proactively when it is cheap to do so,
    7012              :  * and it's convenient to make that happen by piggy-backing it on the "force
    7013              :  * freezing" mechanism.  Conversely, we sometimes delay freezing MultiXactIds
    7014              :  * because it is expensive right now (though only when it's still possible to
    7015              :  * do so without violating the FreezeLimit/MultiXactCutoff postcondition).
    7016              :  *
    7017              :  * It is assumed that the caller has checked the tuple with
    7018              :  * HeapTupleSatisfiesVacuum() and determined that it is not HEAPTUPLE_DEAD
    7019              :  * (else we should be removing the tuple, not freezing it).
    7020              :  *
    7021              :  * NB: This function has side effects: it might allocate a new MultiXactId.
    7022              :  * It will be set as tuple's new xmax when our *frz output is processed within
    7023              :  * heap_execute_freeze_tuple later on.  If the tuple is in a shared buffer
    7024              :  * then caller had better have an exclusive lock on it already.
    7025              :  */
    7026              : bool
    7027     11926819 : heap_prepare_freeze_tuple(HeapTupleHeader tuple,
    7028              :                           const struct VacuumCutoffs *cutoffs,
    7029              :                           HeapPageFreeze *pagefrz,
    7030              :                           HeapTupleFreeze *frz, bool *totally_frozen)
    7031              : {
    7032     11926819 :     bool        xmin_already_frozen = false,
    7033     11926819 :                 xmax_already_frozen = false;
    7034     11926819 :     bool        freeze_xmin = false,
    7035     11926819 :                 replace_xvac = false,
    7036     11926819 :                 replace_xmax = false,
    7037     11926819 :                 freeze_xmax = false;
    7038              :     TransactionId xid;
    7039              : 
    7040     11926819 :     frz->xmax = HeapTupleHeaderGetRawXmax(tuple);
    7041     11926819 :     frz->t_infomask2 = tuple->t_infomask2;
    7042     11926819 :     frz->t_infomask = tuple->t_infomask;
    7043     11926819 :     frz->frzflags = 0;
    7044     11926819 :     frz->checkflags = 0;
    7045              : 
    7046              :     /*
    7047              :      * Process xmin, while keeping track of whether it's already frozen, or
    7048              :      * will become frozen iff our freeze plan is executed by caller (could be
    7049              :      * neither).
    7050              :      */
    7051     11926819 :     xid = HeapTupleHeaderGetXmin(tuple);
    7052     11926819 :     if (!TransactionIdIsNormal(xid))
    7053      7982872 :         xmin_already_frozen = true;
    7054              :     else
    7055              :     {
    7056      3943947 :         if (TransactionIdPrecedes(xid, cutoffs->relfrozenxid))
    7057            0 :             ereport(ERROR,
    7058              :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED),
    7059              :                      errmsg_internal("found xmin %u from before relfrozenxid %u",
    7060              :                                      xid, cutoffs->relfrozenxid)));
    7061              : 
    7062              :         /* Will set freeze_xmin flags in freeze plan below */
    7063      3943947 :         freeze_xmin = TransactionIdPrecedes(xid, cutoffs->OldestXmin);
    7064              : 
    7065              :         /* Verify that xmin committed if and when freeze plan is executed */
    7066      3943947 :         if (freeze_xmin)
    7067              :         {
    7068      3209783 :             frz->checkflags |= HEAP_FREEZE_CHECK_XMIN_COMMITTED;
    7069      3209783 :             if (TransactionIdFollows(xid, pagefrz->FreezePageConflictXid))
    7070       507788 :                 pagefrz->FreezePageConflictXid = xid;
    7071              :         }
    7072              :     }
    7073              : 
    7074              :     /*
    7075              :      * Old-style VACUUM FULL is gone, but we have to process xvac for as long
    7076              :      * as we support having MOVED_OFF/MOVED_IN tuples in the database
    7077              :      */
    7078     11926819 :     xid = HeapTupleHeaderGetXvac(tuple);
    7079     11926819 :     if (TransactionIdIsNormal(xid))
    7080              :     {
    7081              :         Assert(TransactionIdPrecedesOrEquals(cutoffs->relfrozenxid, xid));
    7082              :         Assert(TransactionIdPrecedes(xid, cutoffs->OldestXmin));
    7083              : 
    7084              :         /*
    7085              :          * For Xvac, we always freeze proactively.  This allows totally_frozen
    7086              :          * tracking to ignore xvac.
    7087              :          */
    7088            0 :         replace_xvac = pagefrz->freeze_required = true;
    7089              : 
    7090            0 :         if (TransactionIdFollows(xid, pagefrz->FreezePageConflictXid))
    7091            0 :             pagefrz->FreezePageConflictXid = xid;
    7092              : 
    7093              :         /* Will set replace_xvac flags in freeze plan below */
    7094              :     }
    7095              : 
    7096              :     /* Now process xmax */
    7097     11926819 :     xid = frz->xmax;
    7098     11926819 :     if (tuple->t_infomask & HEAP_XMAX_IS_MULTI)
    7099              :     {
    7100              :         /* Raw xmax is a MultiXactId */
    7101              :         TransactionId newxmax;
    7102              :         uint16      flags;
    7103              : 
    7104              :         /*
    7105              :          * We will either remove xmax completely (in the "freeze_xmax" path),
    7106              :          * process xmax by replacing it (in the "replace_xmax" path), or
    7107              :          * perform no-op xmax processing.  The only constraint is that the
    7108              :          * FreezeLimit/MultiXactCutoff postcondition must never be violated.
    7109              :          */
    7110            7 :         newxmax = FreezeMultiXactId(xid, tuple->t_infomask, cutoffs,
    7111              :                                     &flags, pagefrz);
    7112              : 
    7113            7 :         if (flags & FRM_NOOP)
    7114              :         {
    7115              :             /*
    7116              :              * xmax is a MultiXactId, and nothing about it changes for now.
    7117              :              * This is the only case where 'freeze_required' won't have been
    7118              :              * set for us by FreezeMultiXactId, as well as the only case where
    7119              :              * neither freeze_xmax nor replace_xmax are set (given a multi).
    7120              :              *
    7121              :              * This is a no-op, but the call to FreezeMultiXactId might have
    7122              :              * ratcheted back NewRelfrozenXid and/or NewRelminMxid trackers
    7123              :              * for us (the "freeze page" variants, specifically).  That'll
    7124              :              * make it safe for our caller to freeze the page later on, while
    7125              :              * leaving this particular xmax undisturbed.
    7126              :              *
    7127              :              * FreezeMultiXactId is _not_ responsible for the "no freeze"
    7128              :              * NewRelfrozenXid/NewRelminMxid trackers, though -- that's our
    7129              :              * job.  A call to heap_tuple_should_freeze for this same tuple
    7130              :              * will take place below if 'freeze_required' isn't set already.
    7131              :              * (This repeats work from FreezeMultiXactId, but allows "no
    7132              :              * freeze" tracker maintenance to happen in only one place.)
    7133              :              */
    7134              :             Assert(!MultiXactIdPrecedes(newxmax, cutoffs->MultiXactCutoff));
    7135              :             Assert(MultiXactIdIsValid(newxmax) && xid == newxmax);
    7136              :         }
    7137            6 :         else if (flags & FRM_RETURN_IS_XID)
    7138              :         {
    7139              :             /*
    7140              :              * xmax will become an updater Xid (original MultiXact's updater
    7141              :              * member Xid will be carried forward as a simple Xid in Xmax).
    7142              :              */
    7143              :             Assert(!TransactionIdPrecedes(newxmax, cutoffs->OldestXmin));
    7144              : 
    7145              :             /*
    7146              :              * NB -- some of these transformations are only valid because we
    7147              :              * know the return Xid is a tuple updater (i.e. not merely a
    7148              :              * locker.) Also note that the only reason we don't explicitly
    7149              :              * worry about HEAP_KEYS_UPDATED is because it lives in
    7150              :              * t_infomask2 rather than t_infomask.
    7151              :              */
    7152            0 :             frz->t_infomask &= ~HEAP_XMAX_BITS;
    7153            0 :             frz->xmax = newxmax;
    7154            0 :             if (flags & FRM_MARK_COMMITTED)
    7155            0 :                 frz->t_infomask |= HEAP_XMAX_COMMITTED;
    7156            0 :             replace_xmax = true;
    7157              :         }
    7158            6 :         else if (flags & FRM_RETURN_IS_MULTI)
    7159              :         {
    7160              :             uint16      newbits;
    7161              :             uint16      newbits2;
    7162              : 
    7163              :             /*
    7164              :              * xmax is an old MultiXactId that we have to replace with a new
    7165              :              * MultiXactId, to carry forward two or more original member XIDs.
    7166              :              */
    7167              :             Assert(!MultiXactIdPrecedes(newxmax, cutoffs->OldestMxact));
    7168              : 
    7169              :             /*
    7170              :              * We can't use GetMultiXactIdHintBits directly on the new multi
    7171              :              * here; that routine initializes the masks to all zeroes, which
    7172              :              * would lose other bits we need.  Doing it this way ensures all
    7173              :              * unrelated bits remain untouched.
    7174              :              */
    7175            1 :             frz->t_infomask &= ~HEAP_XMAX_BITS;
    7176            1 :             frz->t_infomask2 &= ~HEAP_KEYS_UPDATED;
    7177            1 :             GetMultiXactIdHintBits(newxmax, &newbits, &newbits2);
    7178            1 :             frz->t_infomask |= newbits;
    7179            1 :             frz->t_infomask2 |= newbits2;
    7180            1 :             frz->xmax = newxmax;
    7181            1 :             replace_xmax = true;
    7182              :         }
    7183              :         else
    7184              :         {
    7185              :             /*
    7186              :              * Freeze plan for tuple "freezes xmax" in the strictest sense:
    7187              :              * it'll leave nothing in xmax (neither an Xid nor a MultiXactId).
    7188              :              */
    7189              :             Assert(flags & FRM_INVALIDATE_XMAX);
    7190              :             Assert(!TransactionIdIsValid(newxmax));
    7191              : 
    7192              :             /* Will set freeze_xmax flags in freeze plan below */
    7193            5 :             freeze_xmax = true;
    7194              :         }
    7195              : 
    7196              :         /* MultiXactId processing forces freezing (barring FRM_NOOP case) */
    7197              :         Assert(pagefrz->freeze_required || (!freeze_xmax && !replace_xmax));
    7198              :     }
    7199     11926812 :     else if (TransactionIdIsNormal(xid))
    7200              :     {
    7201              :         /* Raw xmax is normal XID */
    7202      5480910 :         if (TransactionIdPrecedes(xid, cutoffs->relfrozenxid))
    7203            0 :             ereport(ERROR,
    7204              :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED),
    7205              :                      errmsg_internal("found xmax %u from before relfrozenxid %u",
    7206              :                                      xid, cutoffs->relfrozenxid)));
    7207              : 
    7208              :         /* Will set freeze_xmax flags in freeze plan below */
    7209      5480910 :         freeze_xmax = TransactionIdPrecedes(xid, cutoffs->OldestXmin);
    7210              : 
    7211              :         /*
    7212              :          * Verify that xmax aborted if and when freeze plan is executed,
    7213              :          * provided it's from an update. (A lock-only xmax can be removed
    7214              :          * independent of this, since the lock is released at xact end.)
    7215              :          */
    7216      5480910 :         if (freeze_xmax && !HEAP_XMAX_IS_LOCKED_ONLY(tuple->t_infomask))
    7217          997 :             frz->checkflags |= HEAP_FREEZE_CHECK_XMAX_ABORTED;
    7218              :     }
    7219      6445902 :     else if (!TransactionIdIsValid(xid))
    7220              :     {
    7221              :         /* Raw xmax is InvalidTransactionId XID */
    7222              :         Assert((tuple->t_infomask & HEAP_XMAX_IS_MULTI) == 0);
    7223      6445902 :         xmax_already_frozen = true;
    7224              :     }
    7225              :     else
    7226            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    7227              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED),
    7228              :                  errmsg_internal("found raw xmax %u (infomask 0x%04x) not invalid and not multi",
    7229              :                                  xid, tuple->t_infomask)));
    7230              : 
    7231     11926819 :     if (freeze_xmin)
    7232              :     {
    7233              :         Assert(!xmin_already_frozen);
    7234              : 
    7235      3209783 :         frz->t_infomask |= HEAP_XMIN_FROZEN;
    7236              :     }
    7237     11926819 :     if (replace_xvac)
    7238              :     {
    7239              :         /*
    7240              :          * If a MOVED_OFF tuple is not dead, the xvac transaction must have
    7241              :          * failed; whereas a non-dead MOVED_IN tuple must mean the xvac
    7242              :          * transaction succeeded.
    7243              :          */
    7244              :         Assert(pagefrz->freeze_required);
    7245            0 :         if (tuple->t_infomask & HEAP_MOVED_OFF)
    7246            0 :             frz->frzflags |= XLH_INVALID_XVAC;
    7247              :         else
    7248            0 :             frz->frzflags |= XLH_FREEZE_XVAC;
    7249              :     }
    7250              :     if (replace_xmax)
    7251              :     {
    7252              :         Assert(!xmax_already_frozen && !freeze_xmax);
    7253              :         Assert(pagefrz->freeze_required);
    7254              : 
    7255              :         /* Already set replace_xmax flags in freeze plan earlier */
    7256              :     }
    7257     11926819 :     if (freeze_xmax)
    7258              :     {
    7259              :         Assert(!xmax_already_frozen && !replace_xmax);
    7260              : 
    7261         1879 :         frz->xmax = InvalidTransactionId;
    7262              : 
    7263              :         /*
    7264              :          * The tuple might be marked either XMAX_INVALID or XMAX_COMMITTED +
    7265              :          * LOCKED.  Normalize to INVALID just to be sure no one gets confused.
    7266              :          * Also get rid of the HEAP_KEYS_UPDATED bit.
    7267              :          */
    7268         1879 :         frz->t_infomask &= ~HEAP_XMAX_BITS;
    7269         1879 :         frz->t_infomask |= HEAP_XMAX_INVALID;
    7270         1879 :         frz->t_infomask2 &= ~HEAP_HOT_UPDATED;
    7271         1879 :         frz->t_infomask2 &= ~HEAP_KEYS_UPDATED;
    7272              :     }
    7273              : 
    7274              :     /*
    7275              :      * Determine if this tuple is already totally frozen, or will become
    7276              :      * totally frozen (provided caller executes freeze plans for the page)
    7277              :      */
    7278     23117595 :     *totally_frozen = ((freeze_xmin || xmin_already_frozen) &&
    7279     11190776 :                        (freeze_xmax || xmax_already_frozen));
    7280              : 
    7281     11926819 :     if (!pagefrz->freeze_required && !(xmin_already_frozen &&
    7282              :                                        xmax_already_frozen))
    7283              :     {
    7284              :         /*
    7285              :          * So far no previous tuple from the page made freezing mandatory.
    7286              :          * Does this tuple force caller to freeze the entire page?
    7287              :          */
    7288      7593850 :         pagefrz->freeze_required =
    7289      7593850 :             heap_tuple_should_freeze(tuple, cutoffs,
    7290              :                                      &pagefrz->NoFreezePageRelfrozenXid,
    7291              :                                      &pagefrz->NoFreezePageRelminMxid);
    7292              :     }
    7293              : 
    7294              :     /* Tell caller if this tuple has a usable freeze plan set in *frz */
    7295     11926819 :     return freeze_xmin || replace_xvac || replace_xmax || freeze_xmax;
    7296              : }
    7297              : 
    7298              : /*
    7299              :  * Perform xmin/xmax XID status sanity checks before actually executing freeze
    7300              :  * plans.
    7301              :  *
    7302              :  * heap_prepare_freeze_tuple doesn't perform these checks directly because
    7303              :  * pg_xact lookups are relatively expensive.  They shouldn't be repeated by
    7304              :  * successive VACUUMs that each decide against freezing the same page.
    7305              :  */
    7306              : void
    7307        25741 : heap_pre_freeze_checks(Buffer buffer,
    7308              :                        HeapTupleFreeze *tuples, int ntuples)
    7309              : {
    7310        25741 :     Page        page = BufferGetPage(buffer);
    7311              : 
    7312      1226959 :     for (int i = 0; i < ntuples; i++)
    7313              :     {
    7314      1201218 :         HeapTupleFreeze *frz = tuples + i;
    7315      1201218 :         ItemId      itemid = PageGetItemId(page, frz->offset);
    7316              :         HeapTupleHeader htup;
    7317              : 
    7318      1201218 :         htup = (HeapTupleHeader) PageGetItem(page, itemid);
    7319              : 
    7320              :         /* Deliberately avoid relying on tuple hint bits here */
    7321      1201218 :         if (frz->checkflags & HEAP_FREEZE_CHECK_XMIN_COMMITTED)
    7322              :         {
    7323      1201217 :             TransactionId xmin = HeapTupleHeaderGetRawXmin(htup);
    7324              : 
    7325              :             Assert(!HeapTupleHeaderXminFrozen(htup));
    7326      1201217 :             if (unlikely(!TransactionIdDidCommit(xmin)))
    7327            0 :                 ereport(ERROR,
    7328              :                         (errcode(ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED),
    7329              :                          errmsg_internal("uncommitted xmin %u needs to be frozen",
    7330              :                                          xmin)));
    7331              :         }
    7332              : 
    7333              :         /*
    7334              :          * TransactionIdDidAbort won't work reliably in the presence of XIDs
    7335              :          * left behind by transactions that were in progress during a crash,
    7336              :          * so we can only check that xmax didn't commit
    7337              :          */
    7338      1201218 :         if (frz->checkflags & HEAP_FREEZE_CHECK_XMAX_ABORTED)
    7339              :         {
    7340          246 :             TransactionId xmax = HeapTupleHeaderGetRawXmax(htup);
    7341              : 
    7342              :             Assert(TransactionIdIsNormal(xmax));
    7343          246 :             if (unlikely(TransactionIdDidCommit(xmax)))
    7344            0 :                 ereport(ERROR,
    7345              :                         (errcode(ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED),
    7346              :                          errmsg_internal("cannot freeze committed xmax %u",
    7347              :                                          xmax)));
    7348              :         }
    7349              :     }
    7350        25741 : }
    7351              : 
    7352              : /*
    7353              :  * Helper which executes freezing of one or more heap tuples on a page on
    7354              :  * behalf of caller.  Caller passes an array of tuple plans from
    7355              :  * heap_prepare_freeze_tuple.  Caller must set 'offset' in each plan for us.
    7356              :  * Must be called in a critical section that also marks the buffer dirty and,
    7357              :  * if needed, emits WAL.
    7358              :  */
    7359              : void
    7360        25741 : heap_freeze_prepared_tuples(Buffer buffer, HeapTupleFreeze *tuples, int ntuples)
    7361              : {
    7362        25741 :     Page        page = BufferGetPage(buffer);
    7363              : 
    7364      1226959 :     for (int i = 0; i < ntuples; i++)
    7365              :     {
    7366      1201218 :         HeapTupleFreeze *frz = tuples + i;
    7367      1201218 :         ItemId      itemid = PageGetItemId(page, frz->offset);
    7368              :         HeapTupleHeader htup;
    7369              : 
    7370      1201218 :         htup = (HeapTupleHeader) PageGetItem(page, itemid);
    7371      1201218 :         heap_execute_freeze_tuple(htup, frz);
    7372              :     }
    7373        25741 : }
    7374              : 
    7375              : /*
    7376              :  * heap_freeze_tuple
    7377              :  *      Freeze tuple in place, without WAL logging.
    7378              :  *
    7379              :  * Useful for callers like CLUSTER that perform their own WAL logging.
    7380              :  */
    7381              : bool
    7382       456141 : heap_freeze_tuple(HeapTupleHeader tuple,
    7383              :                   TransactionId relfrozenxid, TransactionId relminmxid,
    7384              :                   TransactionId FreezeLimit, TransactionId MultiXactCutoff)
    7385              : {
    7386              :     HeapTupleFreeze frz;
    7387              :     bool        do_freeze;
    7388              :     bool        totally_frozen;
    7389              :     struct VacuumCutoffs cutoffs;
    7390              :     HeapPageFreeze pagefrz;
    7391              : 
    7392       456141 :     cutoffs.relfrozenxid = relfrozenxid;
    7393       456141 :     cutoffs.relminmxid = relminmxid;
    7394       456141 :     cutoffs.OldestXmin = FreezeLimit;
    7395       456141 :     cutoffs.OldestMxact = MultiXactCutoff;
    7396       456141 :     cutoffs.FreezeLimit = FreezeLimit;
    7397       456141 :     cutoffs.MultiXactCutoff = MultiXactCutoff;
    7398              : 
    7399       456141 :     pagefrz.freeze_required = true;
    7400       456141 :     pagefrz.FreezePageRelfrozenXid = FreezeLimit;
    7401       456141 :     pagefrz.FreezePageRelminMxid = MultiXactCutoff;
    7402       456141 :     pagefrz.FreezePageConflictXid = InvalidTransactionId;
    7403       456141 :     pagefrz.NoFreezePageRelfrozenXid = FreezeLimit;
    7404       456141 :     pagefrz.NoFreezePageRelminMxid = MultiXactCutoff;
    7405              : 
    7406       456141 :     do_freeze = heap_prepare_freeze_tuple(tuple, &cutoffs,
    7407              :                                           &pagefrz, &frz, &totally_frozen);
    7408              : 
    7409              :     /*
    7410              :      * Note that because this is not a WAL-logged operation, we don't need to
    7411              :      * fill in the offset in the freeze record.
    7412              :      */
    7413              : 
    7414       456141 :     if (do_freeze)
    7415       378170 :         heap_execute_freeze_tuple(tuple, &frz);
    7416       456141 :     return do_freeze;
    7417              : }
    7418              : 
    7419              : /*
    7420              :  * For a given MultiXactId, return the hint bits that should be set in the
    7421              :  * tuple's infomask.
    7422              :  *
    7423              :  * Normally this should be called for a multixact that was just created, and
    7424              :  * so is on our local cache, so the GetMembers call is fast.
    7425              :  */
    7426              : static void
    7427        76883 : GetMultiXactIdHintBits(MultiXactId multi, uint16 *new_infomask,
    7428              :                        uint16 *new_infomask2)
    7429              : {
    7430              :     int         nmembers;
    7431              :     MultiXactMember *members;
    7432              :     int         i;
    7433        76883 :     uint16      bits = HEAP_XMAX_IS_MULTI;
    7434        76883 :     uint16      bits2 = 0;
    7435        76883 :     bool        has_update = false;
    7436        76883 :     LockTupleMode strongest = LockTupleKeyShare;
    7437              : 
    7438              :     /*
    7439              :      * We only use this in multis we just created, so they cannot be values
    7440              :      * pre-pg_upgrade.
    7441              :      */
    7442        76883 :     nmembers = GetMultiXactIdMembers(multi, &members, false, false);
    7443              : 
    7444      1472858 :     for (i = 0; i < nmembers; i++)
    7445              :     {
    7446              :         LockTupleMode mode;
    7447              : 
    7448              :         /*
    7449              :          * Remember the strongest lock mode held by any member of the
    7450              :          * multixact.
    7451              :          */
    7452      1395975 :         mode = TUPLOCK_from_mxstatus(members[i].status);
    7453      1395975 :         if (mode > strongest)
    7454         2929 :             strongest = mode;
    7455              : 
    7456              :         /* See what other bits we need */
    7457      1395975 :         switch (members[i].status)
    7458              :         {
    7459      1393553 :             case MultiXactStatusForKeyShare:
    7460              :             case MultiXactStatusForShare:
    7461              :             case MultiXactStatusForNoKeyUpdate:
    7462      1393553 :                 break;
    7463              : 
    7464           53 :             case MultiXactStatusForUpdate:
    7465           53 :                 bits2 |= HEAP_KEYS_UPDATED;
    7466           53 :                 break;
    7467              : 
    7468         2359 :             case MultiXactStatusNoKeyUpdate:
    7469         2359 :                 has_update = true;
    7470         2359 :                 break;
    7471              : 
    7472           10 :             case MultiXactStatusUpdate:
    7473           10 :                 bits2 |= HEAP_KEYS_UPDATED;
    7474           10 :                 has_update = true;
    7475           10 :                 break;
    7476              :         }
    7477              :     }
    7478              : 
    7479        76883 :     if (strongest == LockTupleExclusive ||
    7480              :         strongest == LockTupleNoKeyExclusive)
    7481         2450 :         bits |= HEAP_XMAX_EXCL_LOCK;
    7482        74433 :     else if (strongest == LockTupleShare)
    7483          476 :         bits |= HEAP_XMAX_SHR_LOCK;
    7484        73957 :     else if (strongest == LockTupleKeyShare)
    7485        73957 :         bits |= HEAP_XMAX_KEYSHR_LOCK;
    7486              : 
    7487        76883 :     if (!has_update)
    7488        74514 :         bits |= HEAP_XMAX_LOCK_ONLY;
    7489              : 
    7490        76883 :     if (nmembers > 0)
    7491        76883 :         pfree(members);
    7492              : 
    7493        76883 :     *new_infomask = bits;
    7494        76883 :     *new_infomask2 = bits2;
    7495        76883 : }
    7496              : 
    7497              : /*
    7498              :  * MultiXactIdGetUpdateXid
    7499              :  *
    7500              :  * Given a multixact Xmax and corresponding infomask, which does not have the
    7501              :  * HEAP_XMAX_LOCK_ONLY bit set, obtain and return the Xid of the updating
    7502              :  * transaction.
    7503              :  *
    7504              :  * Caller is expected to check the status of the updating transaction, if
    7505              :  * necessary.
    7506              :  */
    7507              : static TransactionId
    7508       162051 : MultiXactIdGetUpdateXid(TransactionId xmax, uint16 t_infomask)
    7509              : {
    7510       162051 :     TransactionId update_xact = InvalidTransactionId;
    7511              :     MultiXactMember *members;
    7512              :     int         nmembers;
    7513              : 
    7514              :     Assert(!(t_infomask & HEAP_XMAX_LOCK_ONLY));
    7515              :     Assert(t_infomask & HEAP_XMAX_IS_MULTI);
    7516              : 
    7517              :     /*
    7518              :      * Since we know the LOCK_ONLY bit is not set, this cannot be a multi from
    7519              :      * pre-pg_upgrade.
    7520              :      */
    7521       162051 :     nmembers = GetMultiXactIdMembers(xmax, &members, false, false);
    7522              : 
    7523       162051 :     if (nmembers > 0)
    7524              :     {
    7525              :         int         i;
    7526              : 
    7527       245869 :         for (i = 0; i < nmembers; i++)
    7528              :         {
    7529              :             /* Ignore lockers */
    7530       245869 :             if (!ISUPDATE_from_mxstatus(members[i].status))
    7531        83818 :                 continue;
    7532              : 
    7533              :             /* there can be at most one updater */
    7534              :             Assert(update_xact == InvalidTransactionId);
    7535       162051 :             update_xact = members[i].xid;
    7536              : #ifndef USE_ASSERT_CHECKING
    7537              : 
    7538              :             /*
    7539              :              * in an assert-enabled build, walk the whole array to ensure
    7540              :              * there's no other updater.
    7541              :              */
    7542       162051 :             break;
    7543              : #endif
    7544              :         }
    7545              : 
    7546       162051 :         pfree(members);
    7547              :     }
    7548              : 
    7549       162051 :     return update_xact;
    7550              : }
    7551              : 
    7552              : /*
    7553              :  * HeapTupleGetUpdateXid
    7554              :  *      As above, but use a HeapTupleHeader
    7555              :  *
    7556              :  * See also HeapTupleHeaderGetUpdateXid, which can be used without previously
    7557              :  * checking the hint bits.
    7558              :  */
    7559              : TransactionId
    7560       159912 : HeapTupleGetUpdateXid(const HeapTupleHeaderData *tup)
    7561              : {
    7562       159912 :     return MultiXactIdGetUpdateXid(HeapTupleHeaderGetRawXmax(tup),
    7563       159912 :                                    tup->t_infomask);
    7564              : }
    7565              : 
    7566              : /*
    7567              :  * Does the given multixact conflict with the current transaction grabbing a
    7568              :  * tuple lock of the given strength?
    7569              :  *
    7570              :  * The passed infomask pairs up with the given multixact in the tuple header.
    7571              :  *
    7572              :  * If current_is_member is not NULL, it is set to 'true' if the current
    7573              :  * transaction is a member of the given multixact.
    7574              :  */
    7575              : static bool
    7576          218 : DoesMultiXactIdConflict(MultiXactId multi, uint16 infomask,
    7577              :                         LockTupleMode lockmode, bool *current_is_member)
    7578              : {
    7579              :     int         nmembers;
    7580              :     MultiXactMember *members;
    7581          218 :     bool        result = false;
    7582          218 :     LOCKMODE    wanted = tupleLockExtraInfo[lockmode].hwlock;
    7583              : 
    7584          218 :     if (HEAP_LOCKED_UPGRADED(infomask))
    7585            0 :         return false;
    7586              : 
    7587          218 :     nmembers = GetMultiXactIdMembers(multi, &members, false,
    7588          218 :                                      HEAP_XMAX_IS_LOCKED_ONLY(infomask));
    7589          218 :     if (nmembers >= 0)
    7590              :     {
    7591              :         int         i;
    7592              : 
    7593         2682 :         for (i = 0; i < nmembers; i++)
    7594              :         {
    7595              :             TransactionId memxid;
    7596              :             LOCKMODE    memlockmode;
    7597              : 
    7598         2471 :             if (result && (current_is_member == NULL || *current_is_member))
    7599              :                 break;
    7600              : 
    7601         2464 :             memlockmode = LOCKMODE_from_mxstatus(members[i].status);
    7602              : 
    7603              :             /* ignore members from current xact (but track their presence) */
    7604         2464 :             memxid = members[i].xid;
    7605         2464 :             if (TransactionIdIsCurrentTransactionId(memxid))
    7606              :             {
    7607           92 :                 if (current_is_member != NULL)
    7608           78 :                     *current_is_member = true;
    7609           92 :                 continue;
    7610              :             }
    7611         2372 :             else if (result)
    7612            8 :                 continue;
    7613              : 
    7614              :             /* ignore members that don't conflict with the lock we want */
    7615         2364 :             if (!DoLockModesConflict(memlockmode, wanted))
    7616         2325 :                 continue;
    7617              : 
    7618           39 :             if (ISUPDATE_from_mxstatus(members[i].status))
    7619              :             {
    7620              :                 /* ignore aborted updaters */
    7621           17 :                 if (TransactionIdDidAbort(memxid))
    7622            1 :                     continue;
    7623              :             }
    7624              :             else
    7625              :             {
    7626              :                 /* ignore lockers-only that are no longer in progress */
    7627           22 :                 if (!TransactionIdIsInProgress(memxid))
    7628            7 :                     continue;
    7629              :             }
    7630              : 
    7631              :             /*
    7632              :              * Whatever remains are either live lockers that conflict with our
    7633              :              * wanted lock, and updaters that are not aborted.  Those conflict
    7634              :              * with what we want.  Set up to return true, but keep going to
    7635              :              * look for the current transaction among the multixact members,
    7636              :              * if needed.
    7637              :              */
    7638           31 :             result = true;
    7639              :         }
    7640          218 :         pfree(members);
    7641              :     }
    7642              : 
    7643          218 :     return result;
    7644              : }
    7645              : 
    7646              : /*
    7647              :  * Do_MultiXactIdWait
    7648              :  *      Actual implementation for the two functions below.
    7649              :  *
    7650              :  * 'multi', 'status' and 'infomask' indicate what to sleep on (the status is
    7651              :  * needed to ensure we only sleep on conflicting members, and the infomask is
    7652              :  * used to optimize multixact access in case it's a lock-only multi); 'nowait'
    7653              :  * indicates whether to use conditional lock acquisition, to allow callers to
    7654              :  * fail if lock is unavailable.  'rel', 'ctid' and 'oper' are used to set up
    7655              :  * context information for error messages.  'remaining', if not NULL, receives
    7656              :  * the number of members that are still running, including any (non-aborted)
    7657              :  * subtransactions of our own transaction.  'logLockFailure' indicates whether
    7658              :  * to log details when a lock acquisition fails with 'nowait' enabled.
    7659              :  *
    7660              :  * We do this by sleeping on each member using XactLockTableWait.  Any
    7661              :  * members that belong to the current backend are *not* waited for, however;
    7662              :  * this would not merely be useless but would lead to Assert failure inside
    7663              :  * XactLockTableWait.  By the time this returns, it is certain that all
    7664              :  * transactions *of other backends* that were members of the MultiXactId
    7665              :  * that conflict with the requested status are dead (and no new ones can have
    7666              :  * been added, since it is not legal to add members to an existing
    7667              :  * MultiXactId).
    7668              :  *
    7669              :  * But by the time we finish sleeping, someone else may have changed the Xmax
    7670              :  * of the containing tuple, so the caller needs to iterate on us somehow.
    7671              :  *
    7672              :  * Note that in case we return false, the number of remaining members is
    7673              :  * not to be trusted.
    7674              :  */
    7675              : static bool
    7676           61 : Do_MultiXactIdWait(MultiXactId multi, MultiXactStatus status,
    7677              :                    uint16 infomask, bool nowait,
    7678              :                    Relation rel, const ItemPointerData *ctid, XLTW_Oper oper,
    7679              :                    int *remaining, bool logLockFailure)
    7680              : {
    7681           61 :     bool        result = true;
    7682              :     MultiXactMember *members;
    7683              :     int         nmembers;
    7684           61 :     int         remain = 0;
    7685              : 
    7686              :     /* for pre-pg_upgrade tuples, no need to sleep at all */
    7687           61 :     nmembers = HEAP_LOCKED_UPGRADED(infomask) ? -1 :
    7688           61 :         GetMultiXactIdMembers(multi, &members, false,
    7689           61 :                               HEAP_XMAX_IS_LOCKED_ONLY(infomask));
    7690              : 
    7691           61 :     if (nmembers >= 0)
    7692              :     {
    7693              :         int         i;
    7694              : 
    7695          192 :         for (i = 0; i < nmembers; i++)
    7696              :         {
    7697          137 :             TransactionId memxid = members[i].xid;
    7698          137 :             MultiXactStatus memstatus = members[i].status;
    7699              : 
    7700          137 :             if (TransactionIdIsCurrentTransactionId(memxid))
    7701              :             {
    7702           25 :                 remain++;
    7703           25 :                 continue;
    7704              :             }
    7705              : 
    7706          112 :             if (!DoLockModesConflict(LOCKMODE_from_mxstatus(memstatus),
    7707          112 :                                      LOCKMODE_from_mxstatus(status)))
    7708              :             {
    7709           22 :                 if (remaining && TransactionIdIsInProgress(memxid))
    7710            8 :                     remain++;
    7711           22 :                 continue;
    7712              :             }
    7713              : 
    7714              :             /*
    7715              :              * This member conflicts with our multi, so we have to sleep (or
    7716              :              * return failure, if asked to avoid waiting.)
    7717              :              *
    7718              :              * Note that we don't set up an error context callback ourselves,
    7719              :              * but instead we pass the info down to XactLockTableWait.  This
    7720              :              * might seem a bit wasteful because the context is set up and
    7721              :              * tore down for each member of the multixact, but in reality it
    7722              :              * should be barely noticeable, and it avoids duplicate code.
    7723              :              */
    7724           90 :             if (nowait)
    7725              :             {
    7726            6 :                 result = ConditionalXactLockTableWait(memxid, logLockFailure);
    7727            6 :                 if (!result)
    7728            6 :                     break;
    7729              :             }
    7730              :             else
    7731           84 :                 XactLockTableWait(memxid, rel, ctid, oper);
    7732              :         }
    7733              : 
    7734           61 :         pfree(members);
    7735              :     }
    7736              : 
    7737           61 :     if (remaining)
    7738           10 :         *remaining = remain;
    7739              : 
    7740           61 :     return result;
    7741              : }
    7742              : 
    7743              : /*
    7744              :  * MultiXactIdWait
    7745              :  *      Sleep on a MultiXactId.
    7746              :  *
    7747              :  * By the time we finish sleeping, someone else may have changed the Xmax
    7748              :  * of the containing tuple, so the caller needs to iterate on us somehow.
    7749              :  *
    7750              :  * We return (in *remaining, if not NULL) the number of members that are still
    7751              :  * running, including any (non-aborted) subtransactions of our own transaction.
    7752              :  */
    7753              : static void
    7754           55 : MultiXactIdWait(MultiXactId multi, MultiXactStatus status, uint16 infomask,
    7755              :                 Relation rel, const ItemPointerData *ctid, XLTW_Oper oper,
    7756              :                 int *remaining)
    7757              : {
    7758           55 :     (void) Do_MultiXactIdWait(multi, status, infomask, false,
    7759              :                               rel, ctid, oper, remaining, false);
    7760           55 : }
    7761              : 
    7762              : /*
    7763              :  * ConditionalMultiXactIdWait
    7764              :  *      As above, but only lock if we can get the lock without blocking.
    7765              :  *
    7766              :  * By the time we finish sleeping, someone else may have changed the Xmax
    7767              :  * of the containing tuple, so the caller needs to iterate on us somehow.
    7768              :  *
    7769              :  * If the multixact is now all gone, return true.  Returns false if some
    7770              :  * transactions might still be running.
    7771              :  *
    7772              :  * We return (in *remaining, if not NULL) the number of members that are still
    7773              :  * running, including any (non-aborted) subtransactions of our own transaction.
    7774              :  */
    7775              : static bool
    7776            6 : ConditionalMultiXactIdWait(MultiXactId multi, MultiXactStatus status,
    7777              :                            uint16 infomask, Relation rel, int *remaining,
    7778              :                            bool logLockFailure)
    7779              : {
    7780            6 :     return Do_MultiXactIdWait(multi, status, infomask, true,
    7781              :                               rel, NULL, XLTW_None, remaining, logLockFailure);
    7782              : }
    7783              : 
    7784              : /*
    7785              :  * heap_tuple_needs_eventual_freeze
    7786              :  *
    7787              :  * Check to see whether any of the XID fields of a tuple (xmin, xmax, xvac)
    7788              :  * will eventually require freezing (if tuple isn't removed by pruning first).
    7789              :  */
    7790              : bool
    7791       114574 : heap_tuple_needs_eventual_freeze(HeapTupleHeader tuple)
    7792              : {
    7793              :     TransactionId xid;
    7794              : 
    7795              :     /*
    7796              :      * If xmin is a normal transaction ID, this tuple is definitely not
    7797              :      * frozen.
    7798              :      */
    7799       114574 :     xid = HeapTupleHeaderGetXmin(tuple);
    7800       114574 :     if (TransactionIdIsNormal(xid))
    7801         3008 :         return true;
    7802              : 
    7803              :     /*
    7804              :      * If xmax is a valid xact or multixact, this tuple is also not frozen.
    7805              :      */
    7806       111566 :     if (tuple->t_infomask & HEAP_XMAX_IS_MULTI)
    7807              :     {
    7808              :         MultiXactId multi;
    7809              : 
    7810            0 :         multi = HeapTupleHeaderGetRawXmax(tuple);
    7811            0 :         if (MultiXactIdIsValid(multi))
    7812            0 :             return true;
    7813              :     }
    7814              :     else
    7815              :     {
    7816       111566 :         xid = HeapTupleHeaderGetRawXmax(tuple);
    7817       111566 :         if (TransactionIdIsNormal(xid))
    7818            7 :             return true;
    7819              :     }
    7820              : 
    7821       111559 :     if (tuple->t_infomask & HEAP_MOVED)
    7822              :     {
    7823            0 :         xid = HeapTupleHeaderGetXvac(tuple);
    7824            0 :         if (TransactionIdIsNormal(xid))
    7825            0 :             return true;
    7826              :     }
    7827              : 
    7828       111559 :     return false;
    7829              : }
    7830              : 
    7831              : /*
    7832              :  * heap_tuple_should_freeze
    7833              :  *
    7834              :  * Return value indicates if heap_prepare_freeze_tuple sibling function would
    7835              :  * (or should) force freezing of the heap page that contains caller's tuple.
    7836              :  * Tuple header XIDs/MXIDs < FreezeLimit/MultiXactCutoff trigger freezing.
    7837              :  * This includes (xmin, xmax, xvac) fields, as well as MultiXact member XIDs.
    7838              :  *
    7839              :  * The *NoFreezePageRelfrozenXid and *NoFreezePageRelminMxid input/output
    7840              :  * arguments help VACUUM track the oldest extant XID/MXID remaining in rel.
    7841              :  * Our working assumption is that caller won't decide to freeze this tuple.
    7842              :  * It's up to caller to only ratchet back its own top-level trackers after the
    7843              :  * point that it fully commits to not freezing the tuple/page in question.
    7844              :  */
    7845              : bool
    7846      7597247 : heap_tuple_should_freeze(HeapTupleHeader tuple,
    7847              :                          const struct VacuumCutoffs *cutoffs,
    7848              :                          TransactionId *NoFreezePageRelfrozenXid,
    7849              :                          MultiXactId *NoFreezePageRelminMxid)
    7850              : {
    7851              :     TransactionId xid;
    7852              :     MultiXactId multi;
    7853      7597247 :     bool        freeze = false;
    7854              : 
    7855              :     /* First deal with xmin */
    7856      7597247 :     xid = HeapTupleHeaderGetXmin(tuple);
    7857      7597247 :     if (TransactionIdIsNormal(xid))
    7858              :     {
    7859              :         Assert(TransactionIdPrecedesOrEquals(cutoffs->relfrozenxid, xid));
    7860      2508207 :         if (TransactionIdPrecedes(xid, *NoFreezePageRelfrozenXid))
    7861        25792 :             *NoFreezePageRelfrozenXid = xid;
    7862      2508207 :         if (TransactionIdPrecedes(xid, cutoffs->FreezeLimit))
    7863        23652 :             freeze = true;
    7864              :     }
    7865              : 
    7866              :     /* Now deal with xmax */
    7867      7597247 :     xid = InvalidTransactionId;
    7868      7597247 :     multi = InvalidMultiXactId;
    7869      7597247 :     if (tuple->t_infomask & HEAP_XMAX_IS_MULTI)
    7870            2 :         multi = HeapTupleHeaderGetRawXmax(tuple);
    7871              :     else
    7872      7597245 :         xid = HeapTupleHeaderGetRawXmax(tuple);
    7873              : 
    7874      7597247 :     if (TransactionIdIsNormal(xid))
    7875              :     {
    7876              :         Assert(TransactionIdPrecedesOrEquals(cutoffs->relfrozenxid, xid));
    7877              :         /* xmax is a non-permanent XID */
    7878      5415054 :         if (TransactionIdPrecedes(xid, *NoFreezePageRelfrozenXid))
    7879            1 :             *NoFreezePageRelfrozenXid = xid;
    7880      5415054 :         if (TransactionIdPrecedes(xid, cutoffs->FreezeLimit))
    7881           17 :             freeze = true;
    7882              :     }
    7883      2182193 :     else if (!MultiXactIdIsValid(multi))
    7884              :     {
    7885              :         /* xmax is a permanent XID or invalid MultiXactId/XID */
    7886              :     }
    7887            2 :     else if (HEAP_LOCKED_UPGRADED(tuple->t_infomask))
    7888              :     {
    7889              :         /* xmax is a pg_upgrade'd MultiXact, which can't have updater XID */
    7890            0 :         if (MultiXactIdPrecedes(multi, *NoFreezePageRelminMxid))
    7891            0 :             *NoFreezePageRelminMxid = multi;
    7892              :         /* heap_prepare_freeze_tuple always freezes pg_upgrade'd xmax */
    7893            0 :         freeze = true;
    7894              :     }
    7895              :     else
    7896              :     {
    7897              :         /* xmax is a MultiXactId that may have an updater XID */
    7898              :         MultiXactMember *members;
    7899              :         int         nmembers;
    7900              : 
    7901              :         Assert(MultiXactIdPrecedesOrEquals(cutoffs->relminmxid, multi));
    7902            2 :         if (MultiXactIdPrecedes(multi, *NoFreezePageRelminMxid))
    7903            2 :             *NoFreezePageRelminMxid = multi;
    7904            2 :         if (MultiXactIdPrecedes(multi, cutoffs->MultiXactCutoff))
    7905            2 :             freeze = true;
    7906              : 
    7907              :         /* need to check whether any member of the mxact is old */
    7908            2 :         nmembers = GetMultiXactIdMembers(multi, &members, false,
    7909            2 :                                          HEAP_XMAX_IS_LOCKED_ONLY(tuple->t_infomask));
    7910              : 
    7911            5 :         for (int i = 0; i < nmembers; i++)
    7912              :         {
    7913            3 :             xid = members[i].xid;
    7914              :             Assert(TransactionIdPrecedesOrEquals(cutoffs->relfrozenxid, xid));
    7915            3 :             if (TransactionIdPrecedes(xid, *NoFreezePageRelfrozenXid))
    7916            0 :                 *NoFreezePageRelfrozenXid = xid;
    7917            3 :             if (TransactionIdPrecedes(xid, cutoffs->FreezeLimit))
    7918            0 :                 freeze = true;
    7919              :         }
    7920            2 :         if (nmembers > 0)
    7921            1 :             pfree(members);
    7922              :     }
    7923              : 
    7924      7597247 :     if (tuple->t_infomask & HEAP_MOVED)
    7925              :     {
    7926            0 :         xid = HeapTupleHeaderGetXvac(tuple);
    7927            0 :         if (TransactionIdIsNormal(xid))
    7928              :         {
    7929              :             Assert(TransactionIdPrecedesOrEquals(cutoffs->relfrozenxid, xid));
    7930            0 :             if (TransactionIdPrecedes(xid, *NoFreezePageRelfrozenXid))
    7931            0 :                 *NoFreezePageRelfrozenXid = xid;
    7932              :             /* heap_prepare_freeze_tuple forces xvac freezing */
    7933            0 :             freeze = true;
    7934              :         }
    7935              :     }
    7936              : 
    7937      7597247 :     return freeze;
    7938              : }
    7939              : 
    7940              : /*
    7941              :  * Maintain snapshotConflictHorizon for caller by ratcheting forward its value
    7942              :  * using any committed XIDs contained in 'tuple', an obsolescent heap tuple
    7943              :  * that caller is in the process of physically removing, e.g. via HOT pruning
    7944              :  * or index deletion.
    7945              :  *
    7946              :  * Caller must initialize its value to InvalidTransactionId, which is
    7947              :  * generally interpreted as "definitely no need for a recovery conflict".
    7948              :  * Final value must reflect all heap tuples that caller will physically remove
    7949              :  * (or remove TID references to) via its ongoing pruning/deletion operation.
    7950              :  * ResolveRecoveryConflictWithSnapshot() is passed the final value (taken from
    7951              :  * caller's WAL record) by REDO routine when it replays caller's operation.
    7952              :  */
    7953              : void
    7954      3981609 : HeapTupleHeaderAdvanceConflictHorizon(HeapTupleHeader tuple,
    7955              :                                       TransactionId *snapshotConflictHorizon)
    7956              : {
    7957      3981609 :     TransactionId xmin = HeapTupleHeaderGetXmin(tuple);
    7958      3981609 :     TransactionId xmax = HeapTupleHeaderGetUpdateXid(tuple);
    7959      3981609 :     TransactionId xvac = HeapTupleHeaderGetXvac(tuple);
    7960              : 
    7961      3981609 :     if (tuple->t_infomask & HEAP_MOVED)
    7962              :     {
    7963            0 :         if (TransactionIdPrecedes(*snapshotConflictHorizon, xvac))
    7964            0 :             *snapshotConflictHorizon = xvac;
    7965              :     }
    7966              : 
    7967              :     /*
    7968              :      * Ignore tuples inserted by an aborted transaction or if the tuple was
    7969              :      * updated/deleted by the inserting transaction.
    7970              :      *
    7971              :      * Look for a committed hint bit, or if no xmin bit is set, check clog.
    7972              :      */
    7973      3981609 :     if (HeapTupleHeaderXminCommitted(tuple) ||
    7974       131349 :         (!HeapTupleHeaderXminInvalid(tuple) && TransactionIdDidCommit(xmin)))
    7975              :     {
    7976      7511759 :         if (xmax != xmin &&
    7977      3656255 :             TransactionIdFollows(xmax, *snapshotConflictHorizon))
    7978       130698 :             *snapshotConflictHorizon = xmax;
    7979              :     }
    7980      3981609 : }
    7981              : 
    7982              : #ifdef USE_PREFETCH
    7983              : /*
    7984              :  * Helper function for heap_index_delete_tuples.  Issues prefetch requests for
    7985              :  * prefetch_count buffers.  The prefetch_state keeps track of all the buffers
    7986              :  * we can prefetch, and which have already been prefetched; each call to this
    7987              :  * function picks up where the previous call left off.
    7988              :  *
    7989              :  * Note: we expect the deltids array to be sorted in an order that groups TIDs
    7990              :  * by heap block, with all TIDs for each block appearing together in exactly
    7991              :  * one group.
    7992              :  */
    7993              : static void
    7994        27535 : index_delete_prefetch_buffer(Relation rel,
    7995              :                              IndexDeletePrefetchState *prefetch_state,
    7996              :                              int prefetch_count)
    7997              : {
    7998        27535 :     BlockNumber cur_hblkno = prefetch_state->cur_hblkno;
    7999        27535 :     int         count = 0;
    8000              :     int         i;
    8001        27535 :     int         ndeltids = prefetch_state->ndeltids;
    8002        27535 :     TM_IndexDelete *deltids = prefetch_state->deltids;
    8003              : 
    8004        27535 :     for (i = prefetch_state->next_item;
    8005       971354 :          i < ndeltids && count < prefetch_count;
    8006       943819 :          i++)
    8007              :     {
    8008       943819 :         ItemPointer htid = &deltids[i].tid;
    8009              : 
    8010      1879198 :         if (cur_hblkno == InvalidBlockNumber ||
    8011       935379 :             ItemPointerGetBlockNumber(htid) != cur_hblkno)
    8012              :         {
    8013        24748 :             cur_hblkno = ItemPointerGetBlockNumber(htid);
    8014        24748 :             PrefetchBuffer(rel, MAIN_FORKNUM, cur_hblkno);
    8015        24748 :             count++;
    8016              :         }
    8017              :     }
    8018              : 
    8019              :     /*
    8020              :      * Save the prefetch position so that next time we can continue from that
    8021              :      * position.
    8022              :      */
    8023        27535 :     prefetch_state->next_item = i;
    8024        27535 :     prefetch_state->cur_hblkno = cur_hblkno;
    8025        27535 : }
    8026              : #endif
    8027              : 
    8028              : /*
    8029              :  * Helper function for heap_index_delete_tuples.  Checks for index corruption
    8030              :  * involving an invalid TID in index AM caller's index page.
    8031              :  *
    8032              :  * This is an ideal place for these checks.  The index AM must hold a buffer
    8033              :  * lock on the index page containing the TIDs we examine here, so we don't
    8034              :  * have to worry about concurrent VACUUMs at all.  We can be sure that the
    8035              :  * index is corrupt when htid points directly to an LP_UNUSED item or
    8036              :  * heap-only tuple, which is not the case during standard index scans.
    8037              :  */
    8038              : static inline void
    8039       783565 : index_delete_check_htid(TM_IndexDeleteOp *delstate,
    8040              :                         Page page, OffsetNumber maxoff,
    8041              :                         const ItemPointerData *htid, TM_IndexStatus *istatus)
    8042              : {
    8043       783565 :     OffsetNumber indexpagehoffnum = ItemPointerGetOffsetNumber(htid);
    8044              :     ItemId      iid;
    8045              : 
    8046              :     Assert(OffsetNumberIsValid(istatus->idxoffnum));
    8047              : 
    8048       783565 :     if (unlikely(indexpagehoffnum > maxoff))
    8049            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    8050              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_INDEX_CORRUPTED),
    8051              :                  errmsg_internal("heap tid from index tuple (%u,%u) points past end of heap page line pointer array at offset %u of block %u in index \"%s\"",
    8052              :                                  ItemPointerGetBlockNumber(htid),
    8053              :                                  indexpagehoffnum,
    8054              :                                  istatus->idxoffnum, delstate->iblknum,
    8055              :                                  RelationGetRelationName(delstate->irel))));
    8056              : 
    8057       783565 :     iid = PageGetItemId(page, indexpagehoffnum);
    8058       783565 :     if (unlikely(!ItemIdIsUsed(iid)))
    8059            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    8060              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_INDEX_CORRUPTED),
    8061              :                  errmsg_internal("heap tid from index tuple (%u,%u) points to unused heap page item at offset %u of block %u in index \"%s\"",
    8062              :                                  ItemPointerGetBlockNumber(htid),
    8063              :                                  indexpagehoffnum,
    8064              :                                  istatus->idxoffnum, delstate->iblknum,
    8065              :                                  RelationGetRelationName(delstate->irel))));
    8066              : 
    8067       783565 :     if (ItemIdHasStorage(iid))
    8068              :     {
    8069              :         HeapTupleHeader htup;
    8070              : 
    8071              :         Assert(ItemIdIsNormal(iid));
    8072       481889 :         htup = (HeapTupleHeader) PageGetItem(page, iid);
    8073              : 
    8074       481889 :         if (unlikely(HeapTupleHeaderIsHeapOnly(htup)))
    8075            0 :             ereport(ERROR,
    8076              :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_INDEX_CORRUPTED),
    8077              :                      errmsg_internal("heap tid from index tuple (%u,%u) points to heap-only tuple at offset %u of block %u in index \"%s\"",
    8078              :                                      ItemPointerGetBlockNumber(htid),
    8079              :                                      indexpagehoffnum,
    8080              :                                      istatus->idxoffnum, delstate->iblknum,
    8081              :                                      RelationGetRelationName(delstate->irel))));
    8082              :     }
    8083       783565 : }
    8084              : 
    8085              : /*
    8086              :  * heapam implementation of tableam's index_delete_tuples interface.
    8087              :  *
    8088              :  * This helper function is called by index AMs during index tuple deletion.
    8089              :  * See tableam header comments for an explanation of the interface implemented
    8090              :  * here and a general theory of operation.  Note that each call here is either
    8091              :  * a simple index deletion call, or a bottom-up index deletion call.
    8092              :  *
    8093              :  * It's possible for this to generate a fair amount of I/O, since we may be
    8094              :  * deleting hundreds of tuples from a single index block.  To amortize that
    8095              :  * cost to some degree, this uses prefetching and combines repeat accesses to
    8096              :  * the same heap block.
    8097              :  */
    8098              : TransactionId
    8099         8440 : heap_index_delete_tuples(Relation rel, TM_IndexDeleteOp *delstate)
    8100              : {
    8101              :     /* Initial assumption is that earlier pruning took care of conflict */
    8102         8440 :     TransactionId snapshotConflictHorizon = InvalidTransactionId;
    8103         8440 :     BlockNumber blkno = InvalidBlockNumber;
    8104         8440 :     Buffer      buf = InvalidBuffer;
    8105         8440 :     Page        page = NULL;
    8106         8440 :     OffsetNumber maxoff = InvalidOffsetNumber;
    8107              :     TransactionId priorXmax;
    8108              : #ifdef USE_PREFETCH
    8109              :     IndexDeletePrefetchState prefetch_state;
    8110              :     int         prefetch_distance;
    8111              : #endif
    8112              :     SnapshotData SnapshotNonVacuumable;
    8113         8440 :     int         finalndeltids = 0,
    8114         8440 :                 nblocksaccessed = 0;
    8115              : 
    8116              :     /* State that's only used in bottom-up index deletion case */
    8117         8440 :     int         nblocksfavorable = 0;
    8118         8440 :     int         curtargetfreespace = delstate->bottomupfreespace,
    8119         8440 :                 lastfreespace = 0,
    8120         8440 :                 actualfreespace = 0;
    8121         8440 :     bool        bottomup_final_block = false;
    8122              : 
    8123         8440 :     InitNonVacuumableSnapshot(SnapshotNonVacuumable, GlobalVisTestFor(rel));
    8124              : 
    8125              :     /* Sort caller's deltids array by TID for further processing */
    8126         8440 :     index_delete_sort(delstate);
    8127              : 
    8128              :     /*
    8129              :      * Bottom-up case: resort deltids array in an order attuned to where the
    8130              :      * greatest number of promising TIDs are to be found, and determine how
    8131              :      * many blocks from the start of sorted array should be considered
    8132              :      * favorable.  This will also shrink the deltids array in order to
    8133              :      * eliminate completely unfavorable blocks up front.
    8134              :      */
    8135         8440 :     if (delstate->bottomup)
    8136         2903 :         nblocksfavorable = bottomup_sort_and_shrink(delstate);
    8137              : 
    8138              : #ifdef USE_PREFETCH
    8139              :     /* Initialize prefetch state. */
    8140         8440 :     prefetch_state.cur_hblkno = InvalidBlockNumber;
    8141         8440 :     prefetch_state.next_item = 0;
    8142         8440 :     prefetch_state.ndeltids = delstate->ndeltids;
    8143         8440 :     prefetch_state.deltids = delstate->deltids;
    8144              : 
    8145              :     /*
    8146              :      * Determine the prefetch distance that we will attempt to maintain.
    8147              :      *
    8148              :      * Since the caller holds a buffer lock somewhere in rel, we'd better make
    8149              :      * sure that isn't a catalog relation before we call code that does
    8150              :      * syscache lookups, to avoid risk of deadlock.
    8151              :      */
    8152         8440 :     if (IsCatalogRelation(rel))
    8153         6111 :         prefetch_distance = maintenance_io_concurrency;
    8154              :     else
    8155              :         prefetch_distance =
    8156         2329 :             get_tablespace_maintenance_io_concurrency(rel->rd_rel->reltablespace);
    8157              : 
    8158              :     /* Cap initial prefetch distance for bottom-up deletion caller */
    8159         8440 :     if (delstate->bottomup)
    8160              :     {
    8161              :         Assert(nblocksfavorable >= 1);
    8162              :         Assert(nblocksfavorable <= BOTTOMUP_MAX_NBLOCKS);
    8163         2903 :         prefetch_distance = Min(prefetch_distance, nblocksfavorable);
    8164              :     }
    8165              : 
    8166              :     /* Start prefetching. */
    8167         8440 :     index_delete_prefetch_buffer(rel, &prefetch_state, prefetch_distance);
    8168              : #endif
    8169              : 
    8170              :     /* Iterate over deltids, determine which to delete, check their horizon */
    8171              :     Assert(delstate->ndeltids > 0);
    8172       792005 :     for (int i = 0; i < delstate->ndeltids; i++)
    8173              :     {
    8174       786468 :         TM_IndexDelete *ideltid = &delstate->deltids[i];
    8175       786468 :         TM_IndexStatus *istatus = delstate->status + ideltid->id;
    8176       786468 :         ItemPointer htid = &ideltid->tid;
    8177              :         OffsetNumber offnum;
    8178              : 
    8179              :         /*
    8180              :          * Read buffer, and perform required extra steps each time a new block
    8181              :          * is encountered.  Avoid refetching if it's the same block as the one
    8182              :          * from the last htid.
    8183              :          */
    8184      1564496 :         if (blkno == InvalidBlockNumber ||
    8185       778028 :             ItemPointerGetBlockNumber(htid) != blkno)
    8186              :         {
    8187              :             /*
    8188              :              * Consider giving up early for bottom-up index deletion caller
    8189              :              * first. (Only prefetch next-next block afterwards, when it
    8190              :              * becomes clear that we're at least going to access the next
    8191              :              * block in line.)
    8192              :              *
    8193              :              * Sometimes the first block frees so much space for bottom-up
    8194              :              * caller that the deletion process can end without accessing any
    8195              :              * more blocks.  It is usually necessary to access 2 or 3 blocks
    8196              :              * per bottom-up deletion operation, though.
    8197              :              */
    8198        21998 :             if (delstate->bottomup)
    8199              :             {
    8200              :                 /*
    8201              :                  * We often allow caller to delete a few additional items
    8202              :                  * whose entries we reached after the point that space target
    8203              :                  * from caller was satisfied.  The cost of accessing the page
    8204              :                  * was already paid at that point, so it made sense to finish
    8205              :                  * it off.  When that happened, we finalize everything here
    8206              :                  * (by finishing off the whole bottom-up deletion operation
    8207              :                  * without needlessly paying the cost of accessing any more
    8208              :                  * blocks).
    8209              :                  */
    8210         6203 :                 if (bottomup_final_block)
    8211          142 :                     break;
    8212              : 
    8213              :                 /*
    8214              :                  * Give up when we didn't enable our caller to free any
    8215              :                  * additional space as a result of processing the page that we
    8216              :                  * just finished up with.  This rule is the main way in which
    8217              :                  * we keep the cost of bottom-up deletion under control.
    8218              :                  */
    8219         6061 :                 if (nblocksaccessed >= 1 && actualfreespace == lastfreespace)
    8220         2761 :                     break;
    8221         3300 :                 lastfreespace = actualfreespace;    /* for next time */
    8222              : 
    8223              :                 /*
    8224              :                  * Deletion operation (which is bottom-up) will definitely
    8225              :                  * access the next block in line.  Prepare for that now.
    8226              :                  *
    8227              :                  * Decay target free space so that we don't hang on for too
    8228              :                  * long with a marginal case. (Space target is only truly
    8229              :                  * helpful when it allows us to recognize that we don't need
    8230              :                  * to access more than 1 or 2 blocks to satisfy caller due to
    8231              :                  * agreeable workload characteristics.)
    8232              :                  *
    8233              :                  * We are a bit more patient when we encounter contiguous
    8234              :                  * blocks, though: these are treated as favorable blocks.  The
    8235              :                  * decay process is only applied when the next block in line
    8236              :                  * is not a favorable/contiguous block.  This is not an
    8237              :                  * exception to the general rule; we still insist on finding
    8238              :                  * at least one deletable item per block accessed.  See
    8239              :                  * bottomup_nblocksfavorable() for full details of the theory
    8240              :                  * behind favorable blocks and heap block locality in general.
    8241              :                  *
    8242              :                  * Note: The first block in line is always treated as a
    8243              :                  * favorable block, so the earliest possible point that the
    8244              :                  * decay can be applied is just before we access the second
    8245              :                  * block in line.  The Assert() verifies this for us.
    8246              :                  */
    8247              :                 Assert(nblocksaccessed > 0 || nblocksfavorable > 0);
    8248         3300 :                 if (nblocksfavorable > 0)
    8249         3074 :                     nblocksfavorable--;
    8250              :                 else
    8251          226 :                     curtargetfreespace /= 2;
    8252              :             }
    8253              : 
    8254              :             /* release old buffer */
    8255        19095 :             if (BufferIsValid(buf))
    8256        10655 :                 UnlockReleaseBuffer(buf);
    8257              : 
    8258        19095 :             blkno = ItemPointerGetBlockNumber(htid);
    8259        19095 :             buf = ReadBuffer(rel, blkno);
    8260        19095 :             nblocksaccessed++;
    8261              :             Assert(!delstate->bottomup ||
    8262              :                    nblocksaccessed <= BOTTOMUP_MAX_NBLOCKS);
    8263              : 
    8264              : #ifdef USE_PREFETCH
    8265              : 
    8266              :             /*
    8267              :              * To maintain the prefetch distance, prefetch one more page for
    8268              :              * each page we read.
    8269              :              */
    8270        19095 :             index_delete_prefetch_buffer(rel, &prefetch_state, 1);
    8271              : #endif
    8272              : 
    8273        19095 :             LockBuffer(buf, BUFFER_LOCK_SHARE);
    8274              : 
    8275        19095 :             page = BufferGetPage(buf);
    8276        19095 :             maxoff = PageGetMaxOffsetNumber(page);
    8277              :         }
    8278              : 
    8279              :         /*
    8280              :          * In passing, detect index corruption involving an index page with a
    8281              :          * TID that points to a location in the heap that couldn't possibly be
    8282              :          * correct.  We only do this with actual TIDs from caller's index page
    8283              :          * (not items reached by traversing through a HOT chain).
    8284              :          */
    8285       783565 :         index_delete_check_htid(delstate, page, maxoff, htid, istatus);
    8286              : 
    8287       783565 :         if (istatus->knowndeletable)
    8288              :             Assert(!delstate->bottomup && !istatus->promising);
    8289              :         else
    8290              :         {
    8291       614914 :             ItemPointerData tmp = *htid;
    8292              :             HeapTupleData heapTuple;
    8293              : 
    8294              :             /* Are any tuples from this HOT chain non-vacuumable? */
    8295       614914 :             if (heap_hot_search_buffer(&tmp, rel, buf, &SnapshotNonVacuumable,
    8296              :                                        &heapTuple, NULL, true))
    8297       371842 :                 continue;       /* can't delete entry */
    8298              : 
    8299              :             /* Caller will delete, since whole HOT chain is vacuumable */
    8300       243072 :             istatus->knowndeletable = true;
    8301              : 
    8302              :             /* Maintain index free space info for bottom-up deletion case */
    8303       243072 :             if (delstate->bottomup)
    8304              :             {
    8305              :                 Assert(istatus->freespace > 0);
    8306        10041 :                 actualfreespace += istatus->freespace;
    8307        10041 :                 if (actualfreespace >= curtargetfreespace)
    8308         2409 :                     bottomup_final_block = true;
    8309              :             }
    8310              :         }
    8311              : 
    8312              :         /*
    8313              :          * Maintain snapshotConflictHorizon value for deletion operation as a
    8314              :          * whole by advancing current value using heap tuple headers.  This is
    8315              :          * loosely based on the logic for pruning a HOT chain.
    8316              :          */
    8317       411723 :         offnum = ItemPointerGetOffsetNumber(htid);
    8318       411723 :         priorXmax = InvalidTransactionId;   /* cannot check first XMIN */
    8319              :         for (;;)
    8320        23736 :         {
    8321              :             ItemId      lp;
    8322              :             HeapTupleHeader htup;
    8323              : 
    8324              :             /* Sanity check (pure paranoia) */
    8325       435459 :             if (offnum < FirstOffsetNumber)
    8326            0 :                 break;
    8327              : 
    8328              :             /*
    8329              :              * An offset past the end of page's line pointer array is possible
    8330              :              * when the array was truncated
    8331              :              */
    8332       435459 :             if (offnum > maxoff)
    8333            0 :                 break;
    8334              : 
    8335       435459 :             lp = PageGetItemId(page, offnum);
    8336       435459 :             if (ItemIdIsRedirected(lp))
    8337              :             {
    8338        11519 :                 offnum = ItemIdGetRedirect(lp);
    8339        11519 :                 continue;
    8340              :             }
    8341              : 
    8342              :             /*
    8343              :              * We'll often encounter LP_DEAD line pointers (especially with an
    8344              :              * entry marked knowndeletable by our caller up front).  No heap
    8345              :              * tuple headers get examined for an htid that leads us to an
    8346              :              * LP_DEAD item.  This is okay because the earlier pruning
    8347              :              * operation that made the line pointer LP_DEAD in the first place
    8348              :              * must have considered the original tuple header as part of
    8349              :              * generating its own snapshotConflictHorizon value.
    8350              :              *
    8351              :              * Relying on XLOG_HEAP2_PRUNE_VACUUM_SCAN records like this is
    8352              :              * the same strategy that index vacuuming uses in all cases. Index
    8353              :              * VACUUM WAL records don't even have a snapshotConflictHorizon
    8354              :              * field of their own for this reason.
    8355              :              */
    8356       423940 :             if (!ItemIdIsNormal(lp))
    8357       274330 :                 break;
    8358              : 
    8359       149610 :             htup = (HeapTupleHeader) PageGetItem(page, lp);
    8360              : 
    8361              :             /*
    8362              :              * Check the tuple XMIN against prior XMAX, if any
    8363              :              */
    8364       161827 :             if (TransactionIdIsValid(priorXmax) &&
    8365        12217 :                 !TransactionIdEquals(HeapTupleHeaderGetXmin(htup), priorXmax))
    8366            0 :                 break;
    8367              : 
    8368       149610 :             HeapTupleHeaderAdvanceConflictHorizon(htup,
    8369              :                                                   &snapshotConflictHorizon);
    8370              : 
    8371              :             /*
    8372              :              * If the tuple is not HOT-updated, then we are at the end of this
    8373              :              * HOT-chain.  No need to visit later tuples from the same update
    8374              :              * chain (they get their own index entries) -- just move on to
    8375              :              * next htid from index AM caller.
    8376              :              */
    8377       149610 :             if (!HeapTupleHeaderIsHotUpdated(htup))
    8378       137393 :                 break;
    8379              : 
    8380              :             /* Advance to next HOT chain member */
    8381              :             Assert(ItemPointerGetBlockNumber(&htup->t_ctid) == blkno);
    8382        12217 :             offnum = ItemPointerGetOffsetNumber(&htup->t_ctid);
    8383        12217 :             priorXmax = HeapTupleHeaderGetUpdateXid(htup);
    8384              :         }
    8385              : 
    8386              :         /* Enable further/final shrinking of deltids for caller */
    8387       411723 :         finalndeltids = i + 1;
    8388              :     }
    8389              : 
    8390         8440 :     UnlockReleaseBuffer(buf);
    8391              : 
    8392              :     /*
    8393              :      * Shrink deltids array to exclude non-deletable entries at the end.  This
    8394              :      * is not just a minor optimization.  Final deltids array size might be
    8395              :      * zero for a bottom-up caller.  Index AM is explicitly allowed to rely on
    8396              :      * ndeltids being zero in all cases with zero total deletable entries.
    8397              :      */
    8398              :     Assert(finalndeltids > 0 || delstate->bottomup);
    8399         8440 :     delstate->ndeltids = finalndeltids;
    8400              : 
    8401         8440 :     return snapshotConflictHorizon;
    8402              : }
    8403              : 
    8404              : /*
    8405              :  * Specialized inlineable comparison function for index_delete_sort()
    8406              :  */
    8407              : static inline int
    8408     18186204 : index_delete_sort_cmp(TM_IndexDelete *deltid1, TM_IndexDelete *deltid2)
    8409              : {
    8410     18186204 :     ItemPointer tid1 = &deltid1->tid;
    8411     18186204 :     ItemPointer tid2 = &deltid2->tid;
    8412              : 
    8413              :     {
    8414     18186204 :         BlockNumber blk1 = ItemPointerGetBlockNumber(tid1);
    8415     18186204 :         BlockNumber blk2 = ItemPointerGetBlockNumber(tid2);
    8416              : 
    8417     18186204 :         if (blk1 != blk2)
    8418      7214455 :             return (blk1 < blk2) ? -1 : 1;
    8419              :     }
    8420              :     {
    8421     10971749 :         OffsetNumber pos1 = ItemPointerGetOffsetNumber(tid1);
    8422     10971749 :         OffsetNumber pos2 = ItemPointerGetOffsetNumber(tid2);
    8423              : 
    8424     10971749 :         if (pos1 != pos2)
    8425     10971749 :             return (pos1 < pos2) ? -1 : 1;
    8426              :     }
    8427              : 
    8428              :     Assert(false);
    8429              : 
    8430            0 :     return 0;
    8431              : }
    8432              : 
    8433              : /*
    8434              :  * Sort deltids array from delstate by TID.  This prepares it for further
    8435              :  * processing by heap_index_delete_tuples().
    8436              :  *
    8437              :  * This operation becomes a noticeable consumer of CPU cycles with some
    8438              :  * workloads, so we go to the trouble of specialization/micro optimization.
    8439              :  * We use shellsort for this because it's easy to specialize, compiles to
    8440              :  * relatively few instructions, and is adaptive to presorted inputs/subsets
    8441              :  * (which are typical here).
    8442              :  */
    8443              : static void
    8444         8440 : index_delete_sort(TM_IndexDeleteOp *delstate)
    8445              : {
    8446         8440 :     TM_IndexDelete *deltids = delstate->deltids;
    8447         8440 :     int         ndeltids = delstate->ndeltids;
    8448              : 
    8449              :     /*
    8450              :      * Shellsort gap sequence (taken from Sedgewick-Incerpi paper).
    8451              :      *
    8452              :      * This implementation is fast with array sizes up to ~4500.  This covers
    8453              :      * all supported BLCKSZ values.
    8454              :      */
    8455         8440 :     const int   gaps[9] = {1968, 861, 336, 112, 48, 21, 7, 3, 1};
    8456              : 
    8457              :     /* Think carefully before changing anything here -- keep swaps cheap */
    8458              :     StaticAssertDecl(sizeof(TM_IndexDelete) <= 8,
    8459              :                      "element size exceeds 8 bytes");
    8460              : 
    8461        84400 :     for (int g = 0; g < lengthof(gaps); g++)
    8462              :     {
    8463     11015773 :         for (int hi = gaps[g], i = hi; i < ndeltids; i++)
    8464              :         {
    8465     10939813 :             TM_IndexDelete d = deltids[i];
    8466     10939813 :             int         j = i;
    8467              : 
    8468     18713165 :             while (j >= hi && index_delete_sort_cmp(&deltids[j - hi], &d) >= 0)
    8469              :             {
    8470      7773352 :                 deltids[j] = deltids[j - hi];
    8471      7773352 :                 j -= hi;
    8472              :             }
    8473     10939813 :             deltids[j] = d;
    8474              :         }
    8475              :     }
    8476         8440 : }
    8477              : 
    8478              : /*
    8479              :  * Returns how many blocks should be considered favorable/contiguous for a
    8480              :  * bottom-up index deletion pass.  This is a number of heap blocks that starts
    8481              :  * from and includes the first block in line.
    8482              :  *
    8483              :  * There is always at least one favorable block during bottom-up index
    8484              :  * deletion.  In the worst case (i.e. with totally random heap blocks) the
    8485              :  * first block in line (the only favorable block) can be thought of as a
    8486              :  * degenerate array of contiguous blocks that consists of a single block.
    8487              :  * heap_index_delete_tuples() will expect this.
    8488              :  *
    8489              :  * Caller passes blockgroups, a description of the final order that deltids
    8490              :  * will be sorted in for heap_index_delete_tuples() bottom-up index deletion
    8491              :  * processing.  Note that deltids need not actually be sorted just yet (caller
    8492              :  * only passes deltids to us so that we can interpret blockgroups).
    8493              :  *
    8494              :  * You might guess that the existence of contiguous blocks cannot matter much,
    8495              :  * since in general the main factor that determines which blocks we visit is
    8496              :  * the number of promising TIDs, which is a fixed hint from the index AM.
    8497              :  * We're not really targeting the general case, though -- the actual goal is
    8498              :  * to adapt our behavior to a wide variety of naturally occurring conditions.
    8499              :  * The effects of most of the heuristics we apply are only noticeable in the
    8500              :  * aggregate, over time and across many _related_ bottom-up index deletion
    8501              :  * passes.
    8502              :  *
    8503              :  * Deeming certain blocks favorable allows heapam to recognize and adapt to
    8504              :  * workloads where heap blocks visited during bottom-up index deletion can be
    8505              :  * accessed contiguously, in the sense that each newly visited block is the
    8506              :  * neighbor of the block that bottom-up deletion just finished processing (or
    8507              :  * close enough to it).  It will likely be cheaper to access more favorable
    8508              :  * blocks sooner rather than later (e.g. in this pass, not across a series of
    8509              :  * related bottom-up passes).  Either way it is probably only a matter of time
    8510              :  * (or a matter of further correlated version churn) before all blocks that
    8511              :  * appear together as a single large batch of favorable blocks get accessed by
    8512              :  * _some_ bottom-up pass.  Large batches of favorable blocks tend to either
    8513              :  * appear almost constantly or not even once (it all depends on per-index
    8514              :  * workload characteristics).
    8515              :  *
    8516              :  * Note that the blockgroups sort order applies a power-of-two bucketing
    8517              :  * scheme that creates opportunities for contiguous groups of blocks to get
    8518              :  * batched together, at least with workloads that are naturally amenable to
    8519              :  * being driven by heap block locality.  This doesn't just enhance the spatial
    8520              :  * locality of bottom-up heap block processing in the obvious way.  It also
    8521              :  * enables temporal locality of access, since sorting by heap block number
    8522              :  * naturally tends to make the bottom-up processing order deterministic.
    8523              :  *
    8524              :  * Consider the following example to get a sense of how temporal locality
    8525              :  * might matter: There is a heap relation with several indexes, each of which
    8526              :  * is low to medium cardinality.  It is subject to constant non-HOT updates.
    8527              :  * The updates are skewed (in one part of the primary key, perhaps).  None of
    8528              :  * the indexes are logically modified by the UPDATE statements (if they were
    8529              :  * then bottom-up index deletion would not be triggered in the first place).
    8530              :  * Naturally, each new round of index tuples (for each heap tuple that gets a
    8531              :  * heap_update() call) will have the same heap TID in each and every index.
    8532              :  * Since these indexes are low cardinality and never get logically modified,
    8533              :  * heapam processing during bottom-up deletion passes will access heap blocks
    8534              :  * in approximately sequential order.  Temporal locality of access occurs due
    8535              :  * to bottom-up deletion passes behaving very similarly across each of the
    8536              :  * indexes at any given moment.  This keeps the number of buffer misses needed
    8537              :  * to visit heap blocks to a minimum.
    8538              :  */
    8539              : static int
    8540         2903 : bottomup_nblocksfavorable(IndexDeleteCounts *blockgroups, int nblockgroups,
    8541              :                           TM_IndexDelete *deltids)
    8542              : {
    8543         2903 :     int64       lastblock = -1;
    8544         2903 :     int         nblocksfavorable = 0;
    8545              : 
    8546              :     Assert(nblockgroups >= 1);
    8547              :     Assert(nblockgroups <= BOTTOMUP_MAX_NBLOCKS);
    8548              : 
    8549              :     /*
    8550              :      * We tolerate heap blocks that will be accessed only slightly out of
    8551              :      * physical order.  Small blips occur when a pair of almost-contiguous
    8552              :      * blocks happen to fall into different buckets (perhaps due only to a
    8553              :      * small difference in npromisingtids that the bucketing scheme didn't
    8554              :      * quite manage to ignore).  We effectively ignore these blips by applying
    8555              :      * a small tolerance.  The precise tolerance we use is a little arbitrary,
    8556              :      * but it works well enough in practice.
    8557              :      */
    8558         9029 :     for (int b = 0; b < nblockgroups; b++)
    8559              :     {
    8560         8625 :         IndexDeleteCounts *group = blockgroups + b;
    8561         8625 :         TM_IndexDelete *firstdtid = deltids + group->ifirsttid;
    8562         8625 :         BlockNumber block = ItemPointerGetBlockNumber(&firstdtid->tid);
    8563              : 
    8564         8625 :         if (lastblock != -1 &&
    8565         5722 :             ((int64) block < lastblock - BOTTOMUP_TOLERANCE_NBLOCKS ||
    8566         5104 :              (int64) block > lastblock + BOTTOMUP_TOLERANCE_NBLOCKS))
    8567              :             break;
    8568              : 
    8569         6126 :         nblocksfavorable++;
    8570         6126 :         lastblock = block;
    8571              :     }
    8572              : 
    8573              :     /* Always indicate that there is at least 1 favorable block */
    8574              :     Assert(nblocksfavorable >= 1);
    8575              : 
    8576         2903 :     return nblocksfavorable;
    8577              : }
    8578              : 
    8579              : /*
    8580              :  * qsort comparison function for bottomup_sort_and_shrink()
    8581              :  */
    8582              : static int
    8583       258965 : bottomup_sort_and_shrink_cmp(const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
    8584              : {
    8585       258965 :     const IndexDeleteCounts *group1 = (const IndexDeleteCounts *) arg1;
    8586       258965 :     const IndexDeleteCounts *group2 = (const IndexDeleteCounts *) arg2;
    8587              : 
    8588              :     /*
    8589              :      * Most significant field is npromisingtids (which we invert the order of
    8590              :      * so as to sort in desc order).
    8591              :      *
    8592              :      * Caller should have already normalized npromisingtids fields into
    8593              :      * power-of-two values (buckets).
    8594              :      */
    8595       258965 :     if (group1->npromisingtids > group2->npromisingtids)
    8596        12145 :         return -1;
    8597       246820 :     if (group1->npromisingtids < group2->npromisingtids)
    8598        15674 :         return 1;
    8599              : 
    8600              :     /*
    8601              :      * Tiebreak: desc ntids sort order.
    8602              :      *
    8603              :      * We cannot expect power-of-two values for ntids fields.  We should
    8604              :      * behave as if they were already rounded up for us instead.
    8605              :      */
    8606       231146 :     if (group1->ntids != group2->ntids)
    8607              :     {
    8608       165228 :         uint32      ntids1 = pg_nextpower2_32((uint32) group1->ntids);
    8609       165228 :         uint32      ntids2 = pg_nextpower2_32((uint32) group2->ntids);
    8610              : 
    8611       165228 :         if (ntids1 > ntids2)
    8612        24342 :             return -1;
    8613       140886 :         if (ntids1 < ntids2)
    8614        30176 :             return 1;
    8615              :     }
    8616              : 
    8617              :     /*
    8618              :      * Tiebreak: asc offset-into-deltids-for-block (offset to first TID for
    8619              :      * block in deltids array) order.
    8620              :      *
    8621              :      * This is equivalent to sorting in ascending heap block number order
    8622              :      * (among otherwise equal subsets of the array).  This approach allows us
    8623              :      * to avoid accessing the out-of-line TID.  (We rely on the assumption
    8624              :      * that the deltids array was sorted in ascending heap TID order when
    8625              :      * these offsets to the first TID from each heap block group were formed.)
    8626              :      */
    8627       176628 :     if (group1->ifirsttid > group2->ifirsttid)
    8628        85826 :         return 1;
    8629        90802 :     if (group1->ifirsttid < group2->ifirsttid)
    8630        90802 :         return -1;
    8631              : 
    8632            0 :     pg_unreachable();
    8633              : 
    8634              :     return 0;
    8635              : }
    8636              : 
    8637              : /*
    8638              :  * heap_index_delete_tuples() helper function for bottom-up deletion callers.
    8639              :  *
    8640              :  * Sorts deltids array in the order needed for useful processing by bottom-up
    8641              :  * deletion.  The array should already be sorted in TID order when we're
    8642              :  * called.  The sort process groups heap TIDs from deltids into heap block
    8643              :  * groupings.  Earlier/more-promising groups/blocks are usually those that are
    8644              :  * known to have the most "promising" TIDs.
    8645              :  *
    8646              :  * Sets new size of deltids array (ndeltids) in state.  deltids will only have
    8647              :  * TIDs from the BOTTOMUP_MAX_NBLOCKS most promising heap blocks when we
    8648              :  * return.  This often means that deltids will be shrunk to a small fraction
    8649              :  * of its original size (we eliminate many heap blocks from consideration for
    8650              :  * caller up front).
    8651              :  *
    8652              :  * Returns the number of "favorable" blocks.  See bottomup_nblocksfavorable()
    8653              :  * for a definition and full details.
    8654              :  */
    8655              : static int
    8656         2903 : bottomup_sort_and_shrink(TM_IndexDeleteOp *delstate)
    8657              : {
    8658              :     IndexDeleteCounts *blockgroups;
    8659              :     TM_IndexDelete *reordereddeltids;
    8660         2903 :     BlockNumber curblock = InvalidBlockNumber;
    8661         2903 :     int         nblockgroups = 0;
    8662         2903 :     int         ncopied = 0;
    8663         2903 :     int         nblocksfavorable = 0;
    8664              : 
    8665              :     Assert(delstate->bottomup);
    8666              :     Assert(delstate->ndeltids > 0);
    8667              : 
    8668              :     /* Calculate per-heap-block count of TIDs */
    8669         2903 :     blockgroups = palloc_array(IndexDeleteCounts, delstate->ndeltids);
    8670      1393376 :     for (int i = 0; i < delstate->ndeltids; i++)
    8671              :     {
    8672      1390473 :         TM_IndexDelete *ideltid = &delstate->deltids[i];
    8673      1390473 :         TM_IndexStatus *istatus = delstate->status + ideltid->id;
    8674      1390473 :         ItemPointer htid = &ideltid->tid;
    8675      1390473 :         bool        promising = istatus->promising;
    8676              : 
    8677      1390473 :         if (curblock != ItemPointerGetBlockNumber(htid))
    8678              :         {
    8679              :             /* New block group */
    8680        51111 :             nblockgroups++;
    8681              : 
    8682              :             Assert(curblock < ItemPointerGetBlockNumber(htid) ||
    8683              :                    !BlockNumberIsValid(curblock));
    8684              : 
    8685        51111 :             curblock = ItemPointerGetBlockNumber(htid);
    8686        51111 :             blockgroups[nblockgroups - 1].ifirsttid = i;
    8687        51111 :             blockgroups[nblockgroups - 1].ntids = 1;
    8688        51111 :             blockgroups[nblockgroups - 1].npromisingtids = 0;
    8689              :         }
    8690              :         else
    8691              :         {
    8692      1339362 :             blockgroups[nblockgroups - 1].ntids++;
    8693              :         }
    8694              : 
    8695      1390473 :         if (promising)
    8696       230354 :             blockgroups[nblockgroups - 1].npromisingtids++;
    8697              :     }
    8698              : 
    8699              :     /*
    8700              :      * We're about ready to sort block groups to determine the optimal order
    8701              :      * for visiting heap blocks.  But before we do, round the number of
    8702              :      * promising tuples for each block group up to the next power-of-two,
    8703              :      * unless it is very low (less than 4), in which case we round up to 4.
    8704              :      * npromisingtids is far too noisy to trust when choosing between a pair
    8705              :      * of block groups that both have very low values.
    8706              :      *
    8707              :      * This scheme divides heap blocks/block groups into buckets.  Each bucket
    8708              :      * contains blocks that have _approximately_ the same number of promising
    8709              :      * TIDs as each other.  The goal is to ignore relatively small differences
    8710              :      * in the total number of promising entries, so that the whole process can
    8711              :      * give a little weight to heapam factors (like heap block locality)
    8712              :      * instead.  This isn't a trade-off, really -- we have nothing to lose. It
    8713              :      * would be foolish to interpret small differences in npromisingtids
    8714              :      * values as anything more than noise.
    8715              :      *
    8716              :      * We tiebreak on nhtids when sorting block group subsets that have the
    8717              :      * same npromisingtids, but this has the same issues as npromisingtids,
    8718              :      * and so nhtids is subject to the same power-of-two bucketing scheme. The
    8719              :      * only reason that we don't fix nhtids in the same way here too is that
    8720              :      * we'll need accurate nhtids values after the sort.  We handle nhtids
    8721              :      * bucketization dynamically instead (in the sort comparator).
    8722              :      *
    8723              :      * See bottomup_nblocksfavorable() for a full explanation of when and how
    8724              :      * heap locality/favorable blocks can significantly influence when and how
    8725              :      * heap blocks are accessed.
    8726              :      */
    8727        54014 :     for (int b = 0; b < nblockgroups; b++)
    8728              :     {
    8729        51111 :         IndexDeleteCounts *group = blockgroups + b;
    8730              : 
    8731              :         /* Better off falling back on nhtids with low npromisingtids */
    8732        51111 :         if (group->npromisingtids <= 4)
    8733        42870 :             group->npromisingtids = 4;
    8734              :         else
    8735         8241 :             group->npromisingtids =
    8736         8241 :                 pg_nextpower2_32((uint32) group->npromisingtids);
    8737              :     }
    8738              : 
    8739              :     /* Sort groups and rearrange caller's deltids array */
    8740         2903 :     qsort(blockgroups, nblockgroups, sizeof(IndexDeleteCounts),
    8741              :           bottomup_sort_and_shrink_cmp);
    8742         2903 :     reordereddeltids = palloc(delstate->ndeltids * sizeof(TM_IndexDelete));
    8743              : 
    8744         2903 :     nblockgroups = Min(BOTTOMUP_MAX_NBLOCKS, nblockgroups);
    8745              :     /* Determine number of favorable blocks at the start of final deltids */
    8746         2903 :     nblocksfavorable = bottomup_nblocksfavorable(blockgroups, nblockgroups,
    8747              :                                                  delstate->deltids);
    8748              : 
    8749        18746 :     for (int b = 0; b < nblockgroups; b++)
    8750              :     {
    8751        15843 :         IndexDeleteCounts *group = blockgroups + b;
    8752        15843 :         TM_IndexDelete *firstdtid = delstate->deltids + group->ifirsttid;
    8753              : 
    8754        15843 :         memcpy(reordereddeltids + ncopied, firstdtid,
    8755        15843 :                sizeof(TM_IndexDelete) * group->ntids);
    8756        15843 :         ncopied += group->ntids;
    8757              :     }
    8758              : 
    8759              :     /* Copy final grouped and sorted TIDs back into start of caller's array */
    8760         2903 :     memcpy(delstate->deltids, reordereddeltids,
    8761              :            sizeof(TM_IndexDelete) * ncopied);
    8762         2903 :     delstate->ndeltids = ncopied;
    8763              : 
    8764         2903 :     pfree(reordereddeltids);
    8765         2903 :     pfree(blockgroups);
    8766              : 
    8767         2903 :     return nblocksfavorable;
    8768              : }
    8769              : 
    8770              : /*
    8771              :  * Perform XLogInsert for a heap-update operation.  Caller must already
    8772              :  * have modified the buffer(s) and marked them dirty.
    8773              :  */
    8774              : static XLogRecPtr
    8775      2382791 : log_heap_update(Relation reln, Buffer oldbuf,
    8776              :                 Buffer newbuf, HeapTuple oldtup, HeapTuple newtup,
    8777              :                 HeapTuple old_key_tuple,
    8778              :                 bool all_visible_cleared, bool new_all_visible_cleared,
    8779              :                 bool walLogical)
    8780              : {
    8781              :     xl_heap_update xlrec;
    8782              :     xl_heap_header xlhdr;
    8783              :     xl_heap_header xlhdr_idx;
    8784              :     uint8       info;
    8785              :     uint16      prefix_suffix[2];
    8786      2382791 :     uint16      prefixlen = 0,
    8787      2382791 :                 suffixlen = 0;
    8788              :     XLogRecPtr  recptr;
    8789      2382791 :     Page        page = BufferGetPage(newbuf);
    8790      2382791 :     bool        need_tuple_data = walLogical && RelationIsLogicallyLogged(reln);
    8791              :     bool        init;
    8792              :     int         bufflags;
    8793              : 
    8794              :     /* Caller should not call me on a non-WAL-logged relation */
    8795              :     Assert(RelationNeedsWAL(reln));
    8796              : 
    8797      2382791 :     XLogBeginInsert();
    8798              : 
    8799      2382791 :     if (HeapTupleIsHeapOnly(newtup))
    8800       169598 :         info = XLOG_HEAP_HOT_UPDATE;
    8801              :     else
    8802      2213193 :         info = XLOG_HEAP_UPDATE;
    8803              : 
    8804              :     /*
    8805              :      * If the old and new tuple are on the same page, we only need to log the
    8806              :      * parts of the new tuple that were changed.  That saves on the amount of
    8807              :      * WAL we need to write.  Currently, we just count any unchanged bytes in
    8808              :      * the beginning and end of the tuple.  That's quick to check, and
    8809              :      * perfectly covers the common case that only one field is updated.
    8810              :      *
    8811              :      * We could do this even if the old and new tuple are on different pages,
    8812              :      * but only if we don't make a full-page image of the old page, which is
    8813              :      * difficult to know in advance.  Also, if the old tuple is corrupt for
    8814              :      * some reason, it would allow the corruption to propagate the new page,
    8815              :      * so it seems best to avoid.  Under the general assumption that most
    8816              :      * updates tend to create the new tuple version on the same page, there
    8817              :      * isn't much to be gained by doing this across pages anyway.
    8818              :      *
    8819              :      * Skip this if we're taking a full-page image of the new page, as we
    8820              :      * don't include the new tuple in the WAL record in that case.  Also
    8821              :      * disable if effective_wal_level='logical', as logical decoding needs to
    8822              :      * be able to read the new tuple in whole from the WAL record alone.
    8823              :      */
    8824      2382791 :     if (oldbuf == newbuf && !need_tuple_data &&
    8825       174236 :         !XLogCheckBufferNeedsBackup(newbuf))
    8826              :     {
    8827       173703 :         char       *oldp = (char *) oldtup->t_data + oldtup->t_data->t_hoff;
    8828       173703 :         char       *newp = (char *) newtup->t_data + newtup->t_data->t_hoff;
    8829       173703 :         int         oldlen = oldtup->t_len - oldtup->t_data->t_hoff;
    8830       173703 :         int         newlen = newtup->t_len - newtup->t_data->t_hoff;
    8831              : 
    8832              :         /* Check for common prefix between old and new tuple */
    8833     14553319 :         for (prefixlen = 0; prefixlen < Min(oldlen, newlen); prefixlen++)
    8834              :         {
    8835     14525455 :             if (newp[prefixlen] != oldp[prefixlen])
    8836       145839 :                 break;
    8837              :         }
    8838              : 
    8839              :         /*
    8840              :          * Storing the length of the prefix takes 2 bytes, so we need to save
    8841              :          * at least 3 bytes or there's no point.
    8842              :          */
    8843       173703 :         if (prefixlen < 3)
    8844        24829 :             prefixlen = 0;
    8845              : 
    8846              :         /* Same for suffix */
    8847      6295653 :         for (suffixlen = 0; suffixlen < Min(oldlen, newlen) - prefixlen; suffixlen++)
    8848              :         {
    8849      6267455 :             if (newp[newlen - suffixlen - 1] != oldp[oldlen - suffixlen - 1])
    8850       145505 :                 break;
    8851              :         }
    8852       173703 :         if (suffixlen < 3)
    8853        43409 :             suffixlen = 0;
    8854              :     }
    8855              : 
    8856              :     /* Prepare main WAL data chain */
    8857      2382791 :     xlrec.flags = 0;
    8858      2382791 :     if (all_visible_cleared)
    8859         2138 :         xlrec.flags |= XLH_UPDATE_OLD_ALL_VISIBLE_CLEARED;
    8860      2382791 :     if (new_all_visible_cleared)
    8861          774 :         xlrec.flags |= XLH_UPDATE_NEW_ALL_VISIBLE_CLEARED;
    8862      2382791 :     if (prefixlen > 0)
    8863       148874 :         xlrec.flags |= XLH_UPDATE_PREFIX_FROM_OLD;
    8864      2382791 :     if (suffixlen > 0)
    8865       130294 :         xlrec.flags |= XLH_UPDATE_SUFFIX_FROM_OLD;
    8866      2382791 :     if (need_tuple_data)
    8867              :     {
    8868        47053 :         xlrec.flags |= XLH_UPDATE_CONTAINS_NEW_TUPLE;
    8869        47053 :         if (old_key_tuple)
    8870              :         {
    8871          165 :             if (reln->rd_rel->relreplident == REPLICA_IDENTITY_FULL)
    8872           68 :                 xlrec.flags |= XLH_UPDATE_CONTAINS_OLD_TUPLE;
    8873              :             else
    8874           97 :                 xlrec.flags |= XLH_UPDATE_CONTAINS_OLD_KEY;
    8875              :         }
    8876              :     }
    8877              : 
    8878              :     /* If new tuple is the single and first tuple on page... */
    8879      2395908 :     if (ItemPointerGetOffsetNumber(&(newtup->t_self)) == FirstOffsetNumber &&
    8880        13117 :         PageGetMaxOffsetNumber(page) == FirstOffsetNumber)
    8881              :     {
    8882        12964 :         info |= XLOG_HEAP_INIT_PAGE;
    8883        12964 :         init = true;
    8884              :     }
    8885              :     else
    8886      2369827 :         init = false;
    8887              : 
    8888              :     /* Prepare WAL data for the old page */
    8889      2382791 :     xlrec.old_offnum = ItemPointerGetOffsetNumber(&oldtup->t_self);
    8890      2382791 :     xlrec.old_xmax = HeapTupleHeaderGetRawXmax(oldtup->t_data);
    8891      4765582 :     xlrec.old_infobits_set = compute_infobits(oldtup->t_data->t_infomask,
    8892      2382791 :                                               oldtup->t_data->t_infomask2);
    8893              : 
    8894              :     /* Prepare WAL data for the new page */
    8895      2382791 :     xlrec.new_offnum = ItemPointerGetOffsetNumber(&newtup->t_self);
    8896      2382791 :     xlrec.new_xmax = HeapTupleHeaderGetRawXmax(newtup->t_data);
    8897              : 
    8898      2382791 :     bufflags = REGBUF_STANDARD;
    8899      2382791 :     if (init)
    8900        12964 :         bufflags |= REGBUF_WILL_INIT;
    8901      2382791 :     if (need_tuple_data)
    8902        47053 :         bufflags |= REGBUF_KEEP_DATA;
    8903              : 
    8904      2382791 :     XLogRegisterBuffer(0, newbuf, bufflags);
    8905      2382791 :     if (oldbuf != newbuf)
    8906      2196584 :         XLogRegisterBuffer(1, oldbuf, REGBUF_STANDARD);
    8907              : 
    8908      2382791 :     XLogRegisterData(&xlrec, SizeOfHeapUpdate);
    8909              : 
    8910              :     /*
    8911              :      * Prepare WAL data for the new tuple.
    8912              :      */
    8913      2382791 :     if (prefixlen > 0 || suffixlen > 0)
    8914              :     {
    8915       171640 :         if (prefixlen > 0 && suffixlen > 0)
    8916              :         {
    8917       107528 :             prefix_suffix[0] = prefixlen;
    8918       107528 :             prefix_suffix[1] = suffixlen;
    8919       107528 :             XLogRegisterBufData(0, &prefix_suffix, sizeof(uint16) * 2);
    8920              :         }
    8921        64112 :         else if (prefixlen > 0)
    8922              :         {
    8923        41346 :             XLogRegisterBufData(0, &prefixlen, sizeof(uint16));
    8924              :         }
    8925              :         else
    8926              :         {
    8927        22766 :             XLogRegisterBufData(0, &suffixlen, sizeof(uint16));
    8928              :         }
    8929              :     }
    8930              : 
    8931      2382791 :     xlhdr.t_infomask2 = newtup->t_data->t_infomask2;
    8932      2382791 :     xlhdr.t_infomask = newtup->t_data->t_infomask;
    8933      2382791 :     xlhdr.t_hoff = newtup->t_data->t_hoff;
    8934              :     Assert(SizeofHeapTupleHeader + prefixlen + suffixlen <= newtup->t_len);
    8935              : 
    8936              :     /*
    8937              :      * PG73FORMAT: write bitmap [+ padding] [+ oid] + data
    8938              :      *
    8939              :      * The 'data' doesn't include the common prefix or suffix.
    8940              :      */
    8941      2382791 :     XLogRegisterBufData(0, &xlhdr, SizeOfHeapHeader);
    8942      2382791 :     if (prefixlen == 0)
    8943              :     {
    8944      2233917 :         XLogRegisterBufData(0,
    8945      2233917 :                             (char *) newtup->t_data + SizeofHeapTupleHeader,
    8946      2233917 :                             newtup->t_len - SizeofHeapTupleHeader - suffixlen);
    8947              :     }
    8948              :     else
    8949              :     {
    8950              :         /*
    8951              :          * Have to write the null bitmap and data after the common prefix as
    8952              :          * two separate rdata entries.
    8953              :          */
    8954              :         /* bitmap [+ padding] [+ oid] */
    8955       148874 :         if (newtup->t_data->t_hoff - SizeofHeapTupleHeader > 0)
    8956              :         {
    8957       148874 :             XLogRegisterBufData(0,
    8958       148874 :                                 (char *) newtup->t_data + SizeofHeapTupleHeader,
    8959       148874 :                                 newtup->t_data->t_hoff - SizeofHeapTupleHeader);
    8960              :         }
    8961              : 
    8962              :         /* data after common prefix */
    8963       148874 :         XLogRegisterBufData(0,
    8964       148874 :                             (char *) newtup->t_data + newtup->t_data->t_hoff + prefixlen,
    8965       148874 :                             newtup->t_len - newtup->t_data->t_hoff - prefixlen - suffixlen);
    8966              :     }
    8967              : 
    8968              :     /* We need to log a tuple identity */
    8969      2382791 :     if (need_tuple_data && old_key_tuple)
    8970              :     {
    8971              :         /* don't really need this, but its more comfy to decode */
    8972          165 :         xlhdr_idx.t_infomask2 = old_key_tuple->t_data->t_infomask2;
    8973          165 :         xlhdr_idx.t_infomask = old_key_tuple->t_data->t_infomask;
    8974          165 :         xlhdr_idx.t_hoff = old_key_tuple->t_data->t_hoff;
    8975              : 
    8976          165 :         XLogRegisterData(&xlhdr_idx, SizeOfHeapHeader);
    8977              : 
    8978              :         /* PG73FORMAT: write bitmap [+ padding] [+ oid] + data */
    8979          165 :         XLogRegisterData((char *) old_key_tuple->t_data + SizeofHeapTupleHeader,
    8980          165 :                          old_key_tuple->t_len - SizeofHeapTupleHeader);
    8981              :     }
    8982              : 
    8983              :     /* filtering by origin on a row level is much more efficient */
    8984      2382791 :     XLogSetRecordFlags(XLOG_INCLUDE_ORIGIN);
    8985              : 
    8986      2382791 :     recptr = XLogInsert(RM_HEAP_ID, info);
    8987              : 
    8988      2382791 :     return recptr;
    8989              : }
    8990              : 
    8991              : /*
    8992              :  * Perform XLogInsert of an XLOG_HEAP2_NEW_CID record
    8993              :  *
    8994              :  * This is only used when effective_wal_level is logical, and only for
    8995              :  * catalog tuples.
    8996              :  */
    8997              : static XLogRecPtr
    8998        33018 : log_heap_new_cid(Relation relation, HeapTuple tup)
    8999              : {
    9000              :     xl_heap_new_cid xlrec;
    9001              : 
    9002              :     XLogRecPtr  recptr;
    9003        33018 :     HeapTupleHeader hdr = tup->t_data;
    9004              : 
    9005              :     Assert(ItemPointerIsValid(&tup->t_self));
    9006              :     Assert(tup->t_tableOid != InvalidOid);
    9007              : 
    9008        33018 :     xlrec.top_xid = GetTopTransactionId();
    9009        33018 :     xlrec.target_locator = relation->rd_locator;
    9010        33018 :     xlrec.target_tid = tup->t_self;
    9011              : 
    9012              :     /*
    9013              :      * If the tuple got inserted & deleted in the same TX we definitely have a
    9014              :      * combo CID, set cmin and cmax.
    9015              :      */
    9016        33018 :     if (hdr->t_infomask & HEAP_COMBOCID)
    9017              :     {
    9018              :         Assert(!(hdr->t_infomask & HEAP_XMAX_INVALID));
    9019              :         Assert(!HeapTupleHeaderXminInvalid(hdr));
    9020         2256 :         xlrec.cmin = HeapTupleHeaderGetCmin(hdr);
    9021         2256 :         xlrec.cmax = HeapTupleHeaderGetCmax(hdr);
    9022         2256 :         xlrec.combocid = HeapTupleHeaderGetRawCommandId(hdr);
    9023              :     }
    9024              :     /* No combo CID, so only cmin or cmax can be set by this TX */
    9025              :     else
    9026              :     {
    9027              :         /*
    9028              :          * Tuple inserted.
    9029              :          *
    9030              :          * We need to check for LOCK ONLY because multixacts might be
    9031              :          * transferred to the new tuple in case of FOR KEY SHARE updates in
    9032              :          * which case there will be an xmax, although the tuple just got
    9033              :          * inserted.
    9034              :          */
    9035        41504 :         if (hdr->t_infomask & HEAP_XMAX_INVALID ||
    9036        10742 :             HEAP_XMAX_IS_LOCKED_ONLY(hdr->t_infomask))
    9037              :         {
    9038        20021 :             xlrec.cmin = HeapTupleHeaderGetRawCommandId(hdr);
    9039        20021 :             xlrec.cmax = InvalidCommandId;
    9040              :         }
    9041              :         /* Tuple from a different tx updated or deleted. */
    9042              :         else
    9043              :         {
    9044        10741 :             xlrec.cmin = InvalidCommandId;
    9045        10741 :             xlrec.cmax = HeapTupleHeaderGetRawCommandId(hdr);
    9046              :         }
    9047        30762 :         xlrec.combocid = InvalidCommandId;
    9048              :     }
    9049              : 
    9050              :     /*
    9051              :      * Note that we don't need to register the buffer here, because this
    9052              :      * operation does not modify the page. The insert/update/delete that
    9053              :      * called us certainly did, but that's WAL-logged separately.
    9054              :      */
    9055        33018 :     XLogBeginInsert();
    9056        33018 :     XLogRegisterData(&xlrec, SizeOfHeapNewCid);
    9057              : 
    9058              :     /* will be looked at irrespective of origin */
    9059              : 
    9060        33018 :     recptr = XLogInsert(RM_HEAP2_ID, XLOG_HEAP2_NEW_CID);
    9061              : 
    9062        33018 :     return recptr;
    9063              : }
    9064              : 
    9065              : /*
    9066              :  * Build a heap tuple representing the configured REPLICA IDENTITY to represent
    9067              :  * the old tuple in an UPDATE or DELETE.
    9068              :  *
    9069              :  * Returns NULL if there's no need to log an identity or if there's no suitable
    9070              :  * key defined.
    9071              :  *
    9072              :  * Pass key_required true if any replica identity columns changed value, or if
    9073              :  * any of them have any external data.  Delete must always pass true.
    9074              :  *
    9075              :  * *copy is set to true if the returned tuple is a modified copy rather than
    9076              :  * the same tuple that was passed in.
    9077              :  */
    9078              : static HeapTuple
    9079      4289967 : ExtractReplicaIdentity(Relation relation, HeapTuple tp, bool key_required,
    9080              :                        bool *copy)
    9081              : {
    9082      4289967 :     TupleDesc   desc = RelationGetDescr(relation);
    9083      4289967 :     char        replident = relation->rd_rel->relreplident;
    9084              :     Bitmapset  *idattrs;
    9085              :     HeapTuple   key_tuple;
    9086              :     bool        nulls[MaxHeapAttributeNumber];
    9087              :     Datum       values[MaxHeapAttributeNumber];
    9088              : 
    9089      4289967 :     *copy = false;
    9090              : 
    9091      4289967 :     if (!RelationIsLogicallyLogged(relation))
    9092      4189573 :         return NULL;
    9093              : 
    9094       100394 :     if (replident == REPLICA_IDENTITY_NOTHING)
    9095          272 :         return NULL;
    9096              : 
    9097       100122 :     if (replident == REPLICA_IDENTITY_FULL)
    9098              :     {
    9099              :         /*
    9100              :          * When logging the entire old tuple, it very well could contain
    9101              :          * toasted columns. If so, force them to be inlined.
    9102              :          */
    9103          203 :         if (HeapTupleHasExternal(tp))
    9104              :         {
    9105            4 :             *copy = true;
    9106            4 :             tp = toast_flatten_tuple(tp, desc);
    9107              :         }
    9108          203 :         return tp;
    9109              :     }
    9110              : 
    9111              :     /* if the key isn't required and we're only logging the key, we're done */
    9112        99919 :     if (!key_required)
    9113        46908 :         return NULL;
    9114              : 
    9115              :     /* find out the replica identity columns */
    9116        53011 :     idattrs = RelationGetIndexAttrBitmap(relation,
    9117              :                                          INDEX_ATTR_BITMAP_IDENTITY_KEY);
    9118              : 
    9119              :     /*
    9120              :      * If there's no defined replica identity columns, treat as !key_required.
    9121              :      * (This case should not be reachable from heap_update, since that should
    9122              :      * calculate key_required accurately.  But heap_delete just passes
    9123              :      * constant true for key_required, so we can hit this case in deletes.)
    9124              :      */
    9125        53011 :     if (bms_is_empty(idattrs))
    9126         6021 :         return NULL;
    9127              : 
    9128              :     /*
    9129              :      * Construct a new tuple containing only the replica identity columns,
    9130              :      * with nulls elsewhere.  While we're at it, assert that the replica
    9131              :      * identity columns aren't null.
    9132              :      */
    9133        46990 :     heap_deform_tuple(tp, desc, values, nulls);
    9134              : 
    9135       150979 :     for (int i = 0; i < desc->natts; i++)
    9136              :     {
    9137       103989 :         if (bms_is_member(i + 1 - FirstLowInvalidHeapAttributeNumber,
    9138              :                           idattrs))
    9139              :             Assert(!nulls[i]);
    9140              :         else
    9141        56979 :             nulls[i] = true;
    9142              :     }
    9143              : 
    9144        46990 :     key_tuple = heap_form_tuple(desc, values, nulls);
    9145        46990 :     *copy = true;
    9146              : 
    9147        46990 :     bms_free(idattrs);
    9148              : 
    9149              :     /*
    9150              :      * If the tuple, which by here only contains indexed columns, still has
    9151              :      * toasted columns, force them to be inlined. This is somewhat unlikely
    9152              :      * since there's limits on the size of indexed columns, so we don't
    9153              :      * duplicate toast_flatten_tuple()s functionality in the above loop over
    9154              :      * the indexed columns, even if it would be more efficient.
    9155              :      */
    9156        46990 :     if (HeapTupleHasExternal(key_tuple))
    9157              :     {
    9158            4 :         HeapTuple   oldtup = key_tuple;
    9159              : 
    9160            4 :         key_tuple = toast_flatten_tuple(oldtup, desc);
    9161            4 :         heap_freetuple(oldtup);
    9162              :     }
    9163              : 
    9164        46990 :     return key_tuple;
    9165              : }
    9166              : 
    9167              : /*
    9168              :  * HeapCheckForSerializableConflictOut
    9169              :  *      We are reading a tuple.  If it's not visible, there may be a
    9170              :  *      rw-conflict out with the inserter.  Otherwise, if it is visible to us
    9171              :  *      but has been deleted, there may be a rw-conflict out with the deleter.
    9172              :  *
    9173              :  * We will determine the top level xid of the writing transaction with which
    9174              :  * we may be in conflict, and ask CheckForSerializableConflictOut() to check
    9175              :  * for overlap with our own transaction.
    9176              :  *
    9177              :  * This function should be called just about anywhere in heapam.c where a
    9178              :  * tuple has been read. The caller must hold at least a shared lock on the
    9179              :  * buffer, because this function might set hint bits on the tuple. There is
    9180              :  * currently no known reason to call this function from an index AM.
    9181              :  */
    9182              : void
    9183     42324171 : HeapCheckForSerializableConflictOut(bool visible, Relation relation,
    9184              :                                     HeapTuple tuple, Buffer buffer,
    9185              :                                     Snapshot snapshot)
    9186              : {
    9187              :     TransactionId xid;
    9188              :     HTSV_Result htsvResult;
    9189              : 
    9190     42324171 :     if (!CheckForSerializableConflictOutNeeded(relation, snapshot))
    9191     42316226 :         return;
    9192              : 
    9193              :     /*
    9194              :      * Check to see whether the tuple has been written to by a concurrent
    9195              :      * transaction, either to create it not visible to us, or to delete it
    9196              :      * while it is visible to us.  The "visible" bool indicates whether the
    9197              :      * tuple is visible to us, while HeapTupleSatisfiesVacuum checks what else
    9198              :      * is going on with it.
    9199              :      *
    9200              :      * In the event of a concurrently inserted tuple that also happens to have
    9201              :      * been concurrently updated (by a separate transaction), the xmin of the
    9202              :      * tuple will be used -- not the updater's xid.
    9203              :      */
    9204         7945 :     htsvResult = HeapTupleSatisfiesVacuum(tuple, TransactionXmin, buffer);
    9205         7945 :     switch (htsvResult)
    9206              :     {
    9207         7137 :         case HEAPTUPLE_LIVE:
    9208         7137 :             if (visible)
    9209         7124 :                 return;
    9210           13 :             xid = HeapTupleHeaderGetXmin(tuple->t_data);
    9211           13 :             break;
    9212          361 :         case HEAPTUPLE_RECENTLY_DEAD:
    9213              :         case HEAPTUPLE_DELETE_IN_PROGRESS:
    9214          361 :             if (visible)
    9215          286 :                 xid = HeapTupleHeaderGetUpdateXid(tuple->t_data);
    9216              :             else
    9217           75 :                 xid = HeapTupleHeaderGetXmin(tuple->t_data);
    9218              : 
    9219          361 :             if (TransactionIdPrecedes(xid, TransactionXmin))
    9220              :             {
    9221              :                 /* This is like the HEAPTUPLE_DEAD case */
    9222              :                 Assert(!visible);
    9223           69 :                 return;
    9224              :             }
    9225          292 :             break;
    9226          327 :         case HEAPTUPLE_INSERT_IN_PROGRESS:
    9227          327 :             xid = HeapTupleHeaderGetXmin(tuple->t_data);
    9228          327 :             break;
    9229          120 :         case HEAPTUPLE_DEAD:
    9230              :             Assert(!visible);
    9231          120 :             return;
    9232            0 :         default:
    9233              : 
    9234              :             /*
    9235              :              * The only way to get to this default clause is if a new value is
    9236              :              * added to the enum type without adding it to this switch
    9237              :              * statement.  That's a bug, so elog.
    9238              :              */
    9239            0 :             elog(ERROR, "unrecognized return value from HeapTupleSatisfiesVacuum: %u", htsvResult);
    9240              : 
    9241              :             /*
    9242              :              * In spite of having all enum values covered and calling elog on
    9243              :              * this default, some compilers think this is a code path which
    9244              :              * allows xid to be used below without initialization. Silence
    9245              :              * that warning.
    9246              :              */
    9247              :             xid = InvalidTransactionId;
    9248              :     }
    9249              : 
    9250              :     Assert(TransactionIdIsValid(xid));
    9251              :     Assert(TransactionIdFollowsOrEquals(xid, TransactionXmin));
    9252              : 
    9253              :     /*
    9254              :      * Find top level xid.  Bail out if xid is too early to be a conflict, or
    9255              :      * if it's our own xid.
    9256              :      */
    9257          632 :     if (TransactionIdEquals(xid, GetTopTransactionIdIfAny()))
    9258           64 :         return;
    9259          568 :     xid = SubTransGetTopmostTransaction(xid);
    9260          568 :     if (TransactionIdPrecedes(xid, TransactionXmin))
    9261            0 :         return;
    9262              : 
    9263          568 :     CheckForSerializableConflictOut(relation, xid, snapshot);
    9264              : }
        

Generated by: LCOV version 2.0-1